Ignou Physical Anthropology-1
Ignou Physical Anthropology-1
Ignou Physical Anthropology-1
ANTHROGURU
ANTHROPOLOGY
IGNOU-MA (ANTHROPOLOGY)
PHYSICAL
ANTHROPOLOGY
{ PART-1 }
TOPICS COVERED;
PAPER-1
1.1, 1.5, 1.7,9.1,9.2,9.3,9.4,9.6
CONTACT:
telegram: anthroguru
1.3 Main branches of Anthropology, their scope and relevance:
1.7 The biological basis of life: The Cell, DNA structure and replication, Protein Synthesis,
Gene, Mutation, Chromosomes, and Cell Division.
9.1 Human Genetics : Methods and Application: Methods for study of genetic principles in
man-family study (pedigree analysis, twin study, foster child, co-twin method, cytogenetic
method, chromosomal and karyo-type analysis), biochemical methods, immunological
methods, D.N.A. technology and recombinant technologies.
9.2 Mendelian genetics in man-family study, single factor, multifactor, lethal, sublethal and
polygenic inheritance in man.
(b) Sex chromosomal aberrations – Klinefelter (XXY), Turner (XO), Super female (XXX),
intersex and other syndromic disorders.
(c) Autosomal aberrations – Down syndrome, Patau, Edward and Cri-du-chat syndromes.
(d) Genetic imprints in human disease, genetic screening, genetic counseling, human DNA
profiling, gene mapping and genome study.
9.6 Age, sex and population variation as genetic marker- ABO, Rh blood groups, HLA Hp,
transferring, Gm, blood enzymes. Physiological characteristics-Hb level, body fat, pulse
rate, respiratory functions and sensory perceptions in different cultural and socio-
economic groups.
MANI-002
PHYSICAL
Indira Gandhi
ANTHROPOLOGY
National Open University
School of Social Sciences
Block
1
HISTORY AND DEVELOPMENT OF PHYSICAL
ANTHROPOLOGY
UNIT 1
Definition and Scope 5
UNIT 2
Relationship with Other Disciplines 17
UNIT 3
Applied Dimensions-I 25
UNIT 4
Applied Dimentions-II 33
Expert Committee
Professor I. J. S. Bansal Professor S.Channa
Retired, Department of Human Biology Department of Anthropology
Punjabi University University of Delhi, Delhi
Patiala
Professor P. Vijay Prakash
Professor K. K. Misra Department of Anthropology
Director Andhra University
Indira Gandhi Rashtriya Manav Visakhapatnam
Sangrahalaya, Bhopal
Dr. Nita Mathur
Professor Ranjana Ray Associate Professor
Retired, Department of Anthropology, Faculty of Sociology
Calcutta University School of Social Sciences
Kolkata Indira Gandhi National Open University
Maidan Garhi, New Delhi
Professor P. Chengal Reddy
Retired, Department of Anthropology Dr. S. M. Patnaik
S V University, Tirupati Associate Professor
Department of Anthropology
Professor R. K. Pathak
University of Delhi, Delhi
Department of Anthropology
Panjab University Dr. Manoj Kumar Singh
Chandigarh Assistant Professor
Department of Anthropology
Professor A. K. Kapoor
University of Delhi, Delhi
Department of Anthropology
University of Delhi, Delhi Faculty of Anthropology
SOSS, IGNOU
Professor V.K.Srivastava
Principal, Hindu College Dr. Rashmi Sinha, Reader
University of Delhi, Delhi Dr. Mitoo Das, Assistant Professor
Professor Sudhakar Rao Dr. Rukshana Zaman, Assistant Professor
Department of Anthropology Dr. P Venkatramana, Assistant Professor
University of Hyderabad, Hyderabad Dr. K. Anil Kumar, Assistant Professor
Programme Coordinator: Dr. Rashmi Sinha, SOSS, IGNOU, New Delhi
Course Coordinator: Dr. Rashmi Sinha, SOSS, IGNOU, New Delhi
Content Editor Language Editor
Professor P. K. Seth Mrs. Narinder Jit Kaur
Retired, Department of Anthropology Retired, Associate Professor in English
University of Delhi, Delhi Government Mohindra College, Patiala
Blocks Preparation Team
Unit Writers
Dr Rashmi Sinha (Units 1,2 & 3) Dr. P. Venkatramana (Unit 4)
Reader, Faculty of Anthropology Assistant Professor, Faculty of Anthropology
SOSS, IGNOU, New Delhi SOSS, IGNOU, New Delhi
Authors are responsible for the academic content of this course as far as the copy right issues are concerned.
Introduction
We are so inquisitive to know about ourselves right from what we were earlier to
why we are like today. The scientific family and individual have been enamored
by the subject for many years. All the answers lead us to the in-depth knowledge
in the discipline of Anthropology. Anthropology is holistic in approach as it
deals with human beings all around the world and throughout time by examining
the historical and present geographical distribution and considering all aspects
of human, both biological as well as social. The strength of physical anthropology
lies in its wide horizon to understand man as a physical being in his prehistoric
setting and cultural context ruled by a multifaceted system of customs, attitudes
and behaviour. Amongst the branches in Anthropology, Physical Anthropology
holds a very coveted position.
What is Physical anthropology, its definition at various times past and present is
dealt in Unit 1. Its historical journey to the days when physical anthropology
meant human variation and measurement, to the current status when our
knowledge has advanced through technical progression, the aim and scope of
this subject and an overview of the several sub disciplines of physical
anthropology exploring human yet maintaining its own identity will all be dealt
in this introductory unit.
Anthropology is not an isolated but is a broad field of study. It involves all branches
of learning that concerns human and hence is involved with several other
disciplines. Unit 2 concerns with the interdisciplinary and trandisciplinary
approaches in relation to physical anthropology. There are some strong
connections between physical anthropology and other disciplines like forensic
science, life sciences, medical sciences, earth sciences, human biology,
environmental sciences, social sciences, human engineering and technology, and
physical sciences.
Anthropology has spread its tentacles to more than just being an academic
discipline. The recent years reflect an ever increasing recognition; what
anthropology has discovered and can discover about human is invaluable. Applied
and academic anthropology are not mutually restricted approaches, infact, applied
anthropology banks on research and theory of academic anthropology and
simultaneously has much to contribute to theory and technique. But then the
applied aspect of physical anthropology is far from the knowledge bank of the
subject. Applied anthropology is dedicated in making theoretical anthropological
knowledge useful. The applied aspect in physical anthropology is not a recent
discipline which needs an introduction. The knowledge gained by physical
anthropology has been used for getting practical benefits in various fields will
History and Development of be dealt in unit 3 and 4. The application of physical anthropology in field of
Physical Anthropology
designing, forensic anthropology, diseases, aging, sports, public health and
nutritional anthropology would be covered in Unit 3 and Unit 4 deals with
paternity diagnosis, genetic counseling, eugenics and DNA technology and its
use in disease and medicine.
4
Definition and Scope
UNIT 1 DEFINITION AND SCOPE
Contents
1.1 Introduction
1.2 Definition
1.3 Aim
1.4 Scope
1.5 History
1.6 Branches and its Development
1.7 Summary
Suggested Reading
Sample Questions
1.1 INTRODUCTION
Physical anthropology is an important field of anthropology. Aren’t we inquisitive
to know about ourselves? How we were in the past to why we are like today? In
this course on Physical Anthropology, let us first define what physical
anthropology is and what does one achieve knowing this discipline. The historical
background will take you back to the days when physical anthropology meant
human variation and measurement to the current status, when we have advanced
our knowledge through technical progression. The progress in this discipline
has paved the way for several branches in physical anthropology.
1.2 DEFINITION
It very much interests us to know more about our past, present and future. What
were the stages that took us to our present day form? All the answers lead us to
the in-depth knowledge of Anthropology. The word Anthropology consists of
Greek word “Anthropos” which means man and “logos” stands for study. It is a
very vast subject comprising man as a physical being, man in his prehistoric
setting and man in his cultural context who is ruled by a multifaceted system of
customs, attitudes and behaviour. Anthropology is holistic in approach as it is
concerned with all human beings, at all times, around the world through the
examination of historical and present geographical distribution of human both
biological as well as social. In a broader perspective, it is comparative science of
man, his variation and their causes.
5
History and Development of Amongst the various branches in Anthropology, Physical Anthropology holds a
Physical Anthropology
very coveted position. What is Physical Anthropology? It is not a simple task to
provide a specific definition of physical anthropology for the simple reason that
it involves interdisciplinary approach. Paul Broca, father of Physical Anthropology
defines it as natural history of the genus Homo and more concretely as the science
whose objective is to study humanity as a whole and in relationship to rest of the
nature. Herskovits identifies that physical anthropologists study such matters as
the nature of racial differences; the inheritance of bodily traits; the growth,
development and decay of human organism; the influence of natural environment
on man. According to Juan Comas, it is defined as science which studies variation,
comparative study of the human body and its inseparable functions, exposition
of the causes and courses of human evolution, transmission and classification,
effects and tendencies in the functional and organic differences, etc.
The branch of anthropology that concerns the human and nonhuman primate
evolution, the biological basis of human behaviour, and human biological
variability and its significance (giving it a proximity to biological science) is
referred to as biological anthropology while physical anthropology is largely an
American and British concept. In most European and many other countries,
physical anthropologists are the only ones who are considered as anthropologists,
while others are referred to as archaeologists, ethnologists, linguists, or
prehistorians depending upon their field of specialisation.
1.3 AIM
The broad based understanding of human organism is the strength of physical
anthropology. Not only this, physical anthropology integrates bio-cultural studies
of human diversity, the ancestors of human species, comparative anatomy,
ecology, behaviour and history of primates. Physical anthropologists are interested
in studying human genetics, growth and development and evolutionary history.
They attempt to accurately describe human physical structure both past and present
and also investigate how function and behaviour are integrated into the
environment in which human beings live.
Human biology has many times been erroneously used as a synonym for physical
anthropology although, there is clear cut area for both the fields. Human biology
comprises structure and function of contemporary man, whereas physical
6
anthropology refers to all that is chronological, racial, social and even pathological Definition and Scope
groupings of human. They are very close knit, yet they maintain individual identity
in working methods, techniques and objectives.
1.4 SCOPE
With so much information getting unveiled, do you think physical anthropology
is merely an academic subject? On the contrary, the recent years reflect an ever
increasing recognition of what anthropology has discovered and can discover
about humans.
The essence of physical anthropology right from its inception remains focused
on man’s physical characters, their origin, how they evolved and their development
to present state that is, whatever we are today is the result of past and present
conditions. Physical anthropology is widely accepted as the comparative science
of man as a physical organism in context to his total surrounding be it social or
cultural or physical; because development of his physical and cultural factors is
reliant on the environment prevailing at that time.
The stages of evolution particularly the ‘prehuman’ history of man to his present
form is the basis of Primatology. It also includes the study of human biology
including anatomy, physiology and ethology. Undeniable is the contribution of
Primate Palaeontology on extinct primates. This entire phenomenon tracing the
origin of man and his evolution comes under Palaeoanthropology. Appropriate
evaluation of the remains of fossil men in evolutionary outlook requires the
contribution of comparative anatomy as well as embryology or developmental
anatomy and physiology of growth.
1.5 HISTORY
Early physical anthropologists pondered about the nature and geneses of human
races. Variation in human phenotypes mesmerized them. Way back in the
seventeenth century, it was widely accepted by the western scholars that humans
belonged to a single species, all descendants of Noah and his family. When they
came across so many different looking human beings, it struck upon them the
diversity among mankind. This was obviously something they had not imagined.
With the advent of 18th century, physical anthropology answered this curiosity
with its emergence as the scientific study of race, a response to the presence of
so many human types.
The founder of physical anthropology was the German physician Johann Friedrich
Blumenbach (1752–1840) of Göttingen; he was also regarded as the inventor of
craniology, build up enormous collection of human skulls, and thus had right to
be an empirical power on the question of human diversity. According to him,
mankind could be divided into five races: American, Caucasian, Ethiopian,
Malayan and Mongolian.
The very first impression everyone had, was that all contemporary human races
were monogenic, which meant that man’s origin was from a single gene. James
Cowles Prichard (1786-1848), was of the opinion that, as the descendants of
Adam became lighter-skinned they attained higher intellects and civilization.
With passage of time, all races would become similar to Western Europeans, the
race that in his view had progressed farther or more rapidly. It was in late
eighteenth and early nineteenth centuries, the proposal that races were polygenic,
that is more than one gene, picked up momentum in the scientific circles of
Europe especially France and America. The advocates of polygenism were of
the view that the extent of human diversity found could not be attributed to the
opponents of polygenism as the variation between the races was too much to be
8
just a resultant of environmental differences and too great for humanity to be Definition and Scope
attributed to a single species. Therefore, there must have been many species
right from the beginning. This human variation which came into limelight was
studied using anthropometric measurements (anthropometry) by a Philadelphia
physician and advocate of polygenism, Samuel George Morton (1799-1844), in
later nineteenth century.
Paul Broca along with other French physical anthropologists intensified their
work on cranial anatomy and other small variations. While the German tradition,
led by Rudolf Virchow (1821–1902) stressed on the fact that the variation
observed in the human form is a result of environment and disease upon the
human body, and the lack of fit among race, nation, and culture. The American
tradition focused upon the “pacified” aboriginal (Indian) inhabitants of the North
American continent, unearthing and gathering skeletons as scientific objects along
with artifacts, languages, and culture.
It was Edward Tyson (1650-1708), a London physician and member of the Royal
Society, who started the European primate studies and differentiated between
the animal, humans, and monkeys by dissecting a chimpanzee. In fact lot of
curiosity was generated among people in primate behaviour despite it most of
the early scientific investigations were basically anatomical. Thomas Henry
Huxley’s in Man’s Place in Nature (1863) endeavored to apply Darwinism to
appreciate the origins of human. Thus Primatology focused on anatomy and look
for primate evolution from paleontological record. It was Ernst Haeckel (1834-
1919) in Germany who published an encyclopedia of primate anatomy and came
up with first scientific phylogenetic trees. It was because of these efforts that
made us understand what we are today, with anatomy remaining the focal point
until after 1900.
9
History and Development of It was prevalent in the United States after the Civil War (1861–65) that physical
Physical Anthropology
anthropology was a mystique medical speciality. But it was Franz Boas (1858–
1942) in 1897, an architect of today’s face of physical anthropology who used
his expertise in measuring schoolchildren, and collecting Inuit skeletons. Boas
also propagated changeability of the human form and minimize race in favor of
studying culture.
Human Evolution: This branch, as the name suggests, revolves around the origin
and evolution of Homo sapiens as a distinct species. The word “human” in the
framework of human evolution speak of the genus Homo. But then how did
humans evolve. In order to understand human evolution we study hominids also
11
History and Development of as the study of hominids holds importance. It is important to know other
Physical Anthropology
disciplines like primatology, archaeology, linguistics and genetics so as to have
a better understanding of human evolution.
Human Ecology: Ecology is a biological discipline that deals with the interactions
between organisms and their environment. This environment is a sum total of
the physical environment including temperature, water availability, wind, soil
acidity and biological environment which holds influences on an organism.
Human adaptation (physiologic, developmental, and genetic) to environmental
stresses and variation is part of human ecology. Human being is the most versatile
species on earth which can adapt in any environment, be it extreme climate,
deserts, polar region, high altitude or even a marooned island. Human species
are distributed world wide well adapted in diverse environment. The human
group is an ever-increasing population which in return would involve more
consumption of resources; therefore better adoption of the Earth’s primary
production is need of the hour. However, many other human ecological
developments are probable in future. The growth of human population and how
this growth is accommodated, the way they utilise these resources yet preserve
the biodiversity is yet to be comprehended.
Forensic Anthropology: This has been one of the most sought after branches of
physical anthropology. The term “forensic” refers to the application of this subfield
of science to a court of law. Forensic anthropology is the application of the science
of physical anthropology and human osteology in a legal scenario; when in a
criminal case, victim’s remains are unidentifiable or in the advanced stages of
decomposition, forensic anthropology helps in identification of the individual.
The techniques of Forensic anthropology helps to assist in the reconstruction of
remains, assessment of age, sex, stature, ancestry, and analyse trauma and disease.
Forensic anthropology is witnessing rapid growth and recognition, laurels of
which goes to anthropologists whose expertise in criminal evidence (fingerprints,
blood types, and skeletal remains) are sought. Forensic anthropologists utilise
the proficiency of forensic pathologists, odontologists, and homicide investigators
to identify a decedent, discover evidence of trauma, and determine the postmortem
interval. Though their opinions are taken into consideration by the medical
examiner, yet they do not enjoy the legal authority to declare the official cause of
death.
Human Variation: The term human variation is gaining popularity over its
historical predecessor “race” in anthropology because of the exploitation of the
term. It is suggested to use gene frequencies and biological traits of human
populations by their geographic area. This genotypic and phenotypic detail would
be understood in terms of historical and closest selective forces in each
environment. Its main thrust is focused in an endeavor to interpret given so much
of human diversity, a consequence of evolution through a long passage of time
and all around the globe.
1.7 SUMMARY
After going through this unit, you must have understood that various definitions
of physical anthropology have been given depending upon the focus at that time.
It is rather difficult to give precise definition to physical anthropology as it
embraces interdisciplinary approach. The mechanisms of biological evolution,
genetic inheritance, human adaptability and variation, primatology and the fossil
record of human evolution constitute Physical Anthropology reflecting an
important scenario in today’s increasingly specialised world of science. It aims
for the physical anthropologists to explore human genetics, growth and
development and evolutionary history in an attempt to accurately describe human
physical structure both in the present and in the past and also investigate how
function and behaviour are integrated into the environment in which human beings
live. The scope of this discipline is manifold making it indispensable. We realised
that the understanding and assessment of the degree of human variability along
with the accounting of factors responsible for our current distribution has been
of vital concern. Genetics and anthropometry have been used in estimating the
detailed cause of individual variation and diversification of the varieties of man.
Human variation, a specialised branch of physical anthropology, currently carries
15
History and Development of out studies to facilitate in the understanding of reliable history of the origin and
Physical Anthropology
evolution of mankind and its varieties; and attempts to evaluate the reasons of
human variation. There are different branches of physical anthropology, each
maintaining its thrust area and identity.
It is believed that by now you must have realised how fascinating is the field of
physical anthropology. It has witnessed a long painstaking journey in its quest to
never-ending desire to know about human. Continuously, physical anthropologists
are meticulously working to unearth the mysteries of human beings. It is not that
they are working in isolation but amazingly involves varied fields resulting in
newer concepts and better understanding which you will encounter in the next
unit.
Suggested Reading
Boaz, N.T and Almquist, A.J. 1999. Essentials of Biological Anthropology, New
Jersey, Prentice Hall.
Harrison, G.A., Weiner, J.S., Tanner, J.M. and Barnicot, N.A.1964. Human
Biology.Oxford University Press
Harrison, G.A, Weiner, J.S., Tanner, J.M., Barnicot, N.A. and Reynolds,V. 1977.
Human Biology, An Introduction to Human Evolution, Variation, Growth and
Ecology. Oxford University Press.
Stein, P. L. and Rowe, B.M. 1974. Physical Anthropology. New York, McGraw-
Hill.
Sample Questions
1) What is physical anthropology and what are its aims and scope?
2) Briefly give the history of physical anthropology.
3) What are the different branches in physical anthropology? Give a brief outline
of each branch.
16
Definition and Scope
UNIT 2 RELATIONSHIP WITH OTHER
DISCIPLINES
Contents
2.1 Introduction
2.2 Interdisciplinary and Trandisciplinary Approaches
2.2.1 Forensic Science
2.2.2 Life Sciences
2.2.3 Medical Sciences
2.2.4 Earth Sciences
2.2.5 Human Biology
2.2.6 Environmental Sciences
2.2.7 Social Sciences
2.2.8 Human Engineering and Technology
2.2.9 Physical Sciences
2.3 Summary
Suggested Reading
Sample Questions
2.1 INTRODUCTION
In this unit, it will be our endeavour to know what does interdisciplinary and
trandisciplinary approaches mean with reference to physical anthropology. As
mentioned in the earlier unit that physical anthropology involves other disciplines
too, we will also explore in this unit the relationship of anthropology with forensic
science, life sciences, medical sciences, earth sciences, human biology,
environmental sciences, social sciences, human engineering and technology, and
physical sciences.
Physical anthropologist can make out whether the person was right or left-handed.
Observe carefully, there would be more muscle attachment on the bones on the
dominant side. A physical anthropologist can also be adjudging the injury suffered
by the deceased that is if ever the deceased injured or fractured a bone during his
lifetime and whether his death was aggressive. All these warning signs can be
determined by looking for signs of trauma which could possibly be stab marks,
marks on the skull, broken bones, and bullets or pellets in or near the body. A
physical anthropologist plays a decisive role in determining the time when the
individual died. This is evidenced by the amount of soft tissue that is still present
which actually is key to determining the time of death. It is established that the
females lose one pound of tissue a day during decomposition; while males loose
three pounds a day. Acidic soil hastens decomposition whereas the alkaline soil
hinders it. A good number of these such as age, sex, race, and height are class
characteristics, but some are individual characteristics such as trauma. Court
substantiates other evidences or supplements the authentication of other experts
along with forensic anthropological identification, to arrive at their verdict.
In the following units you will realise that anthropology can be credited to its
own strong theoretical and scientific foundations some of which are by far oriented
in medicine. The aim of anthropology is to demonstrate rationally what being
specifically human is in the most fundamental physiological functions, with
medical science defining the standards. This has led to the origin of a new
discipline-Medical Anthropology which incorporates both physical anthropology
and medical science.
20
2.2.4 Earth Sciences Relationship with Other
Disciplines
Earth science embraces the study of nature of structural pattern of the earth that
throws light on its various land forms, its waters, the air that engulfs it, how the
rocks are formed, the different strata of the earth and their formation and also
includes the geologic, hydrologic, and atmospheric sciences. The perspective of
Earth sciences is to recognise the present features and past evolution of the Earth
and to exploit this knowledge, wherever found appropriate, for the benefit of
humankind, the basic premise on which physical anthropology is based. It gives
us great deal of information about the series of events which occurred in the
distant past and through these evidences the oldest forms of life can be known
that prospered umpteenth number of years ago on earth. This achievement is
possible through the systematic study and analysis of the earth’s crusts and
different strata of earth bearing fossils as evidence, by employing geological
methodology. Not only has it held an invaluable contribution towards the
understanding of human evolution, but as well of various cultural stages of man
especially when the information on time sequence is crucial.
The physical surroundings which are inhabited by humans include the immediate
surface of the solid Earth along with the land beneath it and the water and air
above it. The facts of life were of concern to the early man rather than with
theories, and thus his survival depended on his ability to get metals from the
ground which enabled him in producing alloys, for example, bronze from copper
and tin, for tools and armor. He was also concerned to find adequate water supplies
for creating dwelling sites, and to predict the weather, which had an immense
bearing on human life in earlier times than it has today. These situations
correspond to the fundamentals of the three principal disciplines of the modern
earth sciences. While physical Anthropologists focuses on the evolution of early
man, the earth scientist concentrates on the raw material available to this early
man which either helped or slowed down their evolutionary process. Only when
one is aware of the marvelous complexity of the Earth, it would be easier to
appreciate how the world today is growing with environment around and how
humans are adapting to this changing earth. Each in its own premise, both physical
anthropology and earth science is a comfortable field and together they emphasise
on two important features, yet basic questions as to how did life on Earth begin,
and from what did man evolve remains a mystery.
Earth Sciences area of specialisation involves with the geologic history of the
earth, study of fossils and the fossil record (paleontology), the growing of
sedimentary strata accumulated typically over millions of years (stratigraphy),
and the isotopic chemistry and age dating of rocks (geochronology). These provide
vital input to anthropology.
Similar to physical Anthropology, the applied aspect of earth sciences deals with
practical applications beneficial to society. They engage in the study of fossil
fuels (oil, natural gas and coal); oil reservoirs; mineral deposits; geothermal energy
for electricity and heating; the structure and composition of bedrock for the setting
of bridges, nuclear reactors, roads, dams and skyscrapers and other buildings;
risk involving rock and mud avalanches, volcanic eruptions, earthquakes, and
the collapse of tunnels; and coastal, cliff, and soil erosion. Most of these would
have a direct impact on human beings hence come under global anthropology’s
focus.
21
History and Development of 2.2.5 Human Biology
Physical Anthropology
Physical anthropology as you have rightly understood is the study of the biological
perspectives of man. Undoubtedly its proximity to biological sciences is natural.
Let us see how it works, when we are trying to build up sequence of human
evolution, physical anthropologists’ basic instinct is to compare the biological
features of man and with other animals. Now-a-days human genetics forms the
integral part of physical anthropology. The focus of physical anthropology on
human heredity, factors relating to growth and development has boosted the
field of human biology.
Anthropology has its applications for future by exploring the conditions adjoining
a civilization’s endurance or disintegration with respect to its environments by
being appreciative of adaptations, weather, biological, behavioural or cultural in
reaction to environment. Environmental sciences point towards the adverse
conditions an environment can pose to its inhabitants and while anthropology, in
all its genuine concern points out the diversity of outstanding characteristics of
life supported by different cultures in different environments. The conservation
and understanding of its significance to human life and its endurance and hence
continued existence are other issues dealt by both disciplines.
Time and again it has been observed that anthropological social sciences give
meaning even to minutest difference in rather than deriving the general laws as
found in natural sciences. Not only this, it boasts of explaining individual cases
through more general principles, like in many fields of psychology. It is rather
difficult for anthropology just as in history to easily fit into one of these categories;
22
but then different branches of anthropology draw on one or more of these fields Relationship with Other
Disciplines
which concerns human. Essentially, the main objective of anthropology is to
grant a holistic account of humans and human nature which corroborates that
although anthropologists usually specialise in only one sub-field the biological,
linguistic, historic and cultural aspects of any problem are always kept into
consideration.
The quest for holism interested most anthropologists to study people in explicitly,
exploiting the biogenetic, archaeological and societal data. This would also take
into account direct observation of present-day customs which in turn correlates
the close relationship it shares with the social sciences. It is not unjustifiable to
believe that all human cultures as part of one large, developing global culture,
which is a basic contention of social scientists. These dynamic relationships,
between what can be observed on the ground, in contrast to what can be observed
by assembling many local observations still remains essential in anthropology,
be it cultural, biological, linguistic or archaeological.
2.3 SUMMARY
What an amazing concept interdisciplinary and transdisciplinary approach is
especially when physical anthropology is concerned. You just read how the
different disciplines join hands and work together for the benefit of mankind
and yet maintain their own identity. Is it not incredible the way anthropology
projects itself. The unit describes the interdisciplinary relation which involves
two or more academic disciplines that are usually considered distinct and also
trans–disciplinary; i.e., the research approach that crosses many disciplinary
boundaries to construct a holistic approach. The following chapter would
enlighten how we apply the knowledge of anthropology in practice.
Suggested Reading
Boaz, N.T and Almquist, A.J. 1999. Essentials of Biological Anthropology, New
Jersey, Prentice Hall.
Harrison, G.A., Weiner, J.S., Tanner, J.M. and Barnicot, N.A.1964. Human
Biology, Oxford University Press
Harrison, G.A, Weiner, J.S., Tanner, J.M., Barnicot, N.A. and Reynolds,V. 1977.
Human Biology, An Introduction to Human Evolution, Variation, Growth and
Ecology. Oxford University Press.
Stein, P. L. and Rowe, B.M. 1974. Physical Anthropology, New York, McGraw-
Hill.
Sample Questions
1) What do you understand by interdisciplinary and transdisciplinary approach?
2) Give examples of interdisciplinary and transdisciplinary approaches in
physical anthropology?
3) Explain the relationship of physical anthropology with special reference to
forensic science and medical science?
24
Relationship with Other
UNIT 3 APPLIED DIMENSIONS-I Disciplines
Contents
3.1 Introduction
3.2 Meaning of Applied Physical Anthropology
3.3 Applied Physical Anthropology
3.3.1 Designing Equipment
3.3.2 Forensic Anthropology
3.3.3 Epidemiology
3.3.4 Aging
3.3.5 Sports
3.3.6 Public Health
3.3.7 Nutritional Anthropology
3.4 Summary
Suggested Reading
Sample Questions
Learning Objectives
&
Once you have studied this unit, you will know:
Ø the meaning of applied physical anthropology;
Ø how academic knowledge is applied as applications; and
Ø the application of physical anthropology in designing equipment, forensic
anthropology, epidemiology, aging, sports, public health and nutritional
anthropology.
3.1 INTRODUCTION
In this unit, we will first discuss the meaning of applied physical anthropology
and how it was initiated. Following this, we will read through the anthropological
applications in the fields of designing equipment, forensic anthropology,
epidemiology, aging, sports, public health and nutritional anthropology.
Applied anthropology in the United States came into picture when the
anthropologists’ worked on disadvantaged people in other cultures and realised
the need for their improvement. In fact, today anthropologists are involved in
understanding and finding solution to the problems in their own society in an
endeavor to improve people’s lives. Currently, there is demand for applied
anthropologists to progressively increase their participation in earlier stages of
planning process and in helping in ventures by solving wide range of issues.
With the passage of time, our knowledge in the subject has seen phenomenal
increase, and this knowledge has culminated in designing many products for
applying it for the benefit and welfare of human use such as airplanes and
automobiles.
26
Applied Dimensions-I
3.3 APPLIED PHYSICAL ANTHROPOLOGY
The thrust of applied physical anthropology aims to construct an explanatory
framework for the many physical and behavioural traits of human species within
evolutionary and environmental contexts and to seek ways to maximize their
function. Here are some examples illustrating the aforementioned.
We all know that health and longevity of every individual to a great deal depends
on heredity and environment. Diseases reveal the array of triggering factors right
from inheritance of genes to the environment of surroundings they live in, which
means that disease can occur due to trait running in the family or the environment
a person lives in. The last two decades have seen momentum in the contributions
that anthropology may be useful to epidemiological study of health and disease.
This can be attributed to rise in chronic, non-infectious diseases as important
causes of morbidity and mortality during the 20th century. Chronic (long lasting),
non-infectious diseases (disease that may be caused by the environment) are
influenced by a number of lifestyle variables. These variables are by themselves
strongly influenced by social and cultural factors. The past decade witnessed
anthropologists and epidemiologists moving together beyond the “harmless
neglect” that characterised their prior relationship. Some of the most important
collaborations between epidemiology and anthropology concerns impact of
culture change and stress, social stratification and spread of various health risks
which have increased immensely. Anthropologists have disapproved and have
expanded epidemiological notions of risk and vulnerability. Now involving
multidisciplinary approaches, anthropologists and epidemiologists have invented
measures to increase the validity and reliability of their results. The working
together of anthropologists and epidemiologists due to their specialised field
area, ensures more nuanced and accurate descriptions of human behaviour and
more appropriate and effective interventions. The involvement of epidemiological
techniques is exploited for anthropological ends, because disease often spreads
along the framework of social structure.
3.3.4 Aging
The field of gerontology is amazingly diverse, warranting massive number of
investigations of physical anthropological issues in aging research. It has been
experienced that a good number of gerontology topics of actual and/or potential
interest are significantly important to physical anthropologists. It has been
observed that the physiological changes of aging include a varied mixture of
physical decline as would be expected from an evolutionary model. It has been
seen that the studies of the prehistoric aging accounts for the estimation of lifespan,
which in no way reflects rate of aging. Recent years have witnessed substantial
work relating to body composition and aging. These results give an evidence
towards the loss of lean tissue with age and relatively constant, though
redistribution of fat mass. Though osteoporosis is one of the major concerns in
females due to aging, tooth loss in both sexes is also witnessed. Biological age is
found to be associated with lifestyle, economic and nutritional status. These
factors can be of significance in divulging cause for variation in rates of aging
which in turn would be of vital importance. To answer these and many more
potential queries physical anthropologists is the best bet.
3.3.5 Sports
Sports, as history shows, has developed to be part of human culture as recreational
activity. We cannot deny the role of cultural aspect in sports, but the biological
aspect of human is considerably responsible for the performance in any sporting
event. The factors like body size, body proportions, physique and nutrition
influence the performance in any sporting event. Most of these traits are acquired
29
History and Development of through heredity but they are also influenced by environment to a substantial
Physical Anthropology
extent. Human psychological factors like motivation, training and nature also
play a vital role in moulding the sportive personality to a large extent. It becomes
quite obvious that human biological, cultural and psychological aspects are must
to understand the environment of sports, thus laying the foundation for
anthropological role in the field of sports.
There are number of factors that are responsible for the performance of an
individual in sports. These factors in turn are dependent on both genetic
constitution and environment. However, it is undisputable that genetics has a
greater role to play in the formation of a phenotype (observable characters arising
out of interaction between gene and environment in an individual). Phenotypic
variations in size, physique, body composition, metabolic powers, strength, speed
and skill, cardio-vascular adaptations are prevailing forces responsible behind a
sportsman’s feat. Environment to some extent can shape a genotype by way of
training and motivation. The goal of Kinanthropometry focuses on selecting the
fit genotypes which help individuals attain their fullest potentialities, that means
selecting those individuals who possess genetic constitution which is ideal for a
particular sport. It is not just muscular strength that is required for coordinating
body movements. But the responsibility of physical anthropologist lies in selecting
the players who have better potentialities in a particular sport than others; for
training and other external influence can change one’s morphological status only
within the narrow limits set by genotype. Physical anthropologist can also curtail
the financial implications by minimizing the expenditure on individuals who
because of their unfavorable anthropometric standards are less fit for a particular
sport. Physical anthropologist would exercise his discretion to choose an
individual ideal for sporting event. It is rather impossible to alter the capacity of
the genotype in order to maintain desirable levels of different bio-chemical
determinants. Thus, it is imperative to lay more emphasis on the genetically
determined morpho-physiological status of the individual to yield good results.
We realise that the techniques of Kinanthropometry enabled the anthropologists
to classify humans into different somatotype and suggest the right sport for them.
The composition of body plays important morphological characteristics essential
for sports. Body composition inclusive of muscular, skeletal, fatty tissues are
dependent on the environmental influence, sex, socio-economic conditions,
occupations, genetic make-up, nutrition and exercise.
31
History and Development of
Physical Anthropology 3.4 SUMMARY
This unit must have made an impression that academic knowledge can be best
utilised if we are able to use it practically. The different applied aspects of physical
anthropology, right from measurements to suit the equipment and furniture
designing, clothes, choice in sports, health status and in the health field, reflect
its wide spectrum. It is astoundingly fascinating to bring into practice the
knowledge of physical anthropology with other disciplines. This corroboration
has done wonders for the benefit of mankind. The unit to follow would take you
through the journey of physical anthropology along with genetics and am sure
you will realise the wonders of applied physical anthropology in understanding
mankind.
Suggested Reading
Boaz, N.T and Almquist, A.J. 1999. Essentials of Biological Anthropology, New
Jersey, Prentice Hall.
Harrison, G.A., Weiner, J.S, Tanner J.M. and Barnicot, N.A.1964. Human Biology,
1964, Oxford University Press
Harrison, G.A, Weiner, J.S., Tanner, J.M., Barnicot, N.A. and Reynolds,V. 1977.
Human Biology, An Introduction to Human Evolution, Variation, Growth and
Ecology. Oxford University Press.
Stein, P. L., and Rowe, B.M. 1974. Physical Anthropology, New York, McGraw-
Hill.
Sample Questions
1) What do you understand by the concept of applied physical/biological
anthropology?
2) Illustrate the application of physical anthropology in designing equipment,
sports and forensic anthropology.
3) Epidemiology, nutrition, aging and public health have applied component
of physical anthropology. How?
32
Applied Dimensions-I
UNIT 4 APPLIED DIMENSIONS-II
Contents
4.1 Introduction
4.2 Paternity Diagnosis
4.3 Genetic Counseling
4.4 Eugenics
4.5 DNA Technology and Its Use in Disease and Medicine
4.6 Summary
References
Suggested Reading
Sample Questions
Learning Objectives
&
It is expected that after reading, you would be able to understand the following
applications of Human Genetics:
Ø paternity diagnosis;
Ø genetic counseling and eugenics; and
Ø DNA technology and its use in disease and medicine
4.1 INTRODUCTION
Genetics is the name given to the study of heredity, the process by which
characteristics are passed from parents to offspring, so that all organisms including
human beings resemble their ancestors. The central concept of genetics is that
heredity is controlled by a vast number of factors called genes, which are discrete
physical particles present in all living organisms.
Since the present unit is on human genetics, the definition of human genetics is
presented here. Human genetics is concerned with genetically determined
resemblances and differences among human beings. In normal human being,
the nucleus of each cell contains 46 chromosomes, which comprises 23 pairs. Of
each of these chromosome pair, one chromosome is from father and one
chromosome is from mother i.e., only one member of each pair is handed on
through the reproductive cell (egg or sperm) to each child. Thus, each egg or
sperm has 23 chromosomes (McGraw-Hill Science & Technology Encyclopedia,
2005). Twenty two of the 23 chromosome pairs, i.e., the autosomes, are alike in
both the sexes, the other pair comprises of the sex chromosomes. A female has a
pair of XX and a male has XY chromosomes. Further, Human Genetics has
several applications, like Paternity diagnosis, genetic counseling and eugenics,
DNA technology and its use in disease and medicine are discussed below.
33
History and Development of
Physical Anthropology 4.2 PATERNITY DIAGNOSIS
Paternity Diagnosis helps to establish genetic proof whether a man is the biological
father of an individual or not. This paternity test is carried out by using DNA
analysis. The DNA analysis through DNA fingerprinting offers a more reliable
way to determine the genetic parent. Before DNA fingerprinting came into
existence, blood group polymorphisms like ABO, MN and Rh systems were
most widely used. But using these blood group polymorphisms, a particular
person can be excluded as the parent of a child. The exclusion of parentage can
be determined with certainty.
But to determine parentage, DNA analysis is the most advanced and accurate
technology. This paternity test compares a child’s DNA pattern with that of the
alleged father to check for evidence of this inheritance. The DNA fingerprinting
technique assures the probability of parents to more than 99.9% if the alleged
father is biologically related and the probability is 0% when the alleged father is
not biologically related to the child.
Source: www.protist.biology.washington.edu
34
DNA Finger Printing: This is also known as DNA typing or Genetic Applied Dimentions-II
Fingerprinting.
After knowing the DNA structure, we now briefly familiarise ourselves with the
procedure adopted in DNA finger printing:
DNA samples can be extracted from blood, semen, hair roots, bone or saliva.
The extracted DNA is then treated with restriction enzymes, which cuts the DNA
into smaller fragments by cutting at specific sites. This DNA is then amplified
by the technique of Polymerase chain reaction (PCR). By using alkaline chemicals
this double stranded DNA splits into single stranded DNA. The DNA fragments
are then subjected to agarose gel electrophoresis. The DNA bands so formed are
transferred to nylon membrane. This is treated with a radioactively-labelled DNA
probe which binds to complemental DNA sequences on the membrane. The excess
DNA probe is then washed off. The radioactive DNA pattern is transferred to
X-ray film by direct exposure. When developed, the resultant pattern is the DNA
finger print.
Genetic screening
Genetic counseling is essentially a communications process that informs
prospective parents about the nature of genetic disorders, about the risk of their
35
History and Development of having a genetically defective child, and about the options available to them in
Physical Anthropology
dealing with that risk. Or else they can opt to cope with the care of an existing
genetically handicapped child. Genetic screening, in contrast, is a routine
diagnostic procedure devised to detect those who are carriers of, or who are
themselves affected by a hereditary disease. Genetic screening applies to
populations rather than to individuals.
After genetic screening, if both the parents are heterozygous for a genetic disease
and the genotypes of both the prospective parents become known, then it is
easier to work out the probability of their child (if they decide to have one)
inheriting the disease. This can be done through amniocentesis about two months
after conception; i.e., in amniocentesis; the cultured fetal cells are used for
determining their karyotype, levels of the critical enzymes and the restriction
patterns of DNA. Such an antenatal diagnosis is now available for several genetic
diseases and for a variety of chromosomal defects. Such a diagnosis can help
the parents to opt for premature termination of abnormal fetus, if they so decide.
Genetic counseling and antenatal diagnosis provides definite relief to the possible
parents ‘at risk’ and thereby reduce the frequency of genetically defective
individuals in the population. However, it is unlikely that these measures would
eliminate the deleterious alleles from a population. This is so because most genetic
defects are recessive and heterozygotes for such alleles. Thus, even after a total
ban on reproduction by the homozygotes for such recessive alleles, they would
remain in the population through the heterozygotes, therefore, even such an
extreme selection would lead to only a slow decline in their frequency. Further,
it is not likely that all the couples in any society will willingly submit themselves,
at least in the foreseeable future, to these procedures. But genetic counseling has
become a routine aspect of medical practice in most developed countries.
It has been advocated that defective genes may be corrected through sophisticated
genetic techniques either during the early stages of embryo development (embryo
therapy) or in specific tissues of the adult patient (patient therapy); such an
approach is referred to as genetic surgery. Embryo therapy involves
• In vitro fertilization of egg
• Production of several copies of the normal allele of the defective gene
• Introduction of this DNA into the zygote or in the cells of the developing
embryo and
• Integration of DNA, preferably in place of the defective allele, so that it may
function normally.
The aim of patient therapy is to introduce the normal gene into the critical tissue
of the patient that is affected by a genetic disease, i.e., the tissue where the
concerned gene is required to express itself the most, e.g., pancreas in the case of
diabetes. The steps involved in patient therapy are similar to those in embryo
therapy. But in this case, cells from the concerned tissues have to be treated in
vitro to correct their genetic defects and then reintroduced into the tissue where
they may function normally. Techniques for isolation, identification and
36
multiplication of many human genes are now available, and for many others Applied Dimentions-II
they are likely to be developed soon. The techniques for gene transfer in eukaryotes
are being refined and it may not be a great problem in the near future.
A suggestion has also been made to use highly specific chemical mutagens that
will correct the defect in the concerned gene. Such a directed mutagenesis,
however, is a dream that may be more difficult to fulfill for the patient and embryo
therapies through DNA mediated genetic modifications. Genetic screening and
counseling may also lead to certain problems. The cases of mistaken paternity,
the problem of confidentiality, delayed counseling are important among them.
4.4 EUGENICS
The term Eugenics was introduced by Francis Galton in 1883. It refers to the
improvement of a population by selection of only its ‘best’ specimens for breeding.
This has been practiced both by plant and animal breeders since ancient times.
The idea of eugenics was to improve society by screening out and sterilizing
people diagnosed as genetically unfit. Those with desirable genes would be given
incentives to reproduce. Regardless of the reasons in support of sterilization,
restricting an individual’s ability to reproduce is viewed as a violation of their
constitutional rights. The science of eugenics can also be defined as a science of
the well born, improving the inborn qualities of race and obtaining the better
heritage of judicious breeding.
b) To fund the fit: Most of the well gifted persons in a society would like to
lead a well planned and relaxed life. In order to lead a comfortable life and
to avoid unnecessary difficulties in nurturing the children, they wish to have
small number of children. Thus, the selected young men and women who
have best eugenic value should be encouraged to have more children.
H.J.Muller (1890–1967) has suggested that the persons who have best
eugenic value should increase their family size. The persons who have best
eugenic value besides increasing their family size can otherwise act as father
to many more children, and this is possible through artificial insemination.
The sperms and eggs of stupendous people should be stored for potential
use. 37
History and Development of c) Fitness and Education: In a society, the people should be educated about the
Physical Anthropology
basic ideology of wellbeing, ecology, human genetics, eugenics and sex.
Hence, the children should be properly instructed about basic laws of health
and they should be confident to develop a healthy, physically and mentally
sound body. The children ignorant about the details of sex may do further
harm to the society than others. Therefore, there is a need to have sex
education to avoid unwanted behaviour which is not desirable for our country.
Negative Eugenics: Faulty germplasm from the people can be eliminated with
the help of following measures:
i) Sexual disconnection: Colour blindness, night blindness, hemophilia, etc.
are some of the sex-linked diseases possessed by the defective persons and
these may be regulated by dominant or recessive genes. The defective traits
in the population can be checked by sexual disconnection and keeping them
away and separated from the public.
ii) Sterilization of the defective: Persons who have defective traits may be
advised to go for sterilization. Through sterilization, without disturbing any
of his usual functions, we can withdraw a person from his power of
reproduction.
iii) Immigration and its control: The unwanted or faulty genes of different races
and nationalities may intermingle with the normal germplasm of the people
38
during immigration. The persons with unwanted hereditary traits must not
be permitted to migrate from one place to another. Some laws should be Applied Dimentions-II
formulated to control the immigration of those persons who have defective
genetic traits.
iv) Marriage regulation: The affluent or well placed persons (who, still, may
have numerous faulty genetic characters), are more favored for marriages
than those who have eugenically sound hereditary traits but have no money.
Because of not having money the eugenically sound persons agree for
marriage with the genetically defective people. These people fail to reach
the uppermost status in the society due to lack of opportunities.
i) DNA Probes: DNA probes are short segments of DNA that distinguish
corresponding sequences in DNA and hence permit recognition of specific
DNA sequences. This technique is mainly helpful in diagnosis. DNA probes
can hybridize with specific DNA sequences and permit the recognition of
specific parasites. Probes resultant by recombinant DNA methods are
extensively used in prenatal detection of disease: for example, in detecting
genetic disorders like cystic fibrosis, Huntington disease, sickle-cell anemia
etc. In a few cases, probes resultant from the gene itself is used and, in extra
cases, restriction fragment length polymorphisms genetically associated to
the disease gene are engaged. If the disease gene itself, or a region close to
it in the chromosome, differs from the normal chromosome in the positions
of one or more cleavage sites for restriction enzymes, then these differences
can be detected with southern blot i.e. with the use of cloned DNA from the
region as the probe. The genotype of the fetus can, therefore, be determined
since the restriction fragments present in its DNA. These techniques are
very responsive and can be carried out as soon as tissue from the fetus-or
still from the placenta – can be obtained. DNA probes have been developed
for Leishmania, Trypnosoma, plasmodium, Schistosoma, Wuchereria and
some additional human parasites. DNA probes can also be used to recognise
viruses which were previously hard to culture.
ii) Gene Therapy: The hereditary disease in particular can be treated with Gene
therapy. Gene Therapy is the insertion of genes into an individual’s cells to
treat a disease. Gene therapy normally aims to supplement a faulty mutant
allele with a functional one. In the majority gene therapy studies, a normal
gene is inserted into the genome to supplement an abnormal disease causing
gene. A carrier, called a vector, must be used to deliver the therapeutic gene
to the patient’s target cells. Presently, the most widespread vector is a virus
that has been genetically changed to carry normal human DNA. The vector
unloads its genetic material containing the therapeutic human gene into the
39
History and Development of target cell. The creation of an efficient protein product from the therapeutic
Physical Anthropology
gene restores the target cell to a normal state.
iii) Production of hormones and Proteins: Using DNA technique, the genes
responsible for the production of hormones and proteins can be introduced
into bacteria by vectors. These genetically changed bacteria produce greater
amounts of these substances. The hormones like insulin, human growth
hormones, somatostatin, erythropoietin etc. are being produced using this
DNA technique. The most important application of genetic engineering is
the production of large quantities of particular proteins that are otherwise
hard to acquire. Urokinase, are industrially produced today using this DNA
technique.
This DNA technique is also used in the diagnosis of AIDS diagnosis, prenatal
diagnosis, understanding the molecular basis of diseases like sickle cell anaemia,
thalassemia, familial hypercholesterolemia and cystic fibrosis.
4.6 SUMMARY
Genetics is primarily concerned with the understanding of biological properties
that are transmitted from parents to offspring. Human genetics is the study of the
inherited characters of human beings. The applications of human genetics are
many; for instance, paternity diagnosis, genetic counseling, eugenics, DNA
technology in disease and medicine. DNA profiling popularly known as DNA
fingerprinting is used to establish paternity and distant relationship by tracing
their ancestors. Genetic counseling is a process that seeks to assist affected
individuals and other individuals at risk of getting an inherited condition; it also
helps to understand the nature of the genetic disorder, its transmission and the
options available for their management and family planning. Eugenics deals with
the application of the laws of genetics for the improvement of human race. The
recombinant DNA technology has revolutionized modern biology. It is used in
the efficient production of useful proteins, derivation of DNA probes for diagnosis
40
and in the production of vaccines. Gene therapy is another important application Applied Dimentions-II
of human genetics, which is useful in introduction of functional genes in
individuals suffering from non-functioning of some of their genes. Some
infectious diseases, AIDS diagnosis, prenatal diagnosis, molecular basis of
diseases, like sickle cell anaemia, thalassemia, familial hypercholesterolemia
and cystic fibrosis are also diagnosed through this DNA technique.
References
Fraser, F.C. 1974. Excerpts from “Genetic Counseling”. The American Journal
of Human Genetics 636-659.
Suggested Reading
Cederbaum, S.D. 1984. Recombinant DNA in Medicine. West J Med. 141:210-
222
Griffiths, A.J.F., Miller, J.H., Suzuki, D.T., Lewontin, R.C. and Gelbart, W.M.
1993. An Introduction to Genetic Analysis. USA W.H. Freeman and Company.
Gupta, V., Singh, J., Bala, R. and Magazine, R. 2003. Recombinat DNA Therapy
in Medicine. JK practitioner. 10:315-318.
Hartl, D.L. Basic Genetics. 1991. Boston, USA Jones and Bartlett Publishers.
Verma, P.S. and Agarwal, V.K. 1999. Cell Biology, Genetics, Molecular Biology,
Evolution and Ecology. New Delhi. S. Chand company Ltd.
Uhlmann, W.R, Schuette, J.L and Yashar, B.M. 2009. A Guide to Genetic
Counseling. New Jersey. Wiley-Blackwell.
Sample Questions
1) Define Human Genetics and briefly discuss the applications of Human
genetics
2) What is DNA Finger Printing? Explain its application in Paternity Diagnosis.
3) What is genetic counseling? Explain its process
4) Write a note on DNA technology in disease and medicine
5) Write short notes on the following
a) Eugenics
b) DNA Finger printing
c) Genetic counseling
41
MANI-002
PHYSICAL
Indira Gandhi
ANTHROPOLOGY
National Open University
School of Social Sciences
Block
3
PRIMATE STUDY
UNIT 1
Living Primates 5
UNIT 2
Primate Behaviour 24
UNIT 3
Phylogeny of Living Primates and Primate Anatomy 42
Expert Committee
Professor I. J. S. Bansal Professor S.Channa
Retired, Department of Human Biology Department of Anthropology
Punjabi University University of Delhi, Delhi
Patiala
Professor P. Vijay Prakash
Professor K. K. Misra Department of Anthropology
Director Andhra University
Indira Gandhi Rashtriya Manav Visakhapatnam
Sangrahalaya, Bhopal
Dr. Nita Mathur
Professor Ranjana Ray Associate Professor
Retired, Department of Anthropology, Faculty of Sociology
Calcutta University School of Social Sciences
Kolkata Indira Gandhi National Open University
Maidan Garhi, New Delhi
Professor P. Chengal Reddy
Retired, Department of Anthropology Dr. S. M. Patnaik
S V University, Tirupati Associate Professor
Department of Anthropology
Professor R. K. Pathak
University of Delhi, Delhi
Department of Anthropology
Panjab University Dr. Manoj Kumar Singh
Chandigarh Assistant Professor
Department of Anthropology
Professor A. K. Kapoor
University of Delhi, Delhi
Department of Anthropology
University of Delhi, Delhi Faculty of Anthropology
SOSS, IGNOU
Professor V.K.Srivastava
Principal, Hindu College Dr. Rashmi Sinha, Reader
University of Delhi, Delhi Dr. Mitoo Das, Assistant Professor
Professor Sudhakar Rao Dr. Rukshana Zaman, Assistant Professor
Department of Anthropology Dr. P Venkatramana, Assistant Professor
University of Hyderabad, Hyderabad Dr. K. Anil Kumar, Assistant Professor
Programme Coordinator: Dr. Rashmi Sinha, SOSS, IGNOU, New Delhi
Course Coordinator: Dr. Rashmi Sinha, SOSS, IGNOU, New Delhi
Content Editor Language Editor
Professor V. Rami Reddy Mrs. Narinder Jit Kaur
Retired, Department of Anthropology Retired, Associate Professor in English
S V University, Tirupati Government Mohindra College, Patiala
Blocks Preparation Team
Unit Writers
Professor P. K. Seth (Unit 1 & 2) Professor R. P. Srivastava (Unit 3 )
Retired, Deptt. of Anthropology, Retired, Deptt. of Anthropology
University of Delhi, Delhi University of Lucknow, Lucknow.
Authors are responsible for the academic content of this course as far as the copy right issues are concerned.
Introduction
Man is primate of the primates with a unique place in the animal kingdom due to
most distinguishable primate characteristics. He and the non-human primates of
apes and monkeys descended from a common ancestor. The non-human primates
particularly the apes are our close relatives. Primates as multi-cellular animals
are mammals with a rather generalised anatomy. Two categories can be
distinguished among the primates: prosimians or lower monkeys (tree-shrews,
lemurs, lorises and tarsiers), anthoropoids or higher primates (New World or
platyrrhine monkeys, Old World or Catarrhine monkeys and man). There are
many characteristics which are common to both the groups of primates. Humans
are closely related to great apes as shown by anatomical- molecular-behavioural
evidences inspite of many typical characteristics in which they differ from each
other. The ancestral or basal primate stock separated from the common eutherian
stock, emerged as an independent order and evolved as prosimians during
Palaeocene of 70-60 myr BP, as cuboids and pongids of Oligocene of 40-20 myr
BP, and as protohominids during Pliocene of 12-4 myr BP. Squirrel-like, simple
prosimian primates made their first appearance, followed by their adaptive
radiation till the Oligocene time when the New World monkey and the anthropoid
apes came to the scene. The predominance of the latter continued during the
Miocene epoch. During the Miocene and Pliocene epochs the Pliopithicus-
Proconsul-Dryopithecus-Ramapithicus groups made remarkable progress in the
Old World. Of all the classifications of primates, the one by G G Simpson seems
to be most convincing.
The human behaviour including that of the extinct hominids can be best
understood and interpreted from the studies of non-human primates in their natural
setting. This has to be gauged from the findings of field investigations among
the non-human primates on their activity pattern, social organisation, mating
patterns, reproduction, parental care, territoriality, communication, life span,
dominance and aggression, communication, social behaviour, sexual behaviour,
and so on. These behavioural aspects have been examined among such non-
human primates as rhesus monkeys, baboons, presbytis, and great apes. The
rhesus monkey helped in the discovery of Rh factor, which has been found to be
hereditary in Homo sapiens. The great apes have been found to be similar to
humans in anatomical, physiological and behavioural traits.
4
Living Primates
UNIT 1 LIVING PRIMATES
Contents
1.1 Introduction
1.2 Definition
1.3 Characteristics
1.4 Evolutionary Trends
1.5 Classification
1.6 Distribution
1.7 Adaptation
1.8 Summary
1.9 Glossary
References
Suggested Reading
Sample Questions
1.1 INTRODUCTION
That modern MAN, Homo sapiens sapiens, is a primate and a close cousin of
monkeys and apes cannot be denied. Yet, few people understand the relationship
between them. Neither man nor the non-human primates can be defined on the
basis of one or two features. They can be best defined on the basis of the general
pattern displayed by them or by the complexes of their characteristics. So, what
do we mean by the term primate (as this term also includes human beings)?
Unless we know this, it would be difficult for us to proceed with our discussion
on living primates, “our close relatives”.
Carl von Linnaeus, a Swedish botanist, chose the term ‘primate’(meaning first
or the highest amongst all), for the specific order Primates of Animal Kingdom,
Class Mammalia, including humans and the nonhuman primates, i.e., lemurs,
tree-shrews, lorises, aye-ayes, pottos, bush babies, tarsiers, monkeys and apes.
From a little shrew like ancestor, these animals are dominating this kingdom.
The evolutionary story of the primates – beginning from the prosimians at
one end of the spectrum to the highly complex man at the other end – is
now revealed in an ever new and fascinating manner.
5
Primate Study Within the Class Mammalia, there is tremendous diversity — from tiny shrews
to gigantic whales, from flying bats to burrowing badgers, from pronghorns to
sloths, from opossums to artists and engineers and mammalogists.
1.2 DEFINITION
Primates are multicellular animals (metazoans), possess an internal skeleton
(chordata), segmented vertebral column (vertebrates), maintain constant body
temperatures within a few degrees like other mammals and birds (homeotherms),
are mammals for they possess a complex of traits such as mammary glands,
suckling of young ones, hairy body, give birth to young ones, warm blooded,
heterodontism, have a single dental arch which articulates with the squamosal
bone of the skull, have the thorax separated from the abdomen by a muscular
diaphragm and are diphyodont. The primates have retained rather a primitive
and generalised anatomy, which lacks many specialisations; they are not radically
changed from earliest mammals, especially those ancestral to primates.
Primates represent the 7th largest order (including both living and extinct) with
51 genera and 168 species. Of these, 16 genera and 50 species are in the New
World. This order is often considered to be the most important of the mammals.
No one denies that modern man is a primate yet few people understand why man
is classified with animals such as the tree shrew, loris and aye-aye. Most nonhuman
primates occur in tropical areas. Because of his (Man’s) cultural and biological
plasticity, man adapts to most biomes.
None of these traits characterise all members of the order Primate. There are
always exceptions to singular traits. Even today the classic definition of the order
Primate propounded by Mivart in 1873 holds good. Primates cannot be easily
defined as they are characterised by a combination of primitive features and
progressive trends; for instance, primates can be defined as under:
1.3 CHARACTERISTICS
There are no distinguishing features which characterise them all – except a
negative one, i.e. their lack of specialisation. Primates are distinguished from
other mammals by one or more of the following traits: unspecialised structure,
specialised behaviour, a short muzzle, comparatively poor sense of smell,
prehensile five-digit hands and feet possessing flat nails instead of claws, acute
vision with depth perception due to forward-facing eyes, a large brain, and
prolonged pre- and post-natal development. Most species bear a single young
and live in troops headed by a male. They include the prosimians or lower monkeys
lemurs, lorises and tarsiers and the anthropoids or higher primates (New World
monkeys, Old World monkeys, and apes and man). Primates range in size from
the Mouse Lemur, which weighs only 30 grams (1.1 oz) to the Mountain Gorilla
weighing 200 kilograms (440 lb). Monkeys range in size from the Pygmy
Marmoset measuring 140 to 160 millimeters (5½–6½) long (including tail) and
6
weighing 120 to 140 grams (4–5 oz), to the male Mandrill of about one metre Living Primates
(3.3 ft) length and having a weight of 35 kilograms (77 lb). Some are arboreal
(living on trees) while others live in the savanna. Their diet differs amongst
various species. It may contain any of the following: fruits, leaves, seeds, nuts,
flowers, eggs and small animals (including insects and spiders).
In the past, tarsiers (commonly called as owl monkey) have been grouped together
with the strepsirhines as prosimians, because they retain many primitive features
which are absent in higher primates. Tarsiers are crepuscular and have very large
eyes unlike in any other primate. They have adapted to a specialised lifestyle as
vertical clingers and leapers. However, tarsiers share a number of distinctive
specialisations with anthropoids that suggest that they are more closely related
to each other than to the strepsirhines. Hence, tarsiers and anthropoids (higher
primates) are classified together as haplorhines.
The following are the main characteristics of the primates:
v The anatomy of Primates enables them to maintain semi-erect and erect
postures and locomotor patterns.
v They have pentadactyl hands and feet (a very primitive trait).
v They have flattened nails on each of their digits excepting tree shrews.
v They possess a relatively low density of body hairs (hair instead of fur).
v They have fewer tactile hairs.
v The olfactory area of their brain is reduced. They thus have an increased
dominance of vision over smell, and reduction in the length of the (nose)
snout
v The visual area of their brain is expanded.
v Their eye sockets are completely encircled by a bony ridge. Their eyes are
more forwardly directed on the skull (for binocular vision) suggesting
development of a stereoscopic vision.
v They show an increased reliance on stereoscopic vision at the expense of
smell (the dominant sensory system in majority of the mammals).
v Some primates have developed a three color vision.
v They have pseudo-and true-opposability of the thumb and the great toe (i.e.,
the two function, to a varying degree, independently of the other digits.
They are widely separated from them); usually they have both these digits,
on hands and feet, opposable for grasping purposes.
v Some have prehensile tails.
v They possess relatively larger and complex brains.
v Most female primates have a simple unicornuate uterus.
v They are placental mammals with longer gestation period and generally
give birth to only one or two infants at a time.
v They have year round fertility.
v Their infants have prolonged physical and emotional dependence upon their
mothers, i.e. they have a longer period of infant dependency and parenting.
v They have prolonged growth and maturation periods and long life spans.
7
Primate Study v They display a reduction in the number of teeth, i.e. they have an incisor
and premolar less in each half of the upper and lower jaws unlike those in
the primitive placental mammals.
v They have retained a primitive clavicle.
v They possess a separate radius and an ulna in the forearm and a separate
tibia and a fibula in the lower leg (excepting tarsier).
v They show reduction in the length of their external tail.
v They possess a shortened vertebral column.
Prosimians, the simplest and the lowliest of the primates, have comb-like incisors
and canines (lower front teeth forming a toothcomb; also known as procumbent
lower incisors and canines); and a specialised claw on their back feet for grooming
whereas monkeys use their hands.
Platyrrhines display a variety of quadrupedal locomotor types ranging from
squirrel like scrambling to leaping and forelimb suspension. Atelines and capuchin
monkeys are distinctive among primates in having a specialised prehensile tail
that can grasp around branches for extra support. Their dental formula (DF) is
2.1.3.3. Though this DF is similar to that of prosimians yet the typical prosimian
tooth comb is absent in them.
Strepsirhines have elongated and forwardly projecting lower front teeth that form
a toothcomb. These teeth are used for grooming the fur and for obtaining resins
and gums from trees as source of food. The digits of the hands and feet bear
flattened nails, rather than claws, excepting the second toe, which has a sharp
toilet claw for grooming. They also have a moist, naked rhinarium and cleft
upper lip (similar to the wet noses of dogs). Most strepsirhines are nocturnal and
have large eyes. Their brain size is relatively small and the snout tends to be
longer than the haplorhines.
The Old World monkeys include some terrestrial species such as the baboons
and man, whereas the New World monkeys are exclusively arboreal. Some New
World monkeys have a prehensile tail for grasping. Cercopithecids or the Old
World monkeys, and the hominoids or apes and humans are distinguished from
Ceboidea in the development of a tube like (rather than ring like) tympanic bone
to support the eardrum (refer table below):
Ceboidea Cercopithecoidea Hominoidea
Platyrrhines Catarrhines Apes (Pongidae)
New World Monkeys Old World Monkeys Man
(NWM) (OWM) ( Hominidae)
Flat nosed Sharp nosed Sharp nosed
Broad nasal septum Narrow nasal septum Narrow nasal septum
D.F. 2.1.3.3; an D.F. 2.1.2.3 D.F. 2.1.2.3
extra premolar
Bilophodont Dryopithecus pattern of
lower molar
Incisors broad and Incisors broad and
spatulate spatulate
Prehensile tail Tail never prehensile Tail altogether absent
8
Living Primates
MAN APES
Orthograde locomotion Pronograde locomotion
Great toe largest Great toe not the largest
Forward positioning of foramen Foramen magnum backwardly directed
magnum
Strong development of mastoid Mastoid processes not well developed
processes
Vertebral column has moved Vertebral column dorsally placed
anteriorly into thorax
Dorsal shift of shoulder joints Shoulder joints and scapula laterally
and scapula placed
Largest brain Small brain
Marked reduction in the size of Large face and lower jaw
face and lower jaw
Everted chin Receding chin
Forward positioning of eyes Obliquely laterally directed eyes
Post-canine length less More post canine length
Canine size same as other teeth Canine protrudes out of the tooth rows
During the Palaeocene and Eocene epochs (from about 66.4 million to about
36.6 million years ago) early in the Tertiary period, more advanced primates
appeared. During these epochs, an explosive primate radiation took place which
dwindled in the Oligocene (Oligo = small). Lemuroids, Tarsioids and Platyrrhines
have been recognised in the Palaeocene and Eocene epochs of America, Europe,
Egypt and Burma. The Adapidae family represented by the Lemuriformes, was
10
the most widespread one as per the fossil record. The Tarsiiformes are known Living Primates
from one family, the Omomyidae. The characteristic tarsioid (tarsier-like)
specialisation of the skull and hind limbs were already well advanced in the
known fossil forms, but some of the European genera have some structures
indicating relationships with the early monkeys.
The New World witnessed the appearance of three-fourth of the primates. Their
development and human origins probably took place in the Old World.
Amphipithecus, implying both ways an ape, a platyrrhini, found in the Eocene
of Burma is considered to be ancestral to the Parapithecus (Para = near) of
Egypt. Generally speaking, there is hardly any fossil evidence of the Eocene
ancestors of the Old World monkeys and apes. Thus, the Eocene epoch terminated
after about 30 million years of primate evolution with lemur-like and tarsier-like
forms.
Later, during the Oligocene epoch (36.6 to 23.7 million years ago) which followed,
there came into existence primitive monkeys and exceedingly primitive
anthropoid apes. The Fayum deposits of the Oligocene epoch in Egypt yielded
fossil remains of Propliopithecus (Pro = before, Plio = more), the earliest
anthropoid ape on record (they had small brains, long snouts, skulls resembling
those of monkeys or lemurs and their teeth like those of modern apes; they lived
in trees and had tails) and Parapithecus (known from some lower jaws 30 mya),
a very small sized (squirrel-like) and earliest Old World Monkey on record having
a generalised Tarsioid appearance. Gregory regarded Propliopithecus as a
primitive gibbon and Parapithecus as a primitive monkey. These fossils are
distinguished by traits normally necessary for adaptation to arboreal life: grasping
extremities, nails instead of claws, pentadactyly, an opposable thumb and a big
toe, forearm consisting of ulna and radius, reduced snout, forwardly directed
eyes and orbits closed from behind, and enlarged visual centers.
The Miocene fossil forms of Asian and African apes suggest that the Asian apes
formed a distinct category which diversified in Asia and Southeast Europe by
fourteen million years ago (e.g., Sivapithecus, Ramapithecus, etc). There were
other significant fossils reported from the Miocene of Europe, Egypt and Africa.
The lower Miocene epoch is often referred to as the ‘Age of Apes’. Skeletal
11
Primate Study remains from Africa were classified into three major groups: Proconsul (a non-
specialised ape), Sivapithecus (a transitional form between the anthropoids and
man), and Limnopithecus (an early type of gibbon).
From Europe, the fossil material of Pliopithecus was recovered. The name means
that the individual is thought out as ancestral to the modern gibbons. A small-
sized primitive gibbon (Prohylobate) frequented Egypt during the Miocene. This
ape was slightly bigger in size than the Propliopithecus. This epoch, thus, saw
the rise of the generalised apes of large size which are regarded as the offshoots
of Propliopithecus of Oligocene.
The Proconsul groups are known from the early Miocene period of Africa. It
includes three species— Proconsul africanus, Proconsul nyanzae, and Proconsul
major—as well as Rangwapithecus gordoni and several other smaller-bodied
apes. The second group of Middle Miocene apes (all from East Africa) is
represented by the Oreopithecidae, which includes Nyanzapithecus, the large
Afropithecus, and two species of Kenyapithecus.
Dryopithecinae
These fossil remains represent the most interesting and the controversial part of
the primate evolution. The entire subfamily Dryopithecinae has been named after
a mandible (Dryopithecus fontani) by Lartet. Similar finds have been reported
from China, northern India, Africa and parts of Europe, viz., France, Germany,
and Spain. The dryopithecines are a very heterogeneous group representing a
stage of primate evolution rather than a single phylum and its branches. Numerous
species of Dryopithecus have been described. They show considerable variation
in their dental anatomy, some suggesting closeness to the chimpanzee, some to
the orangutans and yet others to the gorilla.
This ape complex is represented by teeth, jaw fragments, cranial and long bones
(humerus shaft, ulna and a femur). The humerus bone, with its both ends missing,
was reported from France and uncertainly labeled as that belonging to
Dryopithecus fontani. A complete femur found in Germany has been assigned to
Paidopithex (Boule and Vallois, 1957). These long bones are gibbon-sized.
Dryopithecinae fossils range in size from animals as big as gibbons to as large or
larger than the modern gorillas. They are distinguished from the Hominidae on
the basis of their dentition alone.
The incisors are small and more vertical compared to those of the Ponginae.
Canines are larger than those in the Hominidae. The lower premolar is sectorial
in shape. The molars usually increase in size within the series M1<M2<M3.
Their characteristic ‘Y-5’ cusp pattern is not commonly found in modern man.
This suggests that the pattern is of fossil origin. The primordial crown pattern of
human lower molars is comprised of set of three grooves in the form of ‘Y’ lying
12
on its side with its tail pointing forwards and its two arms pointing to the rear. In Living Primates
each obtuse angle are stationed two cusps, and in the acute angle, a fifth cusp is
located forming the Y-5 pattern (Coon, 1963). In the teeth of modern human
beings, the molar crown patterns have been simplified in two ways: the groove
pattern has changed from ‘Y’ to a simple ‘+’ and the number of cusps has reduced
from five to four or even less (three or two).
Dryopithecus
Dryopithecus, a genus of extinct apelike animals, is representative of a group of
small, generalised apes that contains the ancestors of both the modern apes and
humans. Although Dryopithecus has been known by a variety of names based
upon fragmentary material found over a widespread area including Europe, Africa,
and Asia, it appears that only a single genus is represented. Dryopithecus is
found as fossils in Miocene and Pliocene deposits (23.7 to 1.6 million years old)
and apparently originated in Africa.
Ramapithecus
The first Ramapithecus fossils (fragments of an upper jaw and some teeth) were
discovered in 1932 in fossil deposits of the Siwalik Hills of Northwestern India.
No significance was attached to these fossils until 1960, when Elwyn Simons of
Yale University began to study them and ‘fit’ the jaw fragments together (refer
Figure below). Based on his observations of the shape of the jaw and dentition
¯ which were transitional between those of apes and humans, Simons advanced
the theory that Ramapithecus represented the first step in the evolutionary
divergence of humans from the common hominoid stock that produced modern
apes and humans.
Ramapithecus (from the Middle and Late Miocene epochs) represents the earliest
known hominid and its existence establishes from that of the African apes fifteen
million years ago. This basic tenet is now regarded as questionable, even if an
alternative ‘correct’ answer cannot be provided. Lewis (1933) first described the
fossil remains of a fragment of an upper jaw from Haritalyangar in the Siwalik
Hills (India) and christened it Ramapithecus brevirostris. This fragment has a
wide curving jaw with an arched palate (man-like feature) and was so named as
it resembled the Indian God ‘Lord Rama’. It has a short snout, a feature
characteristic of the apes.
Gigantopithecus
Gigantopithecus mandible
Gigantopithecus remains from the Siwaliks of India have been dated as ca. 6.3
mya. Hominid features of Gigantopithecus bilaspurensis from the Indian Siwaliks
(for instance, marked reduction of the front teeth, relatively small canine and
tooth wear) suggest that hominid-like tendencies were already underway some 5
to 10 mya in the Pliocene period. Being considerably older than the Chinese
Gigantopithecus, these remains provide newer insights into the initial stages of
differentiation of hominoids and man-like primates. These Siwalik finds were
found associated with antelopes and primitive elephants further indicating that
they inhabited open woodland areas. It can also be argued that the hominoids
were displaced from India and after the emergence of MAN, they made a re-
entry? The Siwalik hominoids probably used ad-hoc tools to compensate for the
reduction of the anterior dentition, exposure to forest ecology accompanied by
dietary change and emergence of incipient bipedality (Simons and Pilbeam, 1965).
14
Living Primates
1.5 CLASSIFICATION
There are numerous classifications of primates suggested by various scientists.
However, the classification of Simpson (1945), based on their morphology, is
widely accepted, and is given below:
Taxonomic Groups including Members
category primates
Kingdom Animalia Multicellular (have sexual reproduction,
nervous system, differentiated tissues)*
Phylum Chordata Animals with vertebral column
Nonchordata Animals without vertebral column
Class Aves Animals with feathers, wings formed by
forelimbs
Pisces Animals having gills throughout life,
usually have fins
Amphibia Animals with 4 pentadactyl limbs; pelvic
girdle unlike fish, have eggs without
protective shell, fertilised without coition
Reptilia Animals having no direct articulation of
dentary bone with the skull, homodont,
polyphyodont
Mammalia Warm blooded furry animals, heterodont
animals, diphyodont, single dentary arch
which articulates with squamosal bone
of skull, thorax separated by a diaphragm
from abdomen, and all other animals that
suckle their young
Subclass Prototheria Egg laying mammals
Metatheria Pouched mammals
Eutheria Placental mammals
Order Insectivora Ordinarily insect eaters, small and
nocturnal, simple brain
Chiroptera Ulna reduced to a vestige, have wings to
fly
Dermoptera Larger than chiroptera
Edentata Usually without teeth, slow in
locomotion
Pholidota Really toothless, scales on their body
Primates Prosimii (the lower primates: tarsiers,
lorises, lemurs, etc.)* and Anthropoidea
(monkeys, baboons, apes and man)*
Suborder Prosimii Lemuriformes, Lorisiformes,
Tarsiiformes (the most primitive of the
primates)*
15
Primate Study
Anthropoidea Ceboidea (Platyrrhines/New World
Monkeys)*, Cercopithecoidea
(Catarrhines/Old World Monkeys)* and
Hominoidea
Superfamily Ceboidea Cebidae and Callitrichidae (monkeys:
owl, saki, howler, capuchin, spider and
goeldi’s, marmosets)*
Cercopithecoidea Cercopithecidae (monkeys: rhesus, drill,
baboon, colobus, nasalis, langur etc)*
Hominoidea Pongidae and Hominidae
Family Pongidae Hylobatinae (gibbon, siamang)* and
Ponginae (orangutan, chimpanzee,
gorilla)*
Hominidae Man (Homo)*, ape-man
(Australopithecus)*, and early ape-man
(Ramapithecus)*
Genus Homo Early man (Homo erectus)* and modern
man (Homo sapiens sapiens)*
Species sapiens Modern humans including early
subspecies and all living races
1.6 DISTRIBUTION
The prosimians are subdivided into three major groups: the lemuroids, which
are restricted to Madagascar (more than 30 species are represented, belonging to
five different families); the lorisoids, which are found throughout tropical Africa
and Asia; and the tarsioids (tiny primates) (weighing only about 120 g), which
inhabit the islands of Southeast Asia (all belong to a single genus, Tarsius).
The platyrrhines from South and Central America are a diverse group of primates
comprising more than 50 species and 16 genera. All members of the suborder
Ceboidea (NWM/platyrrhines) are arboreal. They are widely distributed
throughout tropical forests extending from Mexico to northern Argentina. The
catarrhines include all anthropoid primates from Africa, Asia, and Europe. The
Old World monkeys are widely distributed throughout sub-Saharan Africa and
tropical Asia. They also occur in the extreme southwestern tip of the Arabian
Peninsula, northwest Africa, Gibraltar (their only European record), and East
Asia.
Apes
The gibbons and siamang (Hylobates) are the smallest of the pongids (4–11 kg
or 9–24 lb), and for this reason they are sometimes referred to as the lesser apes.
The nine or so species are common throughout the tropical rain forests, and the
semi deciduous mountain forests of Southeast Asia. They are known for their
remarkably longer arms than in any other primates, which are 30–50% longer
than their legs. This is related to their highly specialised mode of locomotion
called brachiation by which they swing below the tree branches using only their
forelimbs. Gibbons are fruit eaters, while the diet of larger siamangs incorporates
a higher proportion of leaves.
The great apes include the orangutans (Pongo) from Asia and Gorillas (Gorilla)
and chimpanzees (Pan) from Africa. The orangutan is restricted to the tropical
rainforests of Borneo and northern Sumatra. They are large, arboreal primates
and climb cautiously through the trees using all four limbs for support. Orangutans
subsist mainly on fruits (www.accessscience.com).
The Gorillas are the largest of the hominoids found in tropical Africa. Because
of their huge size, gorillas are almost completely terrestrial, although females
and young individuals frequently climb trees. They often build nests on the ground.
Gorillas move quadrupedally. Like the chimpanzees, their hands are specialised
for knuckle-walking when the weight of the animal is borne on the upper surface 17
Primate Study of the middle joints of the fingers. They are of two types: mountain Gorillas and
lowland Gorillas. Mountain Gorillas eat a variety of leaves, stems, and roots,
while the lowland gorillas eats a larger proportion of fruits. They live in groups
which consists of a dominant male, several adult females, sub adults, and infants.
1.7 ADAPTATIONS
Primates have diversified in arboreal and terrestrial habitats (trees, bushes and
land) and retain many characteristics facilitating adaptations to these
environments:
v Retention of the collar bone in the pectoral girdle.
v Shoulder joints with a high degree of movement in all directions.
v Possession of five digits on the fore and hind limbs with opposable thumbs
and big toes facilitating them in grasping objects and climbing trees.
v Presence of nails on the fingers and toes in most species.
v Presence of sensitive tactile pads on the ends of the digits.
v Orbits encircled in a bony rim facilitating rotation of eyeballs in the socket.
v Trend towards a reduced snout and flattened face supposedly leading to the
development of vision at the expense of olfaction.
v Complex visual system with stereoscopic vision, high visual acuity and color
vision – all contributing to quicker movements on the trees.
v Large brain in comparison to body size especially in simians.
v Differentiation of the enlarged cerebral cortex.
v Reduction in the number of teeth compared to primitive mammals.
v Three kinds of teeth.
v Longer gestation and developmental period; and
v Trend towards holding the torso upright leading to bipedalism.
Primates exhibit a wide range of characteristics. Some primates, inclusive of
some great apes and baboons, do not live primarily in trees. But all species possess
adaptations for climbing trees. Their locomotion techniques include leaping from
tree to tree, walking on twos or fours limbs, knuckle-walking, and swinging
between branches of trees (known as brachiation). The three-color vision has
developed in some primates.
18
Living Primates
1.8 SUMMARY
We consider ourselves as the highest among all beings. But we hardly know
about ourselves. Modern MAN, Homo sapiens sapiens, belongs to the group of
mammals known as Primates and is a close cousin of monkeys and apes. Yet,
few people understand the relationship between them.
Here in this unit, we find that neither man nor the non-human primates can be
defined on the basis of one or two features. They can be best defined on the basis
of the general pattern displayed by them or by the complexes of their
characteristics. So, what do we mean by the term primate (as this term also
includes human beings)? The term ‘primate’ means first or the highest amongst
all. Primates belong to the Animal Kingdom, Class Mammalia and include humans
and the nonhuman primates, i.e., lemurs, tree-shrews, lorises, aye-ayes, pottos,
bush babies, tarsiers, the monkeys of the New World and Old World, and also
the apes.
The distinctive features of all the primates (include prosimians, monkeys, apes,
and humans) are that they have:
v hair instead of fur;
v nails instead of claws;
v opposable thumb and big toe (thumb/big toe can touch all other digits) –
The exception is humans in which the big toe is modified for bipedal walking;
v prehensility – ability to grasp with fingers and/or toes;
v pentadactyly – five digits on each hand;
v padded digits with fingerprints;
v reduced olfactory sense and dependent on vision more than smell;
v stereoscopic vision – forward rotation of eye with protective bony structure;
v binocular vision– both eyes focus on one object (depth perception); and
v large brain compared to the body size – high level of intelligence.
We find that primates have a two-fold division: prosimians (lowliest of primates)
and Anthropoidea. The Anthropoidea further includes new world monkeys
(platyrrhines – flat nosed) and the old world monkeys (catarrhines - sharp nosed).
We find that chimpanzee is closest to MAN genetically. Humans and chimpanzees
have very similar DNA (about 98% of human and chimpanzee DNA is identical).
Genetic studies show that chimpanzees and humans share a common ancestor. 19
Primate Study Gorilla is the largest primate on earth and the most powerful of all the primates,
a group which includes everything from small arboreal creatures such as the tree
shrew, bush babies, several types of monkeys to humans.
1.9 GLOSSARY
Apes : Gibbons, Siamangs, Chimpanzees, Gorillas and
Orangutans.
Arboreal : tree dwelling.
Bipedalism : walking on two limbs.
Brachiation : swinging from branch to branch using forearms.
Caecum : end part of intestines.
Claviculate : have a clavicle (collar bone).
Dental formula (D.F.) : number/type of teeth in each half of the lower and
upper jaws; for instance, human D.F. is 2.1.2.3; each
half of jaw has 2 incisors, 1 canine, 2 premolars, 3
molars; total number of teeth = 32.
Extremities : limbs, i.e. arms and or legs.
Great apes : Orangutans, Chimpanzees and Gorillas.
Hallux : great toe.
Ischial callosities : hardening of skin in the region of buttocks which
comes in contact with the surface while sitting.
Knuckle walking : walking using bent fingers.
Lesser apes : Gibbons and Siamangs.
Opposable : oppositely directed.
Orbits : eye sockets.
Pectoral mammae : mammary glands on chest region.
Penis pendulous : male genital organ hanging outside body.
Pentadactyl : having five digits (fingers or toes).
Placental mammals : mammals with umbilical cord.
Pollex : thumb.
Quadrupedalism : walking on all four limbs.
Terrestrial : ground dwelling.
Testes scrotal : testes in the scrotum.
Three types of : (trichromacy or trichromaticism) is the condition of
colour vision possessing three independent channels for conveying
colour information; derived from three different cone
types. Organisms with trichromacy are called
trichromats. Their retina contains three types of
colour receptors (called cone cells) with different
absorption spectra. Trichromatic colour vision is the
ability of humans and some other animals to see
20
different colour, mediated by interactions among Living Primates
three types of colour -sensing cone cells.
Unguiculate : have nails on fingers and toes.
References
Boule, M. and H.V. Vallois 1957 Fossil Men: A Textbook of Human
Palaeontology. London, Thames and Hudson.
Osman Hill, W. C. 1953-1957 Primates. Edinburg, Edinburgh University Press.
Seth, P. K. and S. Seth 1986 The Primates. New Delhi, Northern Book Centre.
Simons E.L. and S.R.K. Chopra 1969a A preliminary announcement of a new
Gigantopithecus species from India. In Recent Advances in Primatology. Ed.
H.O. Hofer. Basel and New York: S. Karger. 2: 135¯142.
Simons, E.L. and S.R.K. Chopra 1969b Gigantopithecus (Pongidae,
Hominoidea): A New Species from North India. Postilla (Yale University Peabody
Museum of Natural History) 138:1¯18.
van Valen, L. and Sloan, R.E. 1965 The Earliest Primates. Science 150:743–
745.
www.accessscience.com/content/Primates.
Suggested Reading
Chopra, S.R.K. 1979a. Early Man in North West India. New Delhi: Allied
Publishers Private Limited.
Chopra, S.R.K. and S. Kaul 1979. A New Species of Pliopithecus from the Indian
Sivaliks. Journal of Human Evolution 8: 475– 477.
Clark, W.E. Le Gros 1934. Early Forerunners of Man. London, Bailliere Tindall
&Cox.
Clark, W.E. Le Gros 1965. History of the Primates. London, British Museum of
Natural History. .
Wood, J.F. 1948. Hallmarks of Mankind. London, Bailliere Tindall and Cox.
Hooton, E.A. 1954. Up From the Ape. New York, The Macmillan Company.
Lewis, G.E. 1933. Preliminary Notice of a New Genus of Lemuroid from the
Siwaliks. American Journal of Science 26: 134– 138.
21
Primate Study Lewis. G.E. 1934. Preliminary Notice of New Man-like Apes from India: Scientific
Research of the Yale India Expedition. American Journal of Science 27:161–
181.
Seth, P.K. and S. Seth 1986. A review of evolutionary and genetic differentiation
in primates. In Primate Evolution. Eds. Else and Lee Cambridge: Cambridge
University Press. Procs. 10th Congress of the International Primatological Society.
Vol. 1, pp 291¯306.
Simons, E.L. 1964. The Early Relatives of Man. Scientific American 211:50-62.
Simons, E.L. 1969. The Origin and Radiation of the Primates. Annals of New
York Academy of Sciences 167:319¯331.
Simons, E.L. 1972. Primate Evolution. –An Introduction to Man’s Place in Nature.
New York: Macmillan.
Simons, E.L. and D.R. Pilbeam 1972. Hominid Palaeoprimatology. In: The
Functional and Evolutionary Biology of Primates. Ed .R.H. Tuttle. Chicago:
Aldine. pp: 36¯62.
Simons, E.L. and D.R. Pilbeam 1978. Ramapithecus. In: Evolution of African
Mammals. Ed: V.J. Maglio and H.B.S. Cooke. Massachusetts: Harvard University
Press. pp 147¯153.
Simpson, G.G. 1949b. The Meaning of Evolution. New Haven: Yale University
22
Press.
Sample Questions Living Primates
1) Who is Man?
2) Who are his immediate relations and why?
3) What are Man’s distinguishing physical characteristics?
4) How does MAN differ from his nearest relatives?
5) What do you know about the evolution of MAN?
23
Primate Study
UNIT 2 PRIMATE BEHAVIOUR
Contents
2.1 Introduction
2.2 Activity Pattern
2.3 Social Organisation
2.4 So What Sort of Behaviours do We See in Primates?
2.5 Rhesus Monkey (Common Monkey)
2.6 Papio (Commonly Known as Baboons)
2.7 Presbytis (Hanuman Langur)
2.8 Lesser Apes (Siamangs and Gibbons)
2.9 Great Apes: Orangutan
2.10 Chimpanzee
2.11 Gorilla
2.12 MAN and Other Primates
2.13 Summary
2.14 Glossary
References
Suggested Reading
Sample Questions
2.1 INTRODUCTION
The very fact that non human primates have been so frequently used in biomedical
researches shows that structurally, physiologically and behaviourally, they display
greater similarities to the Homo sapiens.
So the question arises as to how we can study primate behaviour? Study of their
behaviour in captivity is not their natural behaviour but conditioned behaviour.
24
Thus, we need to understand how they adjust into their environment, i.e., to Primate Behaviour
understand the life style/behaviour of our non-human primate relatives in their
natural habitats. This depends on a number of variables, including different types
of trees on which they move, sleep and collect food (amount and types of food
needed as also food distribution across the habitat occupied) during different
seasons. As such, non human primates occupying different environments must
meet different demands. Many of the behavioural differences prevalent among
them reflect adaptations to this diversity. For instance, different primate groups
live within a single forest but move and feed on different levels and or on different
types of trees (e.g. bamboos, palms, vines, etc.). Most primates eat a variety of
foods resulting in differential development of teeth. For example, insectivores
have pointed cusps on their teeth, plant gum eaters have typically sturdy incisors
and sometimes canines that protrude forward for scraping off gum, frugivores
have wide incisors and low rounded molar cusps for scraping out the fruit from
the rinds, and folivores have sharp ridged molars for shearing leaves into tiny
bits.
The ultimate needs of human and non-human primates are not as divergent as
they appear since the survival of both depends upon the conservation of the
natural habitats. Rapid urbanisation and industrialisation is not only forcing the
non-human primates to move into smaller home ranges but it is also disturbing
their ranging patterns (due to destruction of trees, undergrowth and arboreal
pathways), group structure, dominance, etc. Such demographic changes and
ecological disturbances transform their behaviour as well as movement patterns,
temporarily if not permanently.
Researchers on the above lines reveal that urban primates depict higher
competition and aggressive instinct than their forest counterparts. On the contrary,
the role of leadership and dominance is much more defined amongst the forest
primates in tune with the exigencies of the environment. Aggression is quite
common among the urban primates whereas communication is well developed
amongst the forest monkeys. Seasonal changes in the ecosystems and the annual
variations in the weather year after year influence their daily activity pattern.
All primates have a home range or territoriality which they defend from other
groups. The neighboring groups actively defend the boundaries of their home
ranges. Ranges of non-territorial primates may overlap. At times, when different
groups occupying the same territory come face to face, an encounter occurs leading
to fight with the lesser dominant group yielding to the higher-ranking group.
25
Primate Study
2.3 SOCIAL ORGANISATION
Living in social groups is one of the significant characteristics of primates. They
solve their major adaptive problems within this social context. Social groups
among non-human primates probably formed due to two main selection pressures:
predation (gaining protection by living in groups) and group life (increasing the
efficiency in acquiring food sources in the forest). The richness of the environment
determines the composition of the population, a poor habitat supporting fewer
non-human primates than the richer one.
Many different patterns of social organisations exist among the primates. Usually,
the primate social group includes members of all ages and both sexes. This
composition does not vary significantly during the annual cycle.
The following are the main social groups that can be encountered among the
living primates:
v Solitary individuals, e.g. a mother and her dependent offspring, adult males
and adult females.
v Family, or monogamous pairs (a mated pair and their young ones).
v Multi-male groups (several adult males, several adult females, and their
young ones).
v Offspring and (perhaps) several non-sexually active females.
v Uni-male groups.
v Single male (or harem) groups (a single adult male, several adult females,
and their offspring).
v All female groups (several adult females and their offspring).
v All adult male groups.
These categories reflect the sizes of the social groups. But medium sized groups
of about a dozen individuals can have either one or several males. In any case,
groups of a given size need not have the same internal structure. This applies to
dominance hierarchies. For instance, in multimale groups of macaques and
baboons, there is a clear rank order among the adult males, whereas it is absent
in the multimale groups of spider monkeys and chimpanzees. Besides these,
there are other social groups such as foraging and hunting groups.
Group life is likely to increase competition for resources and any benefits of
groups must outweigh the costs of such competition. The nocturnal primates
live in monogamous family groups. They are not gregarious animals. The diurnal
species usually live in relatively large and stable groups. Most of the diurnal
species form sizeable groups.
For all primate species, the primary social link is the mother-infant bond. In
group living primates, relationships between females and successive generations
of their female off springs usually form the core of the group. Primate social
groups are stable only in a relative sense, as individuals migrate between them
when they become sexually mature. In most of the groups, males leave the group
whereas females remain behind.
26
Mating and Paternal Care Primate Behaviour
Mating and paternal care are the keys to successful reproduction. From amongst
the primates, females must make a substantial commitment of time and energy
to pregnancy and lactation once they have conceived. This naturally leads females
to emphasise parental care.
Females in Groups
The females generally protect themselves by living in groups. As a consequence,
the males usually compete for control over such groups of females. A single
dominant male might be able to keep other competitors away when groups are
small (e.g. less than 10 females) and thereby monopolise matings with the females
within the group. Primates living in more open country like the baboons and
macaques are exposed to much greater risks of predation and thus tend to live in
larger groups. As groups become large, a male cannot prevent other males from
joining his group. This also leads to competition for access to females for mating.
In large multimale groups like baboons and macaques, males are usually organised
in a dominance hierarchy. Most of the matings are generally performed by one or
two ‘top’ ranking males.
Home Range/Territory
This is an area in which the non-human primates normally confine themselves
for their day-to-day activity. This may or may not change during the individual’s
lifetime. The changes vary according to both the species and their sex. Home
range is often described as an area, which provides the animal or group of animals
with food.
Reproduction
In all primates, except for humans (and perhaps Chimpanzees), the females are
seasonally or cyclically receptive. This is usually associated with visual changes
such as genital swelling clearly indicating that the females are experiencing heat.
Pair bonding of any sort is rare among primates though Gibbons seem to be life-
long monogamists. Also some New World monkey groups such as marmosets
have only one reproductively active pair in any group. Chimpanzees have been
seen to have consortships of several weeks where copulation is frequent.
Mother-Infant Relationship
It has been observed that this mother infant bonding is required to allow the
infant to be able to interact properly as an adult. This attachment between the
mother and her infant which begins at birth itself is the most fundamental social
unit within the primate social relations and begins at birth itself. Infants are
mostly cared for by their mother. Primates learn what to eat, where to find food,
how to eat different foods, mating rituals, social structure, and females learn
maternal behaviour.
Dominance
Primates are mostly group-living animals and tend to form “dominance
hierarchies”. These hierarchies are also referred to as status rank. A dominant
individual always gets priority and even in a confrontation his is usually the last
word.
Animals higher in the hierarchy tend to displace lower ranked individuals from
resources like mates, space and food. The hierarchy is not a fixed one and depends
on a number of changing factors such as age, sex, body physique, aggression and
even intelligence perhaps.
Dominance serves to organise social interactions. Since the primates are born
within the group and grown therein, they learn the processes and norms of
behaviour by sheer observation. This helps in avoiding chaotic and unpleasant
situations within the group.
Males are generally dominant over females in most of the non-human primate
societies. Higher ranking males are also responsible for protecting the group,
particularly the females in estrus or with off springs, from predators or from
attack by other groups.
Aggression
Aggression is either intra- or inter-specific and is generally associated with one
or more of the following: competition for food, defense of an infant by its parents,
28
struggle for dominance or change in social status, failure to comply with signals,
the consort formation at oestrus, and changes in the internal biological state of Primate Behaviour
the animal. Aggression builds up spontaneously and must be released. It has
been shown that hierarchies are considered to reduce the amount of aggression
but when hierarchies are most rigid, aggression is most common.
Communication
The communication system of the non-human primates which includes scents,
body postures, gestures, and vocalisations as monkeys and apes is rather an
expanding field. From the human perspective, we often find it easier to associate
sounds with specific meaning, whereas among the non-human primates, gestures
and actions are often used. Presentation and mounting behaviour is often used to
diffuse potentially aggressive situations. Yawns exposing teeth are often threats,
like direct eye contact. Facial expression is important too. It’s very obvious in
chimpanzees: their expression often appears all too human-like, but other primates
also use stereotyped eyelid flashes or lip slaps.
Social Behaviour
They live in large multimale-multifemale groups. Macaques (rhesus monkey)
live in troops of varying sizes in which both males and females have well-defined
rank. Ranking females benefit from easier access to food and water, space, and
grooming partners. Their group sizes range from 5 to 80; at times groups as large
as 125 individuals are also encountered. Macaques have a variable social structure.
Matrilineal hierarchies are very strong. As in many Old World monkeys, females
get genital swellings when they are in oestrus (sexually receptive). This occurs
often in multimale groups. In this way, all the males become aware that the
female is for copulation. For this purpose, they compete with one another and
ultimately the stronger male will copulate with her.
Sexual Behaviour
Male rhesus monkeys make intense sexual friends. Males, especially younger
ones, use a number of ritualised erotic “greeting” gestures with one another,
including embracing, face-licking or kissing, fondling or grabbing of the erect
penis, mounting and rump fingering.
Reproduction
Dominant males copulate with high-ranking females throughout their oestrus
cycles. When low-ranking males mate, they are often interrupted by the dominant
male; to avoid interruption, they mate while he is mating with another female
(www.cellar.org).
Vocalisations
The most common vocalisation of rhesus monkeys is a ‘coo’ used when
approaching other group members to avoid aggression and initiate grooming or
other friendly interactions.
Dominance
All baboons have strong dominance hierarchies where ranks are inherited from
the females. Females outnumber male group members, though males tend to be
dominant, herding females around and determining their foraging direction. The
highest ranking male of the group is dominant over all other males and females.
There is a ranking system between the females that is established at birth. A
daughter assumes the rank just below her mother. The ranking of the females is
stable, where as that of the males frequently changes. The dominant male is
challenged by other males who want to be in the highest ranking position.
Males will often, though not always, live elsewhere. Male olive baboons use
infants as “social buffers” in dominance struggles. Males may change troops
more than once in the course of their lives.
30
Communication Primate Behaviour
Their home range varies between .05-13 km for groups containing both males
and females, and 7-22 km for all-male groups. A portion of the home range is a
core area in which most of the time is spent.
Social Behaviour
Langur groups range between 13-37 individuals. But this can swell up to 125
when several groups gather at rich food areas. Groups usually consist of 8 - 125
individuals. Males without females form bachelor groups of 2-32. Langurs have
variable social structure: one male-multifemale, multimale-mutifemale, all
females with infants and adolescent males and females and all male groups.
Bisexual groups usually contain between 10 and 30 members – one adult male
besides adult females, young individuals of both sexes and infants. All male
troops are more variable in number, and comprise solely of adult and subadult
males. Larger groups may break into subgroups in some seasons. In the groups
with several males, the high-ranking males can mate with any female, while the
other males can only mate when they can sneak by the high-ranking males.
Females stay in the same home-range for their whole lives in association with
their mothers, grand-mothers, sisters, daughters and aunts. These home ranges
slightly overlap.
Reproduction
The young ones are weaned in 10-12 months. Female langurs become sexually
mature at 3-4 years, and the males at 4-5 years. They however do not mate until
they attain 6-7 years of age. Gestation lasts for about 190-210 days. Mothers
usually bear one infant at a time. The oestrus cycle is about 24 days long. But if
the infant is lost, cycles can resume within 8 days. The normal interval between
births is 15-24 months.
Infanticide
When a male takes over a troop, he will kill the infants to gain a reproductive
advantage. Normally, a female takes around nine months to wean her young one
and another year or so to be sexually receptive again. Infanticide serves to shorten
31
Primate Study this waiting period as females whose infants have been killed will be in oestrus
shortly. As such the new male will establish himself as the leader.
Locomotion
They move through the forest and on the ground quadrupedally. Langurs also
use a leaping gait on trees through the forest. Their tails can be up to three feet
long and are used as balancing rods (like a bamboo pole) for swinging in the
trees. Langurs can be entirely terrestrial or entirely arboreal depending on the
ecological situation. In areas where trees are scarce, the langurs adapts well to
life on the ground. When on the ground, langurs walk or run on all four feet. In
the trees, they are remarkably agile. Langurs can jump horizontally from 3-5 m.
The grasping capacity of their hands and feet allows them to move on the trees at
great speeds.
Communication
Presenting behaviour is performed by the female to elicit copulation from the
male. From this condition the male understands that the female is ready for
copulation. Head-shaking precedes the display of the female presenting behaviour.
In the morning, the resident male in a group of females gives long-distance shouts,
viz., whoop, whoop! They produce a variety of sounds, e.g., a joyous “whoop”,
a guttural alarm, and a booming whoop.
Lifespan
Langurs can live up to 20 years in the wild and about 25 years in captivity.
They have a throat pouch (also known as gular sac) which enables them to make
louder calls. This hooting can be heard up to longer distances (approx 2-3 kms)
through the dense rain forests. These apes in the morning make loud territorial
hooting calls and menacing gestures signaling their presence in the area. Such
calls warn others to stay away from their territory particularly from the local
fruit trees. These diurnal apes are otherwise quite social animals. They are
territorial and emigrate from their natal groups around adolescence.
They are arboreal and good climbers having much longer arms than legs. But on
the ground, they have an obliquely quadrupedal mode of locomotion, generally
knuckle walking.
32
Orangutans are intelligent, peaceful and predominantly frugivores. Adult males Primate Behaviour
and females forage independently in their habitat.
Social Behaviour
Orangutans have little social organisation, their maximum group size being the
mother with her infant. A couple may have brief associations when the female is
in oestrus. A few orangutans may congregate at a good fruit tree. Orangutan
adult males mostly lead a solitary life, except when they copulate with females.
This is probably because their food is scattered thinly throughout the rain forest.
Further they need lots of food owing to their being large creatures.
Their population densities range from 0.2 to 5.0 individuals per sq km. Local
variation has been reported in the social structure of the orangutans. Adult males
occupy larger home ranges than adult females and are hostile to one another.
Males’ home ranges are often 2 - 6 sq. km. in size, and overlap the ranges of
several females.
To avoid violent disputes, males make distinctive ‘long call’ unique to orangutans
which produces a booming sound that can be heard up to 1km away. In this way,
males avoid each other.
Orangutans are active during the day and are almost exclusively arboreal. They
forage in the early morning, resting during the midday heat and resume their
activity in the afternoon. They live alone in large territories probably due to their
eating habits.
Orangutans also construct a sleeping nest high up in the trees to rest at night. But
only the lighter female and juveniles do this. The heavier males usually sleep on
the ground. Each night, they construct nests out of leaves and branches. The
nests are of a platform style ranging from 40 to 60 feet high in a tree.
Reproduction
Orangutans have a very low reproductive rate. They mature and become capable
of reproducing when they are 7 to 10 years old by which time they attain their
adult size. The males however continue to grow until they are 10 years old and
do not have successful mating until they are about 14 years of age.
A female usually has her first infant at the age of 12-15 years. It gives birth to
one offspring at a time. They give birth once in every 3-8 years. Their gestation
period is 227 to 275 days (8 to 9 months). The young ones are not weaned from
their mothers until they are 3 ½ years old. The female orangutans have an estrous
cycle of about 30 days in length.
The male and female adults come together only for a brief period of courtship.
For purposes of mating, males prefer fully adult females. The choice of sexual
partners is very much a prerogative of females. When she is ready to mate, the
female listens to the loud calls of males following which she reaches out to one
of them for mating.
Mother - infant
Like human children, orangutan babies have to be taught everything that they
need to know to survive. Since males have nothing to do with the female after
mating, the mother takes the responsibility of teaching the infant. The mother
even feeds her baby pre-chewed food until it can eat on its own.
33
Primate Study A newborn orangutan weighs 2 kg and remains totally dependent on the mother
for the first 18 months. A female adult usually establishes a territory near her
mother often overlapping with hers. A male travels far away to establish a separate
territory.
Life Span
Orangutans live about 50 to 60 years in captivity while their life span in the wild
is only 40 to 50 years.
Locomotion
Orangutans have longer and more powerful arms than other great apes. Their
arms measure 2.2 m across in their outspread position. They are longer than their
height. In contrast, their legs are short and weak. Too heavy to brachiate, the
adult orangutans swing slowly, not letting go of a branch until they reach the
next branch. They usually move slowly and deliberately using all the four limbs.
Orangutans usually move in the forests by swinging from one branch to another
called brachiating. On the ground, they usually walk on all fours. Though they
have really mobile joints, they do not really swing like the gibbons. It is more
like climbing with four hands. Adult males get so big that they sometimes have
to get down and walk from one tree to the next!
As one of man’s closest relatives, the orangutan (Asiatic great ape) or commonly
referred to as ‘man of the forest’, is a severely endangered species.
Tool Use
Orangutans show a remarkable ability to arrive at certain trees just when their
fruit is ripening. Like other great apes, they have been observed to use tools but
less extensively than has been observed in chimpanzees.
They use sticks for digging and winkling out edible seeds from a spiny fruit
case, or use a stick even to hit a snake. They may also use sticks to fight each
other or scratch themselves.
2.10 CHIMPANZEE
Chimpanzees are diurnal, semi terrestrial and generally frugivorous. During the
dry season seeds, nuts, flowers, leaves, resin, eggs , etc., form the important food
resources.
Social Behaviour
Chimpanzees are social animals and are active during the day (diurnal). Their
social structure can be categorised as fusion-fission. They live in small, stable
groups (called communities or unit groups) of about 40-60 individuals who would
defend a common territory. Smaller subgroups of 6-7 chimpanzees stay together
34
for a while, with the membership changing over time. A 38 year long study in the
Gombe Stream Reserve revealed that the number of individuals in the main Primate Behaviour
study community ranged between 40 and 60.
Like other apes, they build bowl shaped sleeping nest in trees with leaves and
other plant material usually at a height of 6-25 m from the ground for safety
from predators. Every evening, chimpanzees construct a new “sleeping nest” in
the trees where they curl up and sleep. They use the same nest for several nights
if the troop is not on the move. They keep their nests clean. Each adult makes its
own nest, only young chimpanzees share their mother’s nest, until the next baby
is born.
Dominance
Within the community, there is a linear hierarchy with one of the males emerging
as number one (or alpha). All adult males dominate all females. The males of a
community regularly patrol their boundaries. Adolescent females may migrate
into a new community permanently. When they become pregnant, they move
back to their own natal group.
Sexual Behaviour
Mothers engage in sexual activity fairly often with their infants. Young females
typically experience a one-to-three year period of long adolescent sterility
following their first menstruation. During this period, they mate heterosexually
without conceiving. Incestuous matings between adults are not common
(www.forum.philosophynow.org).
Reproduction
There is no distinct breeding season among chimpanzees. They mate whenever
a female ‘comes in season’ whereupon she develops massive pink swellings on
35
Primate Study her hind region lasting two to three weeks or more and occurring every four to
six weeks. This condition is an invitation for males for copulation. Chimpanzees
attain full growth and are able to reproduce by the age of 12-13 years. Female
chimpanzee’s pregnancy period lasts 8.5-9 months. They usually have a single
baby at a time; twins are rare. The female gives birth once every 4 to 5 years. The
gestation period ranges from 230 to 250 days (8 to 9 months). The females are
good mothers and raise their young ones alone.
Infanticide
Infanticide is common among them. This generally happens when there is a
change in the leadership as it immediately leads to the weaning females coming
in estrus; thereby the new leader can have sexual relationship with the adult
females to raise his own offspring.
Tool Use
Chimpanzees have opposable thumbs (although much shorter than the human
thumb) and opposable big toes capable of a precision grip, which enables them
to use tools especially in extracting ant and termites out of a mound and or a
ground as also to crack open nuts with a stone using a hard platform. Chimpanzees
have been observed to use sticks to obtain ants and termites to eat and to scare
away intruders. They also use chewed up leaves as a sponge to sop-up water to
drink.
Life Span
Chimpanzees live about 50 to 60 years in captivity while their life span in the
wild ranges from 35-40 years. Like most animals, they survive for longer period
in captivity.
Locomotion
Chimpanzees’ arms are longer than their legs which enable them to reach out to
fruits growing on thin branches that would not support their weight. This also
helps them climb trees and brachiate (swing from branch to branch by their
arms). Chimpanzees can also walk upright (on the two legs in the bipedal
position), when carrying something in their hands or when looking over tall
grass.
Chimpanzees are known as “knuckle walkers” because they place their soles
and the back of the finger joints on the ground. They are terrestrial creatures.
While most primates walk on the flats of their hands, chimpanzees walk on their
knuckles with their hands turned over. This type of walking is typical of not only
chimpanzees but also of gorillas. Chimpanzees usually walk using all fours (on
the soles of feet and the knuckles of their hands).
36
The intra-group communication is mostly achieved through posture, gesture or Primate Behaviour
facial expression, and submissive signals of crouching, presenting the rump and
holding the hand out accompanied by pant-grunts or squeaks.
2.11 GORILLA
These are the largest of the primates in the world weighing up to 400 pounds.
Their build is much heavier than that of chimpanzees. Further, they have big
canine teeth and much larger stature. They are diurnal, terrestrial apes. Some of
them prefer arboreal climbing. Gorillas possess widely set and deeply sunken
eyes and flaring nostrils. They inhabit lowland and montane forests with a
discontinuous distribution in equatorial Africa.
Ecology
Gorillas are mostly folivorous. They eat fruit, leaves, bark, ants, and bamboo
shoots. They never eat all the leaves from a single plant. Instead, they leave
plenty of leaves so that the plant can replace the leaves quickly.
Activity Pattern
The activity pattern of the gorillas depends upon the food availability, social
conditions and their reproductive status. Gorillas are shy, social animals and are
most active in the morning.
Gorillas are active during the daytime. They wake up just after sunrise (troop
rises between 6 A.M. and 8 A.M.) and search for food such as leaves, buds,
stalks, berries, bark and ferns, which they consume and rest and relax. During
midday, adults usually nap while the young play games. Gorillas do not appear
to drink water but derive the same from their juicy diet. They feed again in the
afternoon, finally retiring for the night in nests made of twigs and leaves. Unlike
the chimpanzees, they construct nests of leaves on the ground for sleeping at
night.
Home Range
Gorilla groups wander about within a home range of 10 to 40 sq km (4 to 15 1/
2 sq mile), which is not defended or marked at the boundaries. Some conflicts
may arise with neighboring groups, but encounters are generally avoided by
communications such as drumming on the ground from a distance.
Social Behaviour
Gorillas live in structured family groups with a polygynous mating pattern. The
gorilla’s social system is usually composed of a single adult male with multiple
females. They live in small groups (bands or harems) consisting of close family
members and other relatives (6–7 individuals) that may number up to 30
individuals. The adult females maintain hierarchy within the group which they
pass on to their offspring.
A typical harem is a closely-knit group including a dominant male, one or two
subdominant males, and several mature and young females. Some groups may
contain only the dominant male, two or three females and the young. males are
normally driven out of a harem once they reach an age of 11-13 years. Males
may form all male groups or travel lonely until the opportunity to start their own
harem arises. 37
Primate Study Dominance
The gorilla is essentially a peace-loving creature that would rather retreat than
fight except in circumstances when its life is threatened and retreat is impossible.
However, once provoked, an adult male will attempt to intimidate his aggressor
by standing on his legs and slapping its chest with cupped hands, simultaneously
roaring and screaming. Adult males perform elaborate displays, including chest
beating, running sideways and tearing up vegetation to frighten an intruding
male or similar other threat. Males also use these displays as a show of dominance
within the group. Adult females can become aggressive while defending their
infants, or while helping each other to drive out rowdy, young adult males. The
dominant male leads the family group and decides where the members should
feed and sleep. Females are strongly bonded to the male.
Grooming
Grooming one another (cleaning the hair of another gorilla) is a major occupation
among gorillas in a band. Female gorillas not only groom their offspring but also
one another and the dominant male. Unlike most other primates, each gorilla
takes care of its own toilet routine. Mutual grooming is quite rare among the
gorillas.
Reproduction
Females reach sexual maturity during 6-9 years of age. Males become sexually
mature in the wild between 8 and 9 ½ years of their age and in captivity as early
as 6 ½ years. Males are not considered fully mature until they become about 15
years old. The oestrus cycle lasts 26-30 days. Gorillas do not have a distinct
breeding season. Gestation lasts from 250 to 285 days. In the wild, female gorillas
usually deliver their first offspring at their age of 10½ years old and subsequently
at four-year intervals.
Locomotion
Gorillas walk in an obliquely quadrupedal mode of locomotion by actually using
their knuckles to support part of their weight. However, they do stand erect on
occasions. Gorillas perform knuckle-walking by using both their legs and long
arms. They can climb trees but do not do so very often because of their heavy
weight.
Communication and Vocalisation
Gorillas generally communicate with each other using many complicated sounds
and gestures. Some of their gestures range from chest-beating, high-pitched barks,
lunging, throwing objects to staring, lip-tucking, sticking out the tongue, sideways
running, slapping, rising to a two-legged stance, etc.(www.animalcorner.co.uk).
2.13 SUMMARY
Non human primates are referred to as Man’s closest relatives. Therefore, in
order to understand Man’s changing behaviour and emotions, etc., under different
conditions, it is important to study the behaviour and social structure/organisation
of non-human primates, man’s closest relatives, and then extrapolate that to MAN.
In this Unit, we briefly discuss the behaviour of our closest relatives, i.e. the
non-human primates.
Major activities that occupy these primates most of the day are eating, traveling
and resting, grooming, playing, fighting and mating activities.
For all primate species, the primary social link is the mother-infant bond. In
group living primates, relationships between females and successive generations
of their female off springs usually form the core of the group.
We find in this unit that the frequently observed primate activity is social
grooming. It helps to strengthen links. The mother-infant relationship is the most
fundamental social unit within the primate social relations and begins at birth
itself.
Primates are mostly group-living animals and tend to form “dominance
hierarchies”. These hierarchies are also referred to as status rank. Dominance
serves to organise social interactions. Since the primates are born within the
group and grown therein, they learn the processes and norms of behaviour by
sheer observation. Aggression is either intra- or inter-specific.
In this Unit, it is observed that the primates have a very interesting system of
communication amongst themselves. For example, ‘display’ primarily
communicates information that is useful to an individual of the group, to the
social group to which he belongs and to other species. This mode of
communication conveys to other members of the group, one’s emotion such as
greeting, fear, threat, happiness, danger, pain, hunger, courtship, , etc., through a
wide variety of body movements, facial expressions, vocalisations, and olfactory
signals.
Macaques are the favorite animals for laboratory tests. Tests on the rhesus macaque
resulted in the discovery of the Rh (rhesus) factor in 1940.
Baboons have complex social systems. They live in a multimale - multi-female
social group. Baboons normally sleep in large troops, no matter what their foraging
patterns are, in some high place where they are protected from predators. Mutual
grooming functions as a strong social bond. 39
Primate Study The word “langur” means “long tail” in Hindi language. They are most active in
the early morning and late afternoon. Feeding occurs at dawn and again during
the evening. Langur groups may forage over several kilometers in the course of
a day. A troop of langurs returns to the same resting place every night.
The lesser apes (siamang and gibbon) are monogamous and live in small stable
family groups consisting of an adult male and an adult female (for life) and their
immature offsprings. Unlike great apes, these lesser apes do not make sleeping
nests. They simply sleep (in sitting posture) between the forking branches of the
trees (www.miamimetrozoo.com).
Orangutans, the largest and rarest of the great apes, have senses very similar to
humans, including hearing, sight, smell, taste and touch; are usually frugivores.
Chimpanzees are diurnal, semi terrestrial and generally frugivorous. During the
dry season seeds, nuts, flowers, leaves, resin, eggs etc. form the important food
resources. Chimpanzees on occasions exhibit such behaviours as group hunting,
food sharing and tool making which were once considered as the exclusive trait
of humans. Gorillas are the largest of the primates in the world weighing up to
400 pounds. They are diurnal, terrestrial apes. Some of them prefer arboreal
climbing. Gorillas possess widely set and deeply sunken eyes and flaring nostrils.
These behavioural traits speak of the close anatomical and behavioural kinship
between man and chimpanzees. These non-human primates have senses very
similar to ours, including hearing, sight, smell, taste and touch. Chimpanzees
are very intelligent and can learn even extremely complex tasks but are the most
violent primates besides humans!
2.14 GLOSSARY
Alpha male/female : highest ranking individual within a dominance
hierarchy.
Arboreal : tree dwelling.
Affiliative behaviour : behaviours which promote group cohesion (friendly/
positive gestures), e.g. grooming, touching, and
hugging
Brachiation : locomotion by arm swinging.
Crepuscular : active during twilight hours.
Diurnal : active during day time.
Dominance : ability to intimidate others.
Estrus : period in which an adult female is sexually receptive.
Frugivorous : fruit eating.
Gestation : conception and development of young one in uterus.
Grooming : cleaning of body surface by licking, nibbling, picking
with fingers or kind of manipulation.
Home range : area of land used.
Infanticide : killing of infants.
Mating : having sex.
Matrilocal : residence with mating female.
40
New World : American mainland. Primate Behaviour
References
www.animalcorner.co.uk accessed on 21-03-2011
www.cellar.org accessed on 30-05-2011
www.forum.philosophynow.org accessed on 11-02-2011
www.janegoodallug.org accessed on 16-02-2011
www.miamimetrozoo.com accessed on 02-05-2011.
Suggested Reading
Bramblett, C.A. 1976. Patterns of Primate Behaviour. California, Mayfield
Publishing Company.
Kummer, H. 1971. Primate Societies. Chicago, Aldine Publishing Company.
Nelson, H. and R. Jurmain 1988. Introduction to Physical Anthropology. New
York, West Publishing Company.
Seth, P.K. and S. Seth 1993. Structure, function and diversity of Indian rhesus
monkey. In New Perspective in Anthropology Ed. P.K. Seth and S. Seth. New
Delhi, M.D. Publications Pvt Ltd. pp 47 – 82.
Sample Questions
1) How does home range influence behaviour of primates?
2) What is the role of a female in estrus within the social structure of the group?
3) How do sleeping sites, food, and water resources affect the social structure
of primates?
4) Compare and contrast the social behaviour of rhesus monkey and apes.
5) Write short notes on
a) Territoriality
b) Dominance and aggression
c) Prosimians and insectivores.
41
Primate Study
UNIT 3 PHYLOGENY OF LIVING PRIMATES
AND PRIMATE ANATOMY
Contents
3.1 Introduction
3.2 Biogenetic Basis of Phylogeny of Living Primates
3.2.1 Immunological Techniques
3.2.2 Molecular Approach
3.2.3 DNA Hybridisation
3.2.4 Mobile DNA Elements Approach
3.3 Comparative Anatomy of Man and Apes
3.3.1 Skull
3.3.2 Spine
3.3.3 Pectoral Girdle
3.3.4 Pelvic Girdle
3.3.5 Lower Limbs
3.4 Hominization
3.4.1 Skeletal Changes Due to Erect Posture and its Implications
3.5 Summary
3.6 Glossary
References
Suggested Reading
Sample Questions
Learning Objectives
&
Comparative anatomy and fossil records for constructing phylogenies are very
important for paleontologists. The development of sophisticated techniques in
the field of modern genetics has facilitated in the endeavor. After you have read
this unit you will follow the
Ø biogenetic basis of phylogeny of living primates; and
Ø comparative anatomy of Man and Apes.
3.1 INTRODUCTION
Before the development of sophisticated techniques in the field of modern
genetics, paleontologists had to depend on comparative anatomy and fossil records
for constructing phylogenies. Sometimes the interpretation of the fossils varied
so much that instead of one phylogeny there could be two or more.
It has been observed that nearly 50% of the primates genome is made up of
mobile repetitive DNA sequences such as Alu and LINE elements. The causes
and evolutionary consequences of these mobile elements have been studied during
the last decade.
Without going into the details of the two different types of mobile DNA elements
(DNA Transposons and DNA Retrotransposons), let us examine the role of
Alu elements which are primate specific. Alu elements have been extensively
used in primate phylogenetic studies.
Human-Chimpanzee-Gorilla Trichotomy
According to Paterson et al. (2006), the relationship among humans, chimpanzees,
and gorillas have been a difficult and long standing problem. Several studies
have tried to resolve this problem. Though the mtDNA studies by Horai et al.
(1965) support chimpanzee as nearest living relative of humans, Satta et al. (2000)
who analysed the sequences from 45 nuclear loci found that 60% of the loci
support human-chimpanzee relationship. Salem et al. (2000) analysed 117 Alu
Ye subfamily and 16 loci from Alu Y sub- family. They found a single most
parsimonious tree with high levels of support. The resulting tree clearly clusters
human and chimpanzee as a sister clad with gorilla as outgroups.
44
Phylogeny of Living
3.3 COMPARATIVE ANATOMY OF MAN AND Primates and Primate
Anatomy
APES
Comparative anatomy is one among many branches of Comparative Biological
Sciences such as comparative physiology, comparative embryology, comparative
biochemistry, and so forth. Comparative method is widely used by scientists in
their fields of specialization.
3.3.1 Skull
It consists of two parts – Cranium and Face.
Cranium is a more or less dome shaped case which contains the brain.
Face consists of the upper and lower jaws, the cheek and the nasal bones. Between
the face and cranium are the orbits.
The great size of the cranium and reduction of the face are the characteristics of
man. In apes the face is very large and heavy whereas cranium is proportionately
very small. In man the face is not only small but it does not project beyond the
cranium. Hence the skull is orthognathous (orthos- straight, gnathous – jaw).
On the other hand, the large face and jaws project in front of the cranium and
form a snout. It means that cranium is placed behind the face instead of over it
and as such the skull becomes prognathous.
Face
Orthognathous
Prognathous
Ape
Man
In man, the cranial capacity is larger because of the larger dimensions in length,
breadth and height than that of the apes. The average cranial capacity in man
varies from 1000 cc to 1400 cc. The average cranial capacity of adult gorilla
varies from 540 cc to 600 cc; in chimpanzee it is between 420 cc to 500 cc and in
orangutan it ranges from 450 cc to 550 cc. The smallest cranial capacity of 100
cc is found in the gibbon.
45
Primate Study The roof and the sides of cranium constitute the vault. The vault of the human
skull is smooth and convex in the frontal, occipital and parietal regions which
overlie the corresponding regions of the brain associated with intelligence, vision
and sense of touch and control of muscles. The vault of the ape skull lacks these
convexities also known as eminences or bumps.
The bones in the vault of human and ape skulls are firmly joined together. The
frontal bone of the forehead makes contact with the occipital bone of the back.
There are two parietals between these two, one on each side of the midline on
the top of the skull. There are two more bones namely the temporal and the
sphenoid which complete the side of the vault. The junction along the edges of
these bones is marked by line known as sutures. There are many sutures such as
coronal suture between frontal and parietals, lambdoid between occipital and
parietals, squamous between temporal and parietal where the former overlaps
the latter, sagittal between the two parietals in the midline at the top of the skull,
and spheno-temporal between temporal and sphenoid. These sutures are clearly
seen in man but tend to cynostose (fuse) in old age and become completely
obliterated. In apes the sutures are not easy to see.
Sagittal suture
Coronal suture
Squamous suture
Orbit
SPHENOID
TEMPORAL
Lambdoid suture
Sogebi0tenoirak sytyre
Nasal
bone
ZYGOMATIC
OCCIPITAL
MAXILLA
Occipito-mastooid
Ramus
MANDIBLE
Chin Body
46
Phylogeny of Living
Primates and Primate
Anatomy
FRONTAL
PARIETAL Orbit
TEMPORAL
ZYGOMATIC BONE
Nasal bone
MAXILLA
MANDIBLE
The differences between man and ape skulls are prominently marked in the
development of ridges and the areas for the attachment of neck and masticatory
muscles. In man the side of the vault has extensive flattened area known as
temporal fossa for the attachment of temporal masticatory muscles. These muscles
extend from the side of the cranium to the lower jaw. They help the jaw in moving
up and down and sideways during mastication. The temporal fossa in apes is
much larger than in man. Because of the large size of jaw and teeth, the temporal
fossa in apes has to provide greater surface for the attachment of the masticatory
muscle. The line of its attachment known as temporal line rises right up to the
top of the skull where it meets the midline and forms a vertical crest called the
sagittal crest. This crest joins a transverse crest called occipital crest in the
posterior region of the skull.
The frontal bone in man has two eminences, one on each side and the forehead is
vertical, whereas in apes there are no eminences and the forehead is flat and
retreating. There are two conical cavities which accommodate the eyeballs. These
orbital cavities are connected with the temporal region in man by two narrow
spaces, one between the zygomatic (malar) and sphenoid bones and the other
between the zygomatic and maxillary. The orbital cavities are large and almost
completely shut off from the temporal fossa by the extension inwards of the
zygomatic bone.
The frontal bone forms the upper border of the orbits and in between them it
makes sutural contact with the nasal bones. The upper border is curved and
thickened known as supraorbital ridge. In man, the two supraorbital ridges may
not be prominent. They are separated from the midline by a depressed area. The
supraorbital margins are very strongly developed in apes but in gorilla they are
massive and form a continuous supraorbital torus. In orangutan this torus is
conspicuous but not massive.
The occipital region in the back of the skull forms the vault and also enters into
the part formation of the base. The vault portion in man is smooth and bulging
and the basal portion is less bulging. The occipital bone in the apes is less convex
and less uniform in outline and the rough muscular portion is flattened and looks
backwards and downwards. The external occipital curve line is raised into a
prominent occipital crest which is joined by the sagittal crest. As compared to
47
Primate Study man, the ape’s skull is large and projecting and is ill balanced on the vertebral
column. The muscular area has to be extensive in the occipital bone. At the base
of the skull, there is a large opening through which the spinal cord passes into
the vertebral column. Because of the bulge of occipital bone, there is a
considerable extension of the base of the skull behind the foramen magnum in
man and as such its position is relatively forward. Since there is reduction in the
occipital bulge in apes, the base becomes small and so the foramen is placed far
back and faces downwards.
The face consists of upper jaw formed by two symmetrical bones joined together
in the lower part to form the palate. It has several processes. Its frontonasal
process connects the maxilla to the frontal bone and also supports the nasal
bones. In apes, it is stronger and shorter than in man and acts as a buttress. The
lower curved margin of the maxilla is the alveolar process which bears the teeth.
It is stronger and larger in apes than in man because of the larger teeth.
The zygomatic or the malar bone supports upper and outer part of the cheek on
each side and joins (connects) the maxilla to the cranium on the outer side of the
orbit. It acts as a buttress or support and conveys pressure forces up to the base
of the skull. It is very stout in apes as it has to support the strains (pressure)
produced during mastication by the heavy jaws. The palatal processes of the
maxillae form the hard palate which separates the mouth from the nose and
forms the roof of the mouth and the floor of the nasal cavity. The only difference
between man and apes is that the premaxillary part of the palate is fused with
maxilla in the former whereas it is separate in the latter. The upper surface of the
maxilla extends as the orbital process under the eye. The alveolar process shows
a number of vertical ridges raised by the roots of the teeth and one of these near
the margin of the nasal aperture is prominent. This is the canine ridge. The ridges
are more prominent in apes than in man because of the larger roots of the teeth.
The zygomatic bone connects the upper jaw to the base, and medially and below
it is continuous with zygomatic process of the maxilla. The inner process of the
zygomatic bone meets the angular projection of the frontal bone while the outer
process extends to meet a similar process of the temporal bone across the temporal
48
fossa. This is how the zygomatic arch is formed. In apes we find the same Phylogeny of Living
Primates and Primate
processes as in man but they are shorter and stronger. The zygomatic arch is also Anatomy
shorter.
The paired nasal bones are raised above the level of the face and meet in the
midline. They are in contact with the maxilla on each side and meet the frontal in
the upper end. The lower ends widen out to form the nasal aperture. In apes the
nasal bones are not raised above the level of the face as they are flat and thus
there is no nasal bridge, a prominent feature of nasal bones in man.
The lower jaw or the mandible has two symmetrical halves which become fused
early in infancy. The junction of the two halves in the midline is known as
symphysis menti or mental symphysis (joint of the chin). The bodies of the
mandible (i.e., the two halves) diverge backwards from the symphysis. The
mandibular body accommodates the teeth of the lower jaw. The ramus of the
mandible is a broad flat plate of bone which turns up from the posterior of the
body. The upper part of the ramus is separated into two processes by a depression
known as sigmoid notch. The anterior coronoid process gives attachment to the
temporal muscles where as the posterior process or condyle fits into a fossa on
the undersurface of the squamous portion of the temporal bone to form the
temporo-mandibular joint. The backward divergence of the bodies of the mandible
and the chin are characteristic features of man. The general description of the
mandible of apes is same as that of man but there are differences between them.
In apes, the body of the mandible is heavier and the two halves are parallel.
There is no mental eminence. The two halves of the body at the symphysis are
buttressed behind by a bony bar called simian shelf. The ramus is also wider
than in man and the sigmoid notch is shallower.
There are three parts of a tooth. The crown is above the gum, the root fits into the
socket of the alveolar hard enamel material. The neck is the slightly constricted
region between the crown and the root.
According to the shape, special functions (cutting, grinding) and location in the
jaws, the teeth are classified as incisors, canines, premolars, and molars. The
total number of teeth both in man and apes is 32 represented by the dental formula
of 2123/2123. There are two incisors, one canine, two premolars and three molars
found in each half of the upper and lower jaws (8 x 4 =32). The teeth in apes are
much larger than in man.
49
Primate Study Incisors are sharp cutting or nibbling teeth in front. They are larger and clumsier
than in man. Canines are the tearing teeth. They are large and long with blunted
crown in man. In apes they are large and out of proportion of the adjacent teeth.
On account of great length, they are accommodated into the spaces of the upper
and lower jaws at the time of oscillation or closure of the jaws. The space is
known as diastema characteristic of simian dentition. Diastema between the
upper canines and the lateral incisors is present. The canines project forward and
are interlocked.
Premolars are also known as bicuspsids because they have two conical crowns.
They are also grinding teeth. In man, the upper premolars have two roots and the
lower ones possess only one root, whereas in apes the upper ones have three
roots and the lower ones have two roots. Molars are grinding teeth. In man they
have four dome shaped cusps on the upper and five on the lower molars. The last
molar is the smallest in the series. The molars of the apes have large well developed
cusps. The third molar is the largest in the series.
3.3.2 Spine
The spine is made up by a number of superimposed blocks of bone called
vertebrae. They form a vertical column supporting the head and the ribs. That is
why it has been named as vertebral column. The vertebral column protects the
spinal cord which is a downward prolongation of the central nervous system. It
represents a series of curvatures. These are cervical, thoracic, lumbar, sacral and
caudal or coccygeal. In man, the thoracic and lumbar curves are called primary
curves because they are the parts of the embryo. The cervical curve develops
only after birth when the head is lifted and the lumbar curve appears when the
trunk is raised as the child begins to walk. The curvatures in the cervical and
lumbar region are convex forwards, whereas in the thoracic and pelvic region
they are concave forwards. The cervical vertebrae are seven in number. They are
small and their spines are short and bifid. The first vertebra called atlas supports
the head and is modified to twist horizontally around the second or axis. The
rotation of the head takes place on the atlas and axis. The apes also have seven
cervical vertebrae which are proportionately larger than those of man. Their spines
are long and stout. The graceful hollow of the neck in man is filled up in the
apes.
The thoracic vertebrae are normally twelve but may be thirteen in number. The
thoracic vertebrae resemble those of man. The lumbar vertebrae also known as
lion vertebrae and are five in number in man but may be reduced to four or
increased to six. They are broad from side to side and rough. The lumbar vertebrae
in apes are very flat and broad.
The sacral vertebrae in the pelvic region are fused together to form a wedge
shaped bone. It lies in the posterior part of the pelvis where it is firmly attached.
The curvature or concavity of the sacrum is well developed. In apes this curvature
is less marked and the sacrum is narrower as compared to that of man.
The coccygeal vertebrae of the tail region are reduced to small plates of bone
hardly recognizable as vertebrae both in man and apes.
50
Phylogeny of Living
Primates and Primate
Anatomy
In man, the tibia transmits the weight from the femur to the foot. The upper end
of the tibia is horizontally expanded to support the triangular shaft, whereas the
lower end is slightly expanded which rests on the talus, one of the tarsal bones of
the foot. The tibia does not enter into the knee-joint but articulates with outer
surface of talus. It acts like a spring-bone as it takes up the strain of the outward
bends of the foot at the ankle-joint.
The bones of the tarsus have adapted for bearing weight of the body. The
metatarsals form a somewhat conical arch. Thus the long heel bone, calcaneous,
slops backward from below to reach the ground at the posterior end. In apes, the
plane of the tibio-talus joint is oblique in such a way as to twist the foot a little
inwards. The arching of the inner side of the sole is not so marked.
In man, the metatarsal of the big toe is firmly bound together with the other four
in marked contrast with that of the thumb. In apes, the metatarsal is relatively
and separately movable. Thus the big toe can be opposed to the other toes and
functions as a grasping organ like the human hand.
Big toe
(opposable)
We have considered the comparative anatomy of man and apes and have seen
the differences between them. However it must be noted that there are many
shared features which are ancestral traits, that is, traits inherited from the shared
common ancestor. These are human trunk similar to that of an ape, length of
arm, breadth of trunk, and shortness of the lumbar region (back bone), length of
clavicle, and many details of bone joints and muscles.
3.4 HOMINIZATION
The earliest evidence of hominids that was found, included teeth and cranial
pieces which were not enough to distinguish modern man from our closest
relatives the apes. Then, how can we identify hominids from other types of
animals, especially when these occur only as fragments of fossil remains?
The Olduvai Gorge in Tanzania is the most important site that yielded the fossil
52
evidence in abundance about the skeleton and behaviour of hominids. The layers
through which the Gorge cuts are divided into four numbered from the bottom Phylogeny of Living
Primates and Primate
as Bed I, Bed II, Bed III and Bed IV, the uppermost. Anatomy
In 1960 Leaky’s son found pieces of jaws, partial cranial vault and hand bones
from Bed 1 dated to 1.8 million years ago. The bony remains were encircled by
loosely piled stones. Leaky thought that it was a dwelling of a hominid which
belonged to genus Homo. He named it Homo habilis (handy man) believing it
to be a tool maker. The piled stones, according to Leakey were windbreak
constructed by Homo habilis. The cranial capacity after reconstruction was found
to be 680 cc which to Leakey was further proof for separating Homo habilis
from the Australopithecus africanus.
The debate among the palaeanthropologists over which of the traits-tool making,
large brain, and bipedalism-was critical in defining mankind. Yattersall has very
rightly pointed out that the spin off of this mindset was the idea of hominization,
that is, becoming human in some way was definable and separate process which
could be studied. It must be noted that all these traits did not develop
simultaneously as can be seen in hominid evolution over the last seven million
years. The process of hominization may be examined in the biocultural nature of
hominid evolution.
Knee Joint
The large human knee joint is particularly well adapted for weight bearing and
locomotion. The lower limbs are elongated. The femur is angled inward so that
the legs are directly under the body.
Pelvis
Adaptation of upright posture led to many alterations in the pelvis. The ilium
bones become shorter and broader for balancing the weight of the body and for
transmitting it from the vertebral column to the limbs. The pelvis is shaped like
a basin to accommodate the internal organs.
Vertebral Column
The Vertebral column of man is adapted to his upright posture. It has two distinct
curves, a backward thoracic one (convex) and a forward lumbar one. These two
curvatures keep the trunk and weight centered above the pelvis.
Upper Limb
Man’s upper limb shows some anatomical specializations including the freedom
and mobility of the shoulder joint. Also the human hand can be brought into
almost any position.
Skull
The cranium becomes globular and voluminous. The foramen magnum at the
base of the skull is placed further forward and as such the head is balanced on
the vertebral column.
Implications
There are numerous models that suggest the evolution of upright posture.
According to one view the evolution of erect posture may be associated with the
disappearance of thick forests and their replacement with small woods separated
by tracts of open tall grasses which indicate that such countryside might have
existed in Kenya during the Miocene epoch, once the upright posture was attained
by the hominids, bipedalism became the mode of locomotion as an adaptive
response to life in the tall grasses of savanna. They could thus spot ground
predators and potential prey.
54
Another model accounts for better dispersion of body when the head is raised Phylogeny of Living
Primates and Primate
and less surface is exposed to the sun during the hottest time of the day. This Anatomy
might have played an important role in the thermoregulation of the brain in early
hominids for the development of brain.
The importance of allowing the hands to be free while the legs are moving has
been stressed by paleoanthropologists. Selection may have favoured critical
activity if it were necessary to carry food from one location to other. Hence,
bipedal locomotion offered an adaptive advantage.
Tool use and tool making favoured bipedalism. It was an appropriate adaptation
for hominids to scavenge food. There is however no direct evidence in support
of any of these models on hominization.
3.5 SUMMARY
We read in biogenetic basis of phylogeny of living primates that various
sophisticated techniques have been developed by scientists for establishing the
phylogenetic relationship between humans and apes. The results of immunological
tests and the molecular clock constructed by Sarich and Wilson suggest the
divergence of man and apes from a common ancestor around 5 million years ago
(mya). The chimpanzees are closer to man than the gorilla. The human-
chimpanzees-gorillas trichotomy is accepted by the majority of the scientists.
3.6 GLOSSARY
Adaptation : successful interaction between populations and
environment.
Antibody : a protein produced in response to foreign antigen.
Antigen : a substance (also a protein) that causes the
production of antibody.
Brachiation : a mode of movement through the trees by swinging
alternate arms to reach from branch to branch.
Among the apes Gibbon is the extreme brachiater.
Cranial capacity : the measurement of interior volume of the brain case
expressed in cubic centimeter (c.c.)
Dental Formula : shorthand notation for the number of teeth on each
side of the upper and lower jaws.
DNA : a long stranded molecule in the gene. It directs the
(Deoxyribonucleic acid) making of an organism according to the instructions
in its genetic code.
55
Primate Study Gait : manner of walking, such as bipedal or quadrupedal
gait.
Genome : the total DNA sequences of an organism.
Foramen Magnum : the large opening on the base of the skull where the
spinal cord enters.
Pelvic outlet or basin : the brim of the pelvic cavity. It is wider in human
female.
Posture : the disposition or arrangement of the body parts.
Phylogeny : the evolutionary history or genealogy of the species
or groups of species
Savanna or Savannah : open grasslands in which the food resources are
spread.
Zygomatic arch : the cheek bone formed by the zygomatic and
temporal bone on the side of the skull.
References
Aibley, C.G. and Ahlquist, J.E. 1984. The Phylogeny of Hominoid Primates as
Indicated by DNA-DNA Hybridisation. J.Mol. Evol. 20: 2-15.
Horais, S. Hyansaka, K. Kondo, R. Tasugane, K. and Takahata,N. 1965. Recent
African Origin of Modern Humans Revealed by Complete Sequences of Hominoid
Mitochondrial DHAs. Proc.Natl. Acad. Sci. 92:532-636.
Kluge, A.G. 1983. Cladistics and the classification of the great apes. In: R L
Ciochon and R S Corrtcinni (Eds), New Interpretations of Ape and Human
Ancestory. New York:Plenum press. pp 151-177
Mai, L. L. 1983. A model of chromosome evolution and its bearing cladogenesis
in the hominoidea. In : R L Ciochon and R S Corrtcinni (Eds), New Interpretations
of Ape and Human Ancestory, New York:Plenum press. pp 87-114.
Patterson, N.D., Richter, J., Genorre, S., Lander, E.S. and Reich, D. 2006. Genetic
Evidence for Complex Speciationof Humans and Champanzees. Nature. 441:
1103-1108.
Salem, A.H., Ray, D.A., Xing, T., Callinan, P.A., Mayers, T.S., Hedger, D.J.,
Garberg,R.K., Witherspoon, D.J., Jordeh,B. and Batzer,M.A. 2000c. Alu
Elementsasnd Hominid Phylogenetics. Proc. Natl.Acad. Sci. 100: 12787-12791
Sarich,V.M. and Wilson, A.C. !971. Hominid origin revisted. In Climbing Man’s
Family Tree. Eds.Mc Cowm,T.M. Kennedy,A.R.K. New Jersy, Prentice-hall Inc.
(This article contains details about molecular clock.)
Satta,Y., Klein, J. and Takahata, N. 2000. DNA Archives and Our Nearest Relative:
The Trichotomy Problem Revisited. Mol.Phylogenetic.Evol. 14: 259-275.
Schwartz, J H. 1984. Phylogeny of Humans and Orangutans. American Journal
of Physical Anthropology 63: 217-220.
Yunish, J. and Prakash, G. 1985. The Origin of Man: A Chromosomal Pictorial
Legacy. Science. 215: 1825-1529.
56
Suggested Reading Phylogeny of Living
Primates and Primate
Napier, J.R. and Napier, P.H. 1967. A Handbook of Living Primates. New York. Anatomy
Academic Press
Srivastava, R.P. 2009. Morphology of the Ptimates and Human Evolution. New
Delhi, PHI Learning Pvt. Ltd.
Sample Questions
1) How has genetic research clarified biological relationship between humans
and large apes?
2) Write notes on:
a) Man-chimpanzees -gorilla trichotomy
b) Comment on the existing taxonomic status of man and apes.
3) Compare the morphological features of human skull with those of large
apes.
4) Describe the changes associated with evolution of erect posture in human
body.
5) Discuss the models that have been proposed by different authors to explain
the emergence of erect posture and bipedalism.
57
MANE-001
Human Genetics
Indira Gandhi
National Open University
School of Social Sciences
Block
1
INTRODUCTION TO HUMAN GENETICS
UNIT 1
Definition and Scope 5
UNIT 2
Biological Basis of Human Heredity 27
UNIT 3
Formal Genetics 42
Expert Committee
Prof. P. Dash Sharma (Retd.) Faculty of Anthropology
Dept. of Anthropology SOSS, IGNOU
Ranchi University, Ranchi
Dr. Rashmi Sinha, Reader
Prof. P. Veerraju (Retd.) Discipline of Anthropology
Dept. of Human Genetics IGNOU, New Delhi
Andhra University
Visakhapatnam Dr. P. Venkatramana
Assistant Professor
Prof. S.M.S. Chahal Discipline of Anthropology
Dept. of Human Biology IGNOU, New Delhi
Punjabi University, Patiala
Dr. Rukshana Zaman
Prof. A. Papa Rao Assistant Professor
Dept. of Anthropology Discipline of Anthropology
Sri Venkateswara University IGNOU, New Delhi
Tirupati
Dr. Mitoo Das
Dr. Roli Mathur Assistant Professor
Scientist ‘C’ Discipline of Anthropology
Division of Basic Medical Sciences IGNOU, New Delhi
Indian Council of Medical Research
New Delhi Dr. K. Anil Kumar
Assistant Professor
Dr. Seema Kalra Discipline of Anthropology
Assistant Professor IGNOU, New Delhi
Dept. of Biochemistry
IGNOU, New Delhi
Contents
1.1 Introduction and Background
1.1.1 Modes of Inheritance
1.2 Definition, Scope and Emerging Trends
1.3 Branches of Human Genetics
1.3.1 Cytogenetics
1.3.2 Biochemical Genetics
1.3.3 Immunogenetics
1.3.4 Pharmacogenetics
1.3.5 Molecular Genetics
1.3.6 Somatic Cell Genetics
1.3.7 Population Genetics
1.3.8 Genomics
1.3.9 Clinical Genetics
1.3.9.1 Genetic Diagnosis
1.3.9.2 Mangement of Genetic Conditions
1.4 Summary
Suggested Readings
Glossary
Sample Questions
Learning Objectives
&
After reading this unit, you will be able to:
Ø understand about the subject of human genetics, its origin, growth and
emergence of its branches;
Ø expalin how the characters/traits are inherited from parents to offspring;
Ø discuss about the normal and abnormal composition of the chromosomes
leading to syndromes/ disorders;
Ø elucidate the concept of “one-gene-one-enzyme hypothesis” which explains
development of genetic diseases/disorders caused by defective genes
controlling the functions of enzymes in metabolic pathways;
Ø discuss about ABO and RHD blood groups, blood group incompatibility
and the development of the branch of immunogenetics;
Ø know about the genetic defects caused by nucleotide variations in the DNA
sequence of a gene, providing understanding of molecular basis of genetic
diseases;
Ø explain the importance of somatic cell genetics, pharmacogenetics and
population genetics; and
Ø discuss the importance of clinical diagnosis, genetic counselling and
management of genetic diseases in maintaining human health.
5
Introduction to Human
Genetics 1.1 INTRODUCTION AND BACKGROUND
Man’s insatiable thirst to know more and more about himself and his surroundings
has led to the discovery of many secrets of life. Bestowed with the power of
thinking, imagination and judgment, man has been applying the knowledge he
acquired to his day to day needs and his own betterment. In this attempt he
pursued the search for explanations and scientific proofs for the origin and
existence of other forms of life including plants and animals, their organization,
life processes and their use to the mankind.
Initially it was a puzzle how the individual species maintain their identity with
characteristic features and reproduce individuals similar to them. It was observed
that a mouse reproduces mouse, an elephant another elephant and tamarind seeds
grow only as tamarind trees. In other words, it was understood that “like begets
like”. Still differences or variations were found to occur between the members
of the same species i.e. no two individuals appear to resemble exactly. What
contributes to these differences between the individuals is studied at various
levels using advanced technologies. Such studies provided explanation for
understanding the mechanisms related to the following.
a) The inheritance of characters from parents to offspring that may be simple
or complex.
b) The resemblance between the members of the same species or members of
the same family.
c) The reasons for individual differences.
d) Process of reproduction.
e) Maintenance of species identity and many more.
Such knowledge led to the development of several branches of science and of
them the “science of inheritance” attracted the attention of several scientists over
centuries which could explain the facts of life.
Inheritance of characters (traits) through generations in man was noticed from
time immemorial and in 1644 Sur Kenelm Digby cited a five generation family
with inheritance of polydactyly (extra fingers/toes) (Fig. 1.1).
Fig. 1.1: Polydactly showing extra fingers on hands and extra toes on the feet (source:
6 handfacts.wordpress.com
After a century, the French scientist Maupertuis through family studies described Definition and Scope
segregation of polydactyly and albinism (lack of pigmentation) in family
members and suggested that these two characters are inherited following different
patterns of inheritance. Further, based on animal breeding experiments he
stated that both the parents contribute equally to the inheritance of traits to their
offspring.
Later in 18th and early 19th centuries the inheritance of haemophilia, a bleeding
disorder in which the affected individuals have continuous bleeding as their blood
fails to clot when there is cut or injury and colour blindness, in which the affected
individuals can not differentiate either red or green colours, was discovered.
These two conditions showed high frequency of occurrence in males compared
to females, a typical feature of X-linked inheritance. These initial observations
of inherited characters in man prompted the concept of structural basis of heredity
which was similar to the ideas suggested later by George Mendel through his
laws of inheritance (Box 1.1).
Box 1.1
Mendel’s laws
Understanding the principles of biology was possible in the later part of 19th
century when the nature and functions of the building blocks of life “the cells”
and the stages of cell division and formation of daughter cells were discovered.
Sutton and Boveri in 1903 proposed independently the “chromosomal theory of
inheritance”. They drew one to one correlation between various stages of cell
division leading to the formation of daughter cells and the segregation of
characters from the parents to their offspring. They suggested that the hereditary
factors (genes) are located on the chromosomes and are transmitted along with
the chromosomes to the daughter cells.
Characteristic features
Every affected individual has an affected parent; trait does not skips generation
(vertical inheritance), both males and females are equally affected.
7
Introduction to Human
Genetics
Characteristic features
All the daughters of an affected male are affected; all sons and daughters of an
affected woman will be affected.
Examples: Xg blood groups; Vitamin D resistant rickets; Rett’s syndrome; Fragile
X syndrome.
Characteristic features of X-linked recessive inheritance
Absence of male to male transmission; gene in affected male is transmitted to
his grandson through his daughter; criss-cross inheritance seen; 50% of sons of
carrier woman are affected while 50% of daughters are carriers; when a male is
affected the disease may be present in male relatives of his mother.
Examples: Colour blindness; haemophilia A and B; Duchenne and Becker’s
muscular dystrophies; G6PD deficiency; X-linked ichthyosis.
Y-linked inheritance
Characteristic features of Y-linked Inheritance
Y-linked genes are located on Y chromosome and are always transmitted from
father to sons and not to daughters.
Examples: Male infertility (due to deletions in Y chromosome); Non-syndromic
hearing impairment.
1 2
3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15
Source: Desktopclass.com
Mitochondrial Inheritance
Characteristic features
The defect is transmitted to sons and daughters only through affected mothers;
affected males do not transmit the disorder to his offspring. 9
Introduction to Human Examples: Ptosis, neurological disorders, deafness and diabetes (DAD), Leber’s
Genetics
hereditary optic neuropathy (LHON,Leigh syndrome, Myoclonic Epilepsy with
Ragged Red Fibers.
1.3.1 Cytogenetics
Cytogenetics can be defined as the study of chromosomes, the hereditary units.
It has been an active field of research contributing to the understanding of
organization of chromosomes and human genome. It is a discipline that matches
phenotypes to detectable chromosomal abnormalities. In other words, you can
correlate the abnormal changes occurring in the number (numerical aberrations
like, monosomy, trisomy, nullisomy, triploidy) or structure (structural aberrations
like chromosomal deletions, duplications, translocations and inversions) of
chromosomes in an individual with the clinical features and symptoms (Table 1.1).
Table 1.1: Common chromosomal aberrations in man and their clinical features
The concept of genetic blocks in the metabolic pathways later received support
by the proposition of “one-gene-one-enzyme hypothesis by three scientists namely,
Avery, MacLeod and McCarty in 1944. Garrod also reported other genetic
conditions called albinism, pentosuria and cystinuria arising due to defects in
the respective metabolic pathways. The concept of gene controlling the activity
of an enzyme involved in a biochemical pathway led to the detection of several
inherited biochemical defects covering phenylalanine, amino acid,
mucopolysaccharide, metal, carbohydrate, lipids, and purine and pyrimidine
metabolisms. Each of these pathways may harbor several metabolic blocks leading
to overlapping or distinct clinical conditions. For example, defects in
phenylalanine metabolism may cause phenylketonuria, albinism, tyrosinosis and
alkaptonuria (Fig. 1.2). In general, human metabolic disorders follow autosomal
recessive pattern of inheritance, barring Hurler’s syndrome and Lesch-Nyhan
syndrome which follow sex linked recessive pattern.
THYROXINE
CO2 + H2O
Fig. 1.2: Diagram showing the sites of biochemical blocks in the pathway of phenylalanine
metabolism. Metabolic blocks are indicated in red: 1- Phenylketonuria, 2- Albinism,
3- Alkaptonuria, 4- Congenital Thyroxine Deficiency (Cretinism)
14
Another significant event in the history of human genetics was the discovery of Definition and Scope
sickle cell anaemia in which red blood cells in an affected individual become
sickle shaped under reduced oxygen tension (Figs. 1.3 a, b). This disorder is
inherited as a codominant condition along with normal haemoglobin. Pauling
(1949) demonstrated change in elelectrophoretic pattern of sickle cell
haemoglobin (HB S) implying chemical difference between normal (HB A) and
mutant sickle haemoglobin . The cause of HB S was identified in 1957 by Ingram
by protein fingerprinting as the substitution of glutamic acid by valine which are
coded by the codon GAG and GTG, respectively.
Fig. 1.3a: Normal and sickle shaped red blood cells (indicated by arrow) (source: proargi.us).
Fig. 1.3b: Replacement of glutamic acid in the haemoglobin of normal individual (HB AA)
by valine in the haemoglobin of sickle cell individual (HB SS).
This was the beginning of identification of molecular basis for inherited diseases.
Further, development of chromatography technique to check for the accumulated
metabolites in urine and serum and gel electrophoresis for detecting polymorphic
proteins and automated protein sequencing to identify abnormalities in the
structure of serum and cellular proteins and enzymes enhanced the identification
of several biochemical diseases with Mendelian inheritance.
15
Introduction to Human 1.3.3 Immunogenetics
Genetics
Immunogenetics can be defined as the study that is concerned with the molecular
and genetic basis of the immune response. The field of Immunogenetics has
contributed a great deal in understanding certain disorders in recent times. You
may say that the discovery of the ABO blood groups in 1900 by Landsteiner and
the proof provided by von Dungern and Hirschfeld in 1911 that these blood
groups are inherited formed the basis for the development of a separate field of
immunogenetics in the following years.
The immune system consists of antigens and antibodies that distinguish self
from nonself antigens. The immune reactions are highly specific and the antigens
react only when they come in contact with specific antibodies and this specificity
works like lock and key. ABO blood groups play an important role in blood
transfusions because blood can be given from one person to other only when
there is antigenic compatibility between the donor and recipient (Tables 2a,b).
Table 1.2a: Determination of ABO blood groups, based on reaction to added
antibodies
Table 1.2b: ABO blood groups that can be donated by the donors to the recipients
Donor blood group Recipient blood group Possibility for transfusion
A A and AB Yes
A B and O No
B B and AB Yes
B A and O No
AB AB Yes
AB* A, B and O No
O** A, B, AB and O Yes
16 * Universal recipient, ** Universal donor
Another blood group system important in transfusions is the Rh D blood groups Definition and Scope
which was discovered by the combined effort of Wiener, Levine and Landsteiner
during the second world war. Blood of some wounded soldiers got agglutinated
(clumped) when the antibodies raised in guinea pigs against the blood of rhesus
monkeys was used. This means that the antigens reacting specifically with these
antibodies are similar in man and the rhesus monkeys. The RH blood groups are
important because they may cause haemolytic disease in the RH D+ babies born
to RH D- mothers. This maternal fetal incompatibility leads to haemolytic anemia,
jaundice resulting in premature birth and even death of the newborn. The affected
offspring can be saved by giving exchange transfusion i.e. by slowly removing
the blood from the infant on one side and replacing it with fresh RH D+ blood
(Fig. 1.4, Table 1.3). In 1960 Clarke suggested a prophylactic (preventive)
treatment which is being practiced now by administering anti-RH D antibodies
just before delivery to RH D- mothers who are at risk.
b) Exchange transfusion of blood given to a new born baby with haemolytic anaemia
(source: pathologystudent.com)
Fig. 1.4: Haemolytic anaemia of the new born
17
Introduction to Human Table 1.3: Maternal-fetal incompatibility for RH D blood group system
Genetics
Father’s Mother’s Fetus Condition of
blood group blood group blood group the baby
RH D+ RH D+ RH D+ Normal
RH D- RH D+ RH D+ Normal
RH D- RH D- RH D- Normal
RH D+ RH D- RH D+ Haemolytic anaemia
Similar to red cell antigens, leucocyte (white blood cell) antigens play an important
role in kidney and other organ transplantations. The histocompatibility antigens
(HLA) comprising HLA A, B, C, D and D loci with several hundred alleles at
each locus have only two of these alleles (one derived from the father and another
from the mother) present in an individual. Therefore, it is difficult to identify a
donor with compatible genotypes for the HLA alleles that match with that of the
recipient requiring organ transplantation.
1.3.4 Pharmacogenetics
Pharmacogenetics is a growing field and is defined as the discipline that deals
with inheritance of drug sensitivity in humans. The classical example that can be
quoted is the sensitivity in humans to taste the chemical phenylthiocarbamide
(PTC) or the related compound phenylthio- urea (PTU) which is inherited as an
autosomal dominant trait. Individuals who can taste such compounds at micro
levels are called tasters (about 70% of the population) and those who can not
taste are called non-tasters (about 30% of the population). Thus the ability to
taste PTC is considered to be dominant over the non-tasting of it. The non-
tasters are found to be at higher risk for developing the condition called gout.
The first human gene to be cloned and completely seuqenced was the beta globin
gene of haemoglobin. Now hundreds of genes are cloned that help in the treatment
of diseases (e.g. human insulin used to treat diabetes mellitus). Further rapid
growth of sensitive techniques enabled manipulation of DNA, RNA and proteins
which touched every aspect of human genetics, especially clinical diagnosis and
treatment aspects.
Box 1.3
Genetic Polymorphisms
The proteins and enzymes are encoded by genes with stretches of DNA having
hundreds/thousands of nucleotide base pairs. Alteration/mutation of even a
single nucleotide in the stretch can affect structure and function of the encoded
protein/enzyme. The mutations occurring in the same gene sequence represent
the alleles. When such alleles exist more frequently in a given normal/patient
population, they are referred as polymorphic alleles.. Polymorphism is defind
as the occurrence of two or more alleles of a gene in a population such that
frequency of the rarest of the alleles is =1.0%. In a given individual only two
of the alleles can be present, one inherited from the father and other from the
mother). Thus differences or variations between individuals in a population
are found based on the combination of alleles they possess. If a gene has four
alleles, individuals with ten different allelic combinations are expected. Red
cell antigen polymorphisms (like ABO, RH D blood groups), leucocyte antigen
polymorphisms (HLA system), serum protein polymorphisms (like HP, TF),,
red cell enzyme polymorphisms (like PGM, AK) and DNA polymorphisms
(like, restriction fragment length polymorphisms (RFLPs), variable number
of tandem repeats (VNTRs), di and tri nucleotide polymorphisms and single
nucleotide polymorphisms (SNPs)) represent polymorphic genetic systems
in man.
Molecular biology techniques are being used extensively to map genes to specific
chromosomal regions; understand the clustering of SNPs on a homologue as a
group (i.e. haplotypes); linkage disequilibrium (i.e. non random association of
genes/markers present on same or different chromosomes), epistatic or non allelic
interaction between genetic loci influencing severity of diseases, exploring
population diversity in terms of genic/allelic distribution; to predict risk of a disease
in association with genetic marker/ environmental/ epidemiological factors. 19
Introduction to Human Since molecular analysis generates huge data, improved analytical biometric and
Genetics
bioinformatics tools were developed to draw reliable inferences. Generation of
super computers is expected to simpilfy the study of differences between
individuals for several thousands of SNPs that helps to understand mainly the
population diveristy, origin of races and communities and also evaluation of
drug effects on disease and drug designing, among others.
Barski et al. (1960) were the first to demonstrate spontaneous fusion of two
different but related tumor cells. Ephrussi et al. (1961) showed that large genetic
differences did not affect the cell fusions. Littlefield (1964) used HAT Medium
with hypoxanthine, aminopterine and thymidine- which selects the hybrid cells
from other cells in culture. The two mutant genes located at two different loci
complement with each other in hybrid cells which grow in the minimal medium.
Later Ephrussi and Weiss in 1965 fused mouse and rat cells for the first time
indicating that interspecific barrier does not affect cell fusions. In the same year
Okada, Harris and Watkin enhanced the frequency of cell fusions by adding
inactivated Sendai virus to the cell cultures. Later several chemicals were also
tried and of them polyethylene glycol (PEG) gave good results. Use of Sendai
virus, PEG and HAT medium together yields greater success in somatic cell
fusions.
1.3.8 Genomics
Genomics can be defined as the structural and functional studies of genome that
represents the total content of DNA within an organism or cell, including nuclear
and mitochondrial DNA. The human genome comprises of 3.2 billion nucleotides
and about 20,000 genes along with spaces between them. Under Human Genome
Project (HGP) entire DNA in human genome was sequenced in April 2003. The
sequence derived is being annotated to obtain complete map of human genome.
The organization of the human genome that has coding and non-coding sequences,
unique and repeated sequences, etc., is shown in the flow diagram (Fig. 1.5).
Pleiotropism is defined as multiple end effects of the same gene and in some
conditions may result in a syndrome. A syndrome is defined as a collection of
symptoms arising due to a single gene defect. Pleiotropism is important to clinical
medicine because certain of the multiple effects of a given gene may provide
valuable clues in the diagnosis of serious internal diseases. Variability in the
expression of any disease is another important factor in clinical medicine. If the
expression of the condition is mild, the presence of the mutant gene can not be
recognized by the phenotypic appearance. In such cases the gene is said to be
non penetrant and such an individual, when present in a family the pedigree,
shows irregular dominant pattern of inheritance. Dominant genes are often
associated with penetrance while recessive genes are often associated with varied
expression of the condition.
1.4 SUMMARY
Human genetics is a branch of science that deals with the inheritance of characters
(traits) and diseases/disorders through generations from parents to offspring.
Genetic diseases may be caused by numerical or structural chromosomal
abnormalities (like trisomies, monosomies, translocations, deletions, duplications
and inversions) due to mutations or variations in DNA. These may follow
autosomal dominant, autosomal recessive, X-linked dominant, X-linked recessive
or mitochondrial (maternal) pattern of inheritance. Genes sometimes interact
with demographic and environmental factors and thus cause difficulty in
interpreting the mode of inheritance.
The dedicated work of scientists in the past led to the steady growth of the subject
of human genetics. Biochemical defects, mutations in DNA sequence, differences
in immune responses and abnormal chromosome complements were identified
as reasons for several diseases/ disorders. This led to the subdivision of the subject
of human genetics into branches like cytogenetics, biochemical genetics,
immunogenetics, pharmacogenetics, molecular genetics, somatic cell genetics,
population genetics, genomics, clinical genetics, genetic diagnosis and counseling.
Rapid progress in the subject, especially during the past five decades, has opened
several avenues for improving quality of human health and thereby longevity.
Today, differences between the individuals can be identified at single nucleotide
level and based on this information specific drugs can be used for treatment to
suit the genetic makeup of the individual.
Suggested Readings
Emery, A. E. H. 1986. Methodology in Medical Genetics, 2nd edition.
Edinburgh:Churchill Livingstone.
23
Introduction to Human Lewis, R. 2003. Human Genetics : Concepts and Applications. New
Genetics
York:McGraw-Hill.
Strachan, T. and Read, A. P.2004. Human Molecular Genetics, 3rd edition. New
York: Garland Science.
Vogel, F. and Motulsky, A.G. 1996. Human Genetics: Problems and Approaches.
3rd edition. New York: Springer.
Glossary
Allele : Alternative form of a gene at a locus, each of which
is a viable DNA sequence occupying a given
position, or locus on a chromosome.
Autosome : A chromosome not involved in sex determination.
Chromosomal theory : The chromosomal theory of inheritance is the idea
of inheritance that genes, the units of heredity, are physical in
nature and are found in the chromosomes.
Consanguinity : Consanguineous individuals have at least one
common ancestor in the preceding few generations.
Deoxyribose nucleic : DNA is a double-stranded molecule that encodes
acid (DNA) genetic information.
Domianant gene : Alleles that determine the phenotype displayed in a
heterozygote with another (recessive) allele.
Empiric risk : The chance that a disease will occur in a family
based upon experience (past history, medical
records, etc.) rather than theory.
Epistasis : A circumstance where the expression of one gene
is affected by the expression of one or more
independently inherited genes.
Expresivity : A term used in genetics to refer to variations in a
phenotype among individuals carrying a particular
genotype.
Gene : The fundamental physical and functional unit of
heredity. A gene is an ordered sequence of
nucleotides located in a particular position on a
particular chromosome that encodes a specific
functional product (i.e., a protein or RNA molecule).
Genetic counseling : The educational process that helps individuals,
couples, or families to understand genetic
information and issues that may have an impact on
them.
Genome : All the genetic material in the chromosomes of a
particular organism; its size is generally given as its
total number of base pairs.
Genomics : Refers to the study of the entire genome of an
organism.
24
Genotype : Genetic constitution of an individual Definition and Scope
Contents
2.1 Introduction
2.2 Organization of Various Cellular Components
2.3 Cell Division
2.3.1 Mitosis
2.3.2 Meiosis
2.4 Major differences between Mitosis and Meiosis
2.5 Biochemical Basis of Cell Division
2.6 Genetic Basis of Human Variation
2.7 Summary
Glossary
Suggested Readings
Sample Questions
Learning Objectives
&
After reading this unit, you will be able to:
Ø understand cell, its structure and other cellular components;
Ø discuss mitotic and meiotic cellular divisions and the differences between
them; and
Ø explain the genetic basis of human variation.
2.1 INTRODUCTION
Earlier biologists and geneticists viewed heredity and inheritance in a different
way, some of which are presented here to widen your understanding in this unit.
Galton’s theory of blending inheritance states that the hereditary characteristics
of the parents are irreversibly mixed in the progeny. Weismann (1892) put forth
his theory of germplasm inheritance according to which germplasm was
considered immortal and formed the bridge of life passing from generation to
generation. The blood theory of inheritance states that blood acts as a vehicle for
the transmission of characters from parents to offspring. All these views have
been rendered void after Mendel’s discovery of laws of inheritance. Currently,
the principle of chromosomal theory of inheritance is the valid concept to
understand heredity.
William C. Boyd
27
Introduction to Human
Genetics 2.2 ORGANIZATION OF VARIOUS CELLULAR
COMPONENTS
Historical Background
Robert Hook (1665) observed the cell for the first time with the help of his
primitive microscope. The material that he observed was a piece of cork. This
structure of cell is now known as the unit of life. There is really no ‘typical’ cell
in which we can see all the features of the cell. Living things are composed of
material structural units called cells. A cell is the fundamental unit of structure
and function in an organism. It is that unit of organism which is delimited by
plasma membrane and is capable of self-reproduction (Loewy and Siekevitz,
1963). Sir Frederick Gowland Hopkins called cells as theaters of life. All cells
carry out the same biological function. They perform metabolic and reproductive
functions and maintain cellular integrity for our life. Cells combine to form
colonies (Functional Association) and form tissues (Facultative Association).
Cell Theory
The cell theory is a concept proposed by Schwann and Schleiden (1838-39) and
Rudolf Virchow (1858). This theory states that:
All organisms are made up of cells.
Cells are organisms.
Cells arise from pre-existing cells.
The activities of organisms are the outcome of individual cells.
Cell Types
Living organisms on earth provide us high degree of cellular diversity in reference
to cell types. There are two principle cell types’ namely unicellular simple
prokaryotes and multi cellular complex eukaryotes. The former shows the absence
of well-organized nucleus and nuclear membrane and the latter shows the presence
of them. The examples of prokaryotes (e.g. bacterial cell) and of eukaryotes (e.g.
human) are listed below:
Reproductive cells e.g. sperm, egg.
Somatic cells e.g. nerve cells.
Intestinal cells e.g. mucosa.
Columnar epithelial cells e.g. gut.
Goblet cells e.g. lumen of gut.
Connective tissue cells e.g. collagen fibre.
Muscle cells e.g. smooth muscle cell.
Unicellular organisms e.g. amoeba.
Prokaryotic cell e.g. bacterium.
Eukaryotic plant cell e.g. onion peel cell.
Eukaryotic cell e.g. human cheek epithetical.
28
Cell Structure Biological Basis of Human
Heredity
The cell consists of three principle components. They are: 1) Plasma membrane
2) Cytoplasm and 3) Nucleus, and all of them are combinely known as protoplasm.
The nucleus controls all the activities of the cell (Fig. 2.1). Besides this, the
cytoplasm possesses many organelles and inclusions. For example, endoplasmic
reticulum and mitochondrion are organelles while vacuoles and vesicles are
inclusions. The cell has two types of membranes: 1) cytoplasmic membrane
which regulates internal environment and 2) internal membrane which encloses
organelles and perform metabolic functions such as mitochondrial ATP synthesis.
There are many organelles present inside the cell. The nucleus and chromosomes
take active part in the hereditary transmission of characters so we will examine
them in greater detail in the following.
microvilli
ribosome
pinocytic
vesicles
thylacoids
nuclear
pore
cristae chloroplast
cell wall
oxysome chromatin
desomosome
nucleus
oxysome
endoplasmic
mitochon- reticulum
drion (smooth)
tubuli
Fig 2.1: Diagrammatic representation of cell structure showing differences in animal and
plant cells (Source: Gupta (1974).
The Nucleus
Nucleus is the most vital part of the cell. It controls all the activities of cell and
can be called as manager of the cellular factory. It was first discovered by Robert
Brown in 1831. It is defined as any formation surrounded by cytoplasm from
which chromosomes arise during cell division. Nucleus is present in all cells.
However, it is absent in human red blood corpuscles (RBC) and in some lens
cells.
29
Introduction to Human The nucleus consists of nucleolus proteins and nucleic acids. The nucleic acids
Genetics
are of two types - DNA (deoxyribonucleic acid and RNA (ribonucleic acid).
DNA is present in chromatin network and RNA is present in nucleolus.
The most significant role of the nucleus is to store and transmit hereditary
information from generation to generation of cells.
The Chromosomes
Chromosomes are self-reproducing thread like structures located inside the
nucleus. The word chromosome (chromo = colour, soma = body) means coloured
bodies. They can be easily stained with dyes. Hofmeister in 1848 discovered
chromosomes. They are the vehicles of heredity and serve as our horoscope. The
chromosome number varies from species to species. But it remains constant
between the members of the same species.
Fig 2.3: Human chromosomes, one member of each homologous pair, shown in groups A
to G , and in numerical order of Denver London classification. Banding pattern
indicated. The sex chromosomes X and Y are shown in groups C and G, respectively
(Source: Bhatnagar et al., 1977).
There are two phases/periods in the life of a cell. They are N (inter phase or
period of non-division) and M (phase or period of division). The longest phase
in cell cycle is the inter phase (89 hours). The cycle shows 4 distinct phases.
31
Introduction to Human G1 Phase S – Phase
Genetics
M-Phase
G2 Phase
G1 - Gap (1st Growth)
S = Synthesis
G2 = 2nd Growth
M = Mitosis
The M phase consists of the following two sub phases.
Karyokinesis – division of nucleus into two daughter nuclei.
Cytokinesis – division of cytoplasm into two daughter cells.
2.3.1 Mitosis
Mitosis is essentially somatic cell division and was first discovered by Fleming
in 1879. It is defined as that cell division which gives rise to two identical daughter
cells, each with nucleus containing the same amount of DNA and same genes as
the parent cell. Mitosis is necessary for growth and reproduction of all living
organisms.
Following are the types of mitosis.
Intra nuclear mitosis: It occurs within the nucleus (cell division).
Extra nuclear mitosis: It occurs outside nucleus but in cytoplasm.
Endomitosis: Chromosomes multiply without cell division e.g. polytene chromosome.
Mechanism of Mitosis
The mitotic division takes place in following two stages.
Karyokinesis – the division of nucleus into two daughter nuclei
Cytokinesis – division of cytoplasm into two daughter cells.
The former cell division takes place in four stages. They are prophase, metaphase,
anaphase and telophase (Figs. 2.4, 2.5). We will examine in brief these changes
in each phase.
Fig. 2.4: Some early stages of mitosis (after King, 1965) (Source: Verma and Agarwal,
1982). 33
Introduction to Human
Genetics
Fig. 2.5: Late stages of mitosis (after King, 1965) (Source: Verma and Agarwal, 1982).
2.3.2 Meiosis
Meiosis cell division was discovered by Farmer in 1905. It is also called as
reduction division or reproductive division because the diploid (2n) chromosomes
are reduced to haploid (n). It occurs only in reproductive (germ) cells. The cell in
which meiosis takes place is called meiocytes. It is more complex than mitosis.
Meiosis has two stages as follows.
2) Homotypic division (Second Meiotic division): During this, the two haploid
cells of Ist division divide into 4 haploid cells. The daughter cells are similar
to parent cell in chromosome number.
34
The important point to note here that during the first meiotic division, the Biological Basis of Human
Heredity
centromere does not divide causing the reduction in the number of chromosomes.
During second meiotic division, the centromeres divide and not the chromatids.
Meiosis – First stage (Prophase) is represented in the Fig. 2.6 and is comprised
of 5 different stages as follows.
1) First Prophase
i) Leptotene – The diploid chromosome appear in the nucleus.
ii) Zygotene – The identical chromosomes come close to each other and
undergo pairing whole length. This is called synopsis. The paired
chromosomes become Bivalent condition.
iii) Pachytene – The bivalent chromosomes coil around one another and
get shortened, chromosomes are haploid.
iv) Diplotene: The longitudinal split of chromosome give rise to 2 chromatids.
v) Diakinesis: Chromosomes coil and become further short. They remain
distributed in the Nucleus.
centriole
chromosome
Fig. 2.6: The mechanism of distribution of chromosomes during meiosis first (after King,
1965) (Source: Verma and Agarwal, 1982).
35
Introduction to Human Further stage of Meiotic division is known as Meiosis II and is represented in
Genetics
Figure 2.7. In addition to First Prophase, Meiosis consists of the following stages.
1) First Metaphase: Nuclear membrane disappears, nucleolus vanishes, nuclear
spindle develops and bivalent chromosomes move towards equatorial plane.
Each chromosome has 2 centromeres and attached to spindle fibers.
2) First Anaphase: The two pairs now get separated and move to opposite poles.
3) First Telophase: Two daughter nuclei each with a pair of chromatids formed
at the poles. The nuclei are haploid.
4) Second Metaphase: The paired chromatids are widely separated and point
of attachment is at centromere.
5) Second Anaphase: The chromatids separate in opposite poles.
6) Second Telophase: 4 daughter nuclei are formed each with haploid (N)
number of chromosomes.
centromere chromatids
Fig. 2.7: The different stages of meiosis (after King, 1965) (Source: Verma and Agarwal,
1982).
Genetic significance of Meiosis
1) Gametes are produced by meiosis and are essential units of sexual
reproduction.
2) Meiosis reduces diploid (2n) chromosomes characteristic of somatic cells to
36 the haploid number (n) characteristic of gametes.
3) Meiosis prevents in the duplication of chromosomes in the zygote which Biological Basis of Human
Heredity
otherwise would be abnormal.
4) The constant number of chromosomes is maintained by meiosis in a given species.
5) Meiosis provides new combination of genetic material due to crossing over.
The hereditary factors (genes) from males and females get mixed causing
genetic variations among species. Variations are the principle source for
evolution.
6) Meiotic drive refers to disturbance in 1:1sex ratio.
Human body with all its physical attributes is the product of heredity and
environment. Variation is due to heredity and environment says Galton. Variation
forms the principal source for evolution. When variation within a population is
converted into variation between population evolutions occurs (Lewontin, 1967).
The Mendelian school and Darwinian school differ in their very outlook of
variations. The former look at variations upward from the genes, while later
looks at variation downward from the phenotype. Variations refer to dynamic
study of gene differences in the population to understand evolutionary changes.
The greater genetic diversity in man is due to combination of alleles. Besides
this, mutations play a vital role in the maintenance of genetic variability.
With all the above mechanisms of constancy, biological systems generate new
information or combination of new information. At the backdrop of above
constancy, all biological systems have to play following two games of chance to
play.
38
Types of Variations Biological Basis of Human
Heredity
A) Phenotypic variation
Phenotypic variation
Translation
V
Proteins
Genes are located in linear fashion on the chromosomes which are made up of
DNA and proteins. Thus DNA segments are genes. It is the germ cells which
carry genes from one generation to another. Life itself is an eternal journey from
cell to cell.
The gene is made up of 4 functional units namely Codon, Recon, Muton and
Cistron. Gene is a segment of DNA molecule that codes polypeptide.
2.7 SUMMARY
This unit provides a comprehensive picture on various aspects, heredity,
inheritance, biological and genetic basis of transmission of hereditary characters
in man. Besides this, this unit is endowed with good coverage of all basic points
in reference to cell, cell structure, cell types, structural components of cell, mitosis
and meiosis their major differences and genetic basis of human variation. 39
Introduction to Human Glossary
Genetics
Phenotype : Observable hereditary characteristic of an individual.
Genotype : Characteristic present in an individual.
Karyokinesis : Division of nucleus.
Cytokinesis : Division of cytoplasm.
Diploid : The double state of all chromosomes in somatic cells
(2N).
Somatic cells : Cells of the body.
Reproductive cells : Germ cells e.g. egg, sperm.
Homogametic : Produce one type of gametes (females).
Heterogametic : Two types of gametes are produced (males).
Gene : A segment of DNA that codes for one polypeptide.
Prokaryotes : Unicellular primitive organisms.
Eukaryotes : Multicellular organisms.
Karyotype : The chromosome set of a somatic cell. It is also called
idiograph.
Locus : The site of location of the gene on chromosome.
Centromere : The constricted portion of the chromosome.
Chromatid : One of the two identical longitudinal half of
chromosome.
Crossing over : Exchange of genetic material between two homologous
chromosomes during meiosis.
Codon : A triplet of 3 successive bases in a DNA or RNA
molecule that code for single amino acid.
Cistron : The smallest structural and functional unit of the gene
which specifies the coding of a particular polypeptide.
Muton : Smallest sub unit of cistron that brings mutation in the
genetic material, as small as one nucleotide pair.
Recon : The smallest unit of sub unit of cistron that is capable
of recombination equals one nucleotide pair.
Allele : An alternate form of a gene occurring at a locus.
Meiotic drive : Refers to disturbance in 1:1 sex ratio.
Acentric : Chromosomes without centromere.
chromosome
40
Suggested Readings Biological Basis of Human
Heredity
Gupta, P.K. 1974. A Text Book of Cytology, Genetics and Evolution. Meerut:
Rastogi Publications.
Verma, P.S. and Agarwal, P.K. 1982. Genetics. New Delhi: S. Chand Publishers.
Phondke, B. 1992. Life from Cell to Cell. New Delhi : CSIR PID Publications.
Das, B.M. 1998. Outlines of Physical Anthropology. New Delhi: Kitab Mahal.
Sample Questions
1) What is the difference between prokaryotes and eukaryotes in their cell
structure?
2) What is cell theory? Who proposed it? Explain the theory.
3) What is the composition of a gene? How many functional units are present
in it?
4) Explain transcription, translation and replication with reference to DNA.
5) Define mitosis. Briefly comment on various stages of cell division.
6) Define meiosis and list various stages involved in this cell division.
7) What are the major differences between mitosis and meiosis. What is genetic
significance of cell division.
8) What is karyotype?
9) What are the three principle components of a cell? Elaborate.
10) Explain in brief various earlier theories of heredity and inheritance.
41
Introduction to Human
Genetics UNIT 3 FORMAL GENETICS
Contents
3.1 Introduction
3.2 Mendel’s Laws of Inheritance
3.2.1 Law of Uniformity
3.2.2 Law of Segregation
3.2.3 Law of Independent Assortment
3.2.4 Back Cross and Test Cross
3.3 Inheritance Patterns in Man
3.3.1 Monogenic Inheritance
3.3.2 Autosomal Dominant Inheritance
3.3.3 Autosomal Recessive Inheritance
3.3.4 Sex Linked Inheritance
3.3.4.1 X-Linked Dominant Inheritance
3.3.4.2 X-Linked Recessive Inheritance
3.3.4.3 Y-Linked Inheritance
3.3.5 Extranuclear Inheritance
3.4 Sex Limited Characters
3.5 Sex Influenced Characters
3.6 Multiple Alleles
3.7 Polygenic or Multi-factorial Inheritance
3.8 Summary
Suggested Readings
Sample Questions
Learning Objectives
&
After having studied the contents of this unit, you should be in a position to:
Ø understand the classical concepts of inheritance in man;
Ø explain the different types of simple factor human inheritance; and
Ø discuss the different types of complex types of human inheritance.
3.1 INTRODUCTION
Formal genetics deals with the study of Mendel’s laws of inheritance, suggesting
the transmission of single gene characters in the families, along with more
complex types of inheritance such as multi-factorial or polygenic inheritance.
This unit also deals with multiple allelic inheritance, which is an extension of
single genic inheritance. Further, other exceptions like epistasis are also dealt
with here. Under single genic inheritance, autosomal dominant and autosomal
recessive inheritance and sex-linked inheritance (X-linked inheritance and Y-
linked inheritance) are covered. Inheritance of sex-limited and sex influenced
characters is also described.
42
Formal Genetics
3.2 MENDEL’S LAWS OF INHERITANCE
Gregor Johann Mendel was born on July 22, 1822 to peasant parents in a small
agrarian town in Czechoslovakia. He is considered as the father of genetics.
Through his hybridization experiments on garden pea plant (Pisum sativum), in
the year 1865 he presented some basic ideas on inheritance in a research paper.
This remarkable piece of work unfortunately remained unrecognized for 34 long
years. In the year 1900, Mendel’s work was rediscovered by three botanists namely
Hugo de Vries, Carl Correns and Erich Von Tschermak. Interestingly, it was not
Mendel but Correns, one of the discoverers of Mendel’s work, who proposed this
work as Mendelian laws of Inheritance. These laws of heredity are listed below.
1) Law of uniformity.
2) Law of segregation or Law of purity of gametes.
3) Law of independent assortment or Law of free recombination.
From the monohybrid crosses, in which crosses were made between parents,
each of which exhibited one of two contrasting forms of the characters, Mendel
suggested as follows.
Genetic characters are controlled by unit factors (later called genes) that occur in
pairs on homologous chromosomes in individual organism.
When two unlike unit factors responsible for a single character are present in a
single individual, one unit factor may be dominant over the other, which is referred
to as recessive.
Cross Pollination
Tt Tt
Tt
Tt
F1 generation All Hybrid Tall Self-pollination
(First Filial Generation) (Tt)
t Tt Tt
Fig. 3.2: The Punnett’s square showing genetic constitution of offspring resulted due to the
mating between pure short and pure tall plants.
AA aa
A = Normal dominant
a = Abnormal recessive
A A a (Gametes)
a
Aa Aa Aa Aa
a Aa Aa
Fig. 3.5: The punnett squares showing the genetic contribution of the offspring resulted
from mating between pure normal and pure albino individuals.
44
For explanation see the following figures. Formal Genetics
Di hybrid cross in pea plants having yellow, round, green and wrinkled seeds.
YR X yr Corss
Pure bred Prue bred Pollination
yellow round green wrinkled
F1
F2
Checker Board
Genotype YyRr YR YR
YR Yr yR yr
YR YRYR YRYr YRyR YRyr
Yr YrYR YrYr YryR Yryr
yR yRYR yRYr yRyR yRyr
yr yrYR yrYr yryR Yryr
In case of di hybrid cross, when mating takes place in humans showing different
contrasting pairs of characters, it will be observed that assortment of genes of
one pair will be independent of the other pair.
From the above figure it is revealed that each pair of contrasting characters behaves
independently and bears no association with a particular character.
45
Introduction to Human In the ABO blood group system of human beings, ABO*A and ABO*B are
Genetics
codominant and both are dominant over ABO*O which is recessive, while in the
Rhesus blood group system, RH*D is dominant over RH*d. If an individual
with A blood group (ABO*A ABO*A) and RHD+ factor (RH*D RH*D ) marries
a person possessing O blood group (ABO*O ABO*O) and RHD- factor (RH*d
RH*d), then due to the independent assortment of the two blood group systems
9:3:3:1 dihybrid ratio is observed in the offspring.
F2 generation
Gametes ABO*A RH*D, ABO*O RH*D, ABO*A RH*d, ABO*O RH*d
ABO*A RH*D ABO*A RH*d ABO*O RH*D ABO*O RH*d
ABO*A RH*D ABO*A ABO*A ABO*A ABO*A ABO*A ABO*O ABO*A ABO*O
RH*DRH*D RH*D RH*d RH*DRH*D RH*D RH*d
ABO*A RH*d ABO*A RH*d ABO*A RH*d ABO*A RH*d ABO*A RH*d
ABO*A RH*D ABO*A RH*d ABO*O RH*D ABO*O RH*d
ABO*O RH*D ABO*O RH*D ABO*O RH*D ABO*O ABO*O ABO*O RH*D
ABO*A RH*D ABO*A RH*d RH*DRH*D ABO*O RH*d
ABO*O RH*d ABO*O RH*d ABO*O RH*d ABO*O RH*d ABO*O RH*d
ABO*A RH*D ABO*A RH*d ABO*O RH*D ABO*O RH*d
Genotype 9-different combinations.
Phenotype
Dyhybrid cross: F2 generation
9 A Blood group RH*D+
3 A Blood group RH*D-
3 O Blood group RH*D+
1 O Blood group RH*D-
46
3.2.4 Back Cross and Test Cross Formal Genetics
When F1 individuals are crossed with one of the parents from which they are
obtained, such cross is called back cross. In such back crosses, when F1 is back
crossed to the parent with dominant phenotype, no recessive individuals are
derived in the offspring. But when F1 progeny is back crossed with its recessive
parent, both phenotypes (i.e. dominant and recessive) appear in the progeny.
While both of these crosses are back crossed, only the cross with the recessive
parent is called Test Cross.
Examples
I) Monohybrid Test Cross
In a monohybrid cross of homozygous tall (DD) and homozygous dwarf (dd)
plant is crossed either with its dominant parent to perform a back cross or with
its recessive parent to perform a test cross the following results are obtained
P1
Heterozygous Tall
Dd
A) Back Cross
F1 Tall X P1 Tall
Dd DD
½ DD ½ Dd
B) Test Cross
F1 Tall X P1 Dwarf
Dd dd
½ Dd ½ dd
The test cross of heterozygous yellow round (YyRr) seeded pea plant with a
double parent recessive parent (green wrinkled yyrr) yields a test cross genotypic
ratio of 1 : 1 : 1 : 1 as follows.
47
Introduction to Human P1
Genetics
Yellow, Round X Green, Wrinkled
(Heterozygous) (Homozygous)
YyRr X yyrr
F1
1YyRr : 1Yyrr : 1 yyRr : 1 yyrr
(Or)
¼ Yellow round : ¼ yellow wrinkled : ¼ green round : ¼ green wrinkled
Autosomal inheritance
Sex-linked inheritance
Pedigree Chart
A pedigree diagram is used to follow the transmission of the character in the
families, over different generations using certain symbols as listed below.
• Squares represent males and circles represent females.
• Affected persons (proband / propositus / index case) for male and female are
shown by solid squares or solid circles, respectively.
48
• The position of affected person(s) in the family tree is indicated by arrow. Formal Genetics
Gametes 1:1
A: Mutant gene a: Normal gene
Aa = 50% (Heterozygous affected) aa = 50% (Homozygous normal)
Gametes1:1 A a
Pleiotrophy
Usually an autosomal dominant gene has one effect and thus involves only one
organ or part of the body. However, when single gene disorder produces multiple
phenotypic effects then it is called pleiotrophy. For example, in case of
osteogenesis imperfecta the mutant gene is responsible for defect in the synthesis
of collagen. However, the formation of defective collagen leads to many other
defects like osteosclerosis, blue sclera and brittle bone etc.
Incomplete penetrance
It is the extreme end of variable expressivity. In this condition a person who is
heterozygous for a dominant disorder fails to manifest a disorder clinically. Thus
it may appear as if the disorder has skipped the generation. The penetrance of a
gene in any generation is expressed in terms of percentage (%) which is calculated
from the number of offspring showing the trait as compared to the expected.
The cause of reduced penetrance or the variation in the expression of gene may
be due to influence of genes at other loci. It may be also due to the difference in
environmental factors.
Codominance
When both the traits are expressed fully in heterozygous state they are called
codominant. For example, a person with blood group AB shows both A and B
antigens on his red blood cells. The allelic genes ABO*A and ABO*B, which are
present near the tip of long arm of chromosome 9, are therefore codominant.
Intermediate Inheritance
In the heterozygous condition of a recessive trait, abnormal (mutant) allele is
unable to express itself. However, when in heterozygous condition if it shows
intermediate expression between abnormal heterozygous and normal
heterozygous then this is known as intermediate inheritance.
a Aa Aa
XRX XrXr
Affected
(affected daughter) (unaffected daughter)
Heterozygous
female (XRX) XRY Xr Y
(unaffected son) (unaffected son)
Unaffected Male
(XrY)
Xr Y
Sperms
52
Following are some of the examples of X-linked recessive traits in man. Formal Genetics
Y XHY XhY
XH = Normal gene, Xh = Abnormal gene
The hereditary patterns and mutation rates for the mitochondrial genes differ
from those for genes in the nucleus. Mitochondrial genes are maternally inherited.
They are passed only from an individual’s mother because sperms almost never
contribute to mitochondria when they fertilize an oocyte. Pedigrees that follow
mitochondrial genes show a woman transmitting the trait to all her children,
while a male cannot pass this trait to any of his children.
Unlike DNA in the nucleus, mitochondrial DNA (mt DNA) mutates faster because
it lacks DNA repair enzyme and mitochondria is the site of energy reactions that
produce oxygen free radicals that damage DNA. Also unlike nuclear DNA,
mitochondrial DNA is not wrapped in histone proteins and nor are genes
interrupted by DNA sequences that do not encode proteins called introns.
Inheritance of mitochondrial genes differs from inheritance of nuclear genes
simply because a cell has one nucleus but many mitochondria and each
mitochondrium harbours several copies of its chromosome. Mitochondria with
different alleles for the same gene can reside in the same cell.
For instance, the ABO blood groups are determined by the presence of three
alleles (alternative form of the gene) at a single locus and hence are examples of
multiple alleles. These alleles are designated as ABO*A, ABO*B and ABO*O;
the former two are dominant over the latter. A person can have any two of these
alleles present on the homologous chromosomes.
Genotype Phenotype
(Blood group)
ABO*A ABO*B AB
ABO*O ABO*O O
The ABO*A and ABO*B alleles are dominant over ABO*O allele, which is
recessive. When ABO*A and ABO*B are present together, both are expressed
and this phenomenon is called co-dominance.
3.8 SUMMARY
A bird’s eye view of the contents mentioned in the above unit will give you an
overall picture of the classical concepts of formal genetics in man, the different
modes of the simple and complex inheritances along with illustrations, with a
focus on related topics dealing with certain situations of exceptions, which we
come across while studying the inheritance patterns in man.
Suggested Readings
Lewis, R. 2003. Human Genetics, 5th Edition. New York: McGraw-Hill
Publications.
Verma, P.S and Agarwal, V.K. 2009. Genetics. New Delhi: S. Chand & Company
56 Ltd.
Jorde L.B, Carey J.C, Bamshad M.J, and White R.L 2000. Medical Genetics, Formal Genetics
2nd Edition. St. Louis: Mosby.
Barua, S. 2002. Human Genetics. An Anthropological Perspective. Kolkata:
Classsique Books.
Sample Questions
1) Describe the Mendel’s laws of inheritance. Illustrate your answers with
suitable examples.
2) Distinguish between multiple alleles and polygenic inheritance. Illustrate
your answer with appropriate examples.
3) Differentiate between the autosomal dominant and X-linked dominant modes
of inheritance giving examples.
4) Give an account of mitochondrial inheritance as differentiated from nuclear
inheritance.
5) How can you distinguish mitochondrial inheritance from nuclear inheritance?
6) Write short notes on the following.
a) Pleiotropism
b) Sex limited traits
c) Sex influenced traits
d) Variable expressivity of gene
e) Y-linked inheritance
f) Red green colour blindness
g) Albinism
h) Test cross
57
Introduction to Molecular
UNIT 1 INTRODUCTION TO MOLECULAR Genetics
GENETICS
Contents
1.1 Introduction
1.2 Scope of Molecular Genetics
1.3 Deoxyribonucleic Acid (DNA)
1.3.1 Structure of DNA
1.3.2 Features of Double Helix
1.3.3 How DNA Decides the Hereditary Features
1.4 Genome
1.4.1 Organisation of Nuclear Genome
1.4.2 Organisation of Mitochondrial Genome
1.5 Genetic Code
1.5.1 Properties of Genetic Code
1.6 Gene Expression
1.6.1 Transcription
1.6.1.1 Ribonucleic Acid (RNA) and its Types
1.6.1.2 Messenger RNA (mRNA)
1.6.1.3 Transfer RNA (tRNA)
1.6.1.4 Ribosomal RNA (rRNA)
1.6.2 Post Transcriptional Modifications
1.6.3 Translation
1.6.3.1 Proteins
1.7 Regulation of Gene Expression
1.8 Summary
Suggested Reading
Sample Questions
Learning Objectives
&
After reading this unit, you would be able to:
Ø discuss what is molecular genetics and how is it useful to mankind;
Ø describe structure and function of nucleic acids;
Ø imagine how the genome is organised in humans; and
Ø explain how genes are expressed and the ways in which gene expression is
regulated.
1.1 INTRODUCTION
DNA is the master molecule which carries the genetic information from one
generation to the other. Study of Molecular Genetics accelerated since April 25th,
1953 when James Watson and Francis Crick proposed the structure of DNA
which was published in Journal called ‘Nature’. Molecular Genetics deals with
the flow of genetic information and its regulation. In simple terms it can be
defined as the field of biology which studies the structure and function of genes
at molecular level. 5
Human Molecular Genetics
1.2 SCOPE OF MOLECULAR GENETICS
Development of techniques like nucleic acid hybridisation, cloning, sequencing
etc. brought a revolutionary change in Molecular Genetics. It is of major interest
to the students of biology and medicine. Though it has a lot of significance in
many fields, we’ll confine ourselves to the applications of molecular genetics to
the mankind. They are as follows:
i) Diagnosis of infectious diseases: Normally microorganisms are detected in
the laboratory using biochemical methods. In case of molecular techniques,
microorganisms are detected by using probes (short DNA or RNA sequence)
which are complementary to a part of genome of the microbe. The advantage
of using molecular methods is:
• Identification of pathogen is done within a short time;
• No need to cultivate the microbes;
• Latent infections can also be identified when no antibody is formed; and
• The technique can be used even when the microorganism cannot be
cultured.
ii) Diagnosis of genetic diseases : Before the advent of the above techniques,
counselors used to give risk estimate like one fourth risk of getting the
disease, if the parents are heterozygous for an autosomal trait. But now by
directly testing for the mutation, they are able to confirm the presence or
absence of mutation in the fetus. It is of immense help in prenatal diagnosis.
iii) Individuals can be identified and relationship can be determined by DNA
fingerprinting.
iv) Mouse models for genetic diseases have been developed by creating
transgenic mice.
v) Production of vaccines, antibodies and therapeutic proteins using
recombinant DNA technology. Eg; Insulin, Human Growth Hormone.
vi) It has great potential for treating disease. Gene therapy is a process where
the cells of a patient are genetically modified to alleviate disease.
vii) With the development of recombinant DNA technology, identification of
disease genes became much easier. Once the disease gene is identified, a
molecular test can be designed for diagnosis of genetic disease.
DNA Fingerprinting
Just like no two individuals have identical finger prints, no two individuals
have identical genetic information, except monozygotic twins. Unlike finger
prints which are present only on the tips of the fingers, the genetic
information which is unique to the individual is present in each and every
cell. Alec Jeffrey discovered repetitive sequences called minisatellites to
be unique to every individual. DNA fingerprinting is a technique which
makes use of these sequences to evaluate genetic information. It’s a quick
way to compare the DNA sequences of any two living organisms. It is used
for personal identification, identification of the parents, when babies are
switched in hospital, identification of criminals etc.
6
Introduction to Molecular
1.3 DEOXYRIBONUCLEIC ACID (DNA) Genetics
DNA is the thread of life. It is the hereditary material in all organisms except in
certain RNA viruses. All the information that is needed for the development,
behavior, well being etc. of an individual is encoded in its structure. The genetic
information that’s stored in DNA flows through RNA to proteins. This flow of
genetic information is referred to as central dogma of molecular biology. Though
the information is present in the DNA, it is the activity of proteins that is
responsible for the inherited traits. The function of DNA is to direct its own
replication and to direct transcription.
7
Human Molecular Genetics
Nitrogenous
base
Phosphate
Deoxyribose
sugar
There are two kinds of bases- purines (double ringed) and pyrimidines (single
ringed). A purine (Adenine and Guanine) always pairs with a pyrimidine (Thymine
and Cytosine). Therefore, the amount of purines present in a DNA molecule is
equal to the amount of pyrimidines. Adenine always pairs with Thymine with
two Hydrogen bonds whereas Guanine always pairs with Cytosine with three
Hydrogen bonds. The two strands of the DNA can be separated easily during
replication because of the weak Hydrogen bonds.
Fig. 1.3: Pentose sugar ; Purines and pyrimidines (Source : Berg JM et al, 2002 Biochemistry
WH Freeman & Co.)
The sugar is a pentose sugar which is deoxyribose in DNA because it lacks
Oxygen at second Carbon position. To distinguish between the Carbon atoms
present in the base and sugar, the Carbon atoms in the sugar are given a prime
(‘). The bases attach to the sugar (at 1’C) by glycosidic bond.
The phosphate group links the 3’C atom of one sugar with the 5’C atom of
adjacent sugar by a phospodiester bond. Because of the negative charges present
on the phosphate groups, DNA is a polyanion. In vivo, these charges are neutralised
by the positively charged histone proteins.
The bases are stacked on one another 3.4Ao apart and are perpendicular to the
axis of the double helix. The diameter of the helix is about 20Ao and each complete
turn of helix measures 34Ao, thus accommodating 10 base pairs in each turn.
Stacking of base pairs (bp) results in major and minor grooves in DNA. Major
groove is rich in chemical information and is recognised by sequence specific
DNA binding proteins.
1.4 GENOME
A genome is the total genetic information present in a cell. Basing on the
complexity of humans, if you assume that among all species, the human beings
have the largest amount of DNA, you’re mistaken. This is because many plant
species have much more DNA per cell compared to humans. Even among
vertebrates, it’s the amphibians which have the greatest amount of DNA per cell.
The organisation of human genome is very complex. It comprises of two genomes
(Nuclear and Mitochondrial).
9
Human Molecular Genetics 1.4.1 Organisation of Nuclear Genome
The nuclear genome constitutes more than 99% of the total genome. The haploid
genome contains 3 billion bp. The haploid genome is distributed in 23 different
types of chromosomes (22 autosomes and 1 allosome). Each chromosome contains
many genes. The genes are not uniformly distributed on the chromosomes. A certain
area of the chromosome may be rich in genes while areas like centromere and
telomeres are largely devoid of genes. Some chromosomes are rich in genes (22nd
chromosome) some are gene poor (4th chromosome). The genes which are part
of same metabolic pathway may be on different chromosomes and genes which
are no way connected to metabolic pathway may be side by side on the
chromosome.
There is tremendous variation in the size of the gene, size of the exon as well as
intron. On an average an exon may contain < 200bp. Size of the intron may vary
from 100bp to >100,000bp. About 1.5% of the total genome is coding (Exon is
the coding region and Intron is non coding).
A number of protein coding genes in the human genome form gene families. A
set of genes which code for similar protein sequences or which have nucleotide
sequence similarity form a gene family (just like related individuals make a
family). They arose by duplication of the ancestral gene and accumulation of
independent mutations over a period of time. Eg: members of beta globin gene
family. An individual won’t have same beta globin throughout his development.
Apart from beta globin (â) there are different genes like ä, Gã, Aã and å which
code for slightly different polypeptides. They express during different stages of
development of an individual and forms a gene family. Members of a gene family
generally appear as a cluster or they may be dispersed.
å Gγ Aγ ψβ δ β
More than half of the genome contains repetitive sequences. Basing on the number
of copies per genome, the DNA sequences are classified into-unique sequences
(1-10 copies), moderately repetitive sequences (10-105copies) and highly
repetitive sequences (>105copies). Unique sequences include most of the genes
which code for proteins. Example for moderately repetitive sequences is the
genes which code for ribosomal RNA and histone proteins. Highly repetitive
sequences are tandemly arranged and are transcriptionally inactive. They are
once again classified into mega satellite, satellite, mini satellite and micro satellite
according to the decreasing size of the repeat. Mega satellites are very few in
number. Satellite DNA is present in the centromeric region of the chromosomes.
The length of the mini satellite DNA is quite variable among individuals and is
the basis for DNA fingerprinting. Microsatellites constitute single base runs, di,
tri and tetra nucleotide repeats.
Transposons, the DNA sequences which are capable of moving from one part of
the genome to other constitute about 45% of the total human genome. Most of
them are nonfunctional. Transposition is RNA mediated ie., DNA is first
transcribed into RNA and then reverse transcribed into cDNA which is the double
10
stranded form is inserted elsewhere in the genome.
There are pseudogenes in the genome which are nonfunctional copies of a Introduction to Molecular
Genetics
functional gene eg. pseudo beta(øâ) in beta globin gene family. They also arose
by duplication of the ancestral gene but in course of time accumulated mutations
which rendered them non functional. Few overlapping genes (in class III region
of HLA complex present on 6th chromosome.) and genes within genes (presence
of two genes within the intron of clotting factor VIII gene) also exist in the
genome.
The size of the human mtDNA is 16,569 bp. It is circular and double stranded. It
lies naked in the organelle. mtDNA isn’t associated with histone proteins. It
contains a light chain and a heavy chain. Heavy strand is rich in guanines and
light strand is rich in cytosines. DNA is triple stranded at a region, due to
duplication of a section of heavy strand and is called D loop. D loop has no
coding sequences. mtDNA has altogether 37 genes out of which 13 code for
polypeptides, 22 for tRNAs and 2 for rRNAs. In contrast to nuclear genome,
about 93% of the mtDNA is coding. The genome is compact with no introns and
presence of overlapping genes. Mitochondria have their own ribosomes on which
polypeptides are synthesized. It has a slightly different genetic code when
compared to that followed by the nuclear genome.
The mitochondria synthesize only some of the proteins needed by it, others being
synthesized by the nuclear genes. The proteins produced by the nuclear genome
are imported into mitochondria. mtDNA shows maternal inheritance because all
the mitochondria received by the zygote are from the ovum. Mutations in mtDNA
are responsible for certain diseases in humans.
11
Human Molecular Genetics
1.5 GENETIC CODE
We now know that DNA contains the information that is necessary for the
production of proteins. The question is how the information stored in DNA can
be decoded into a protein? One of the two DNA strands is transcribed into RNA.
This RNA which contains the coded information, acts as a messenger molecule
which is further translated into polypeptide. It’s essential to understand the nature
of genetic code to understand how the coded information in RNA is decoded to
protein. Genetic code is a dictionary for the translation of mRNA into protein.
DNA is made up of only 4 different nucleotides (A,T,G and C) and proteins are
synthesized from 20 different amino acids. The question is how 4 nucleotides
could specify 20 amino acids ? A singlet code (each nucleotide codes for one
amino acid) specifies only 4 amino acids, a doublet code (2 bases code for one
amino acid) specifies only 16 amino acids (42). So the minimum number of
nucleotides needed to code for 20 different amino acids is 3. This group of 3
nucleotides or nucleotide triplet is called a codon. A triplet code will contain 64
codons (43) which are in excess of the number of amino acids. The code was
deciphered in 1960s by the important contributions made by Nirenberg, Matthaei,
Gobind Khorana and Ochoa.
You may have a doubt whether the same genetic code is followed by plants,
animals and bacteria as all of them have same 4 bases in their genetic material.
Yes, genetic code is universal, except slightly different code is used in
mitochondria and by few prokaryotes. Because of this property, we are able to
translate mRNA from one species, in a cell of another species (recombinant
DNA technology).
3’ UCC 5’ → serine
As translation occurs in 5’→ 3’ direction, it’s apt to read the codons in 5’→3’
direction only.
The code is non overlapping: Each codon consists of three consecutive nucleotides.
That is none of the nucleotide is part of 2 codons. Eg. 5’ GCUACCUGC 3’
Non overlapping code will specify only three amino acids. NH2-ala-thr-cys-COOH.
Overlapping code will specify seven amino acids. NH2-ala-leu-tyr-thr-pro-leu-
cys-COOH.
The code is comma less: There is no gap or punctuation between 2 codons. After
one amino acid is coded, the second one will be coded automatically. If there is
any gap between two codons, deletion or addition of one base should not change
the reading frame. But a change in reading frame was observed which means
that code is comma less.
Reading Frame
The code is unambiguous: Though there are few exceptions, a particular codon
will always specify the same amino acid. Eg. GCU always codes for alanine.
The code contains “start” and “stop” signals: There is only one start codon (AUG)
whereas termination codons (UAA, UAG and UGA) are three in number.
Wobble Hypothesis: Leaving the three termination codons which are recognised
by proteins, the remaining 61 codons are recognised by tRNAs. There are only
about 30 types of cytoplasmic tRNAs. Then how’s it possible to interpret 61
codons? This is possible because of the relaxation of normal base pairing rules
when it comes to codon-anticodon recognition. According to Wobble hypothesis
of Crick, normal A-U and G-C rules are followed for the first two base positions
only but wobbling occurs at third position (G can pair with C or U and U can
pair with A or G).
13
Human Molecular Genetics
1.6 GENE EXPRESSION
Before going to gene expression, let us first understand the meaning of gene, the
number of genes in humans, their location and their structure. In simple terms,
gene is a stretch of DNA that carries the information necessary for the synthesis
of a polypeptide. Actually the definition of gene is much more complex. Today
we know that a single gene can give rise to many polypeptides. There are about
25,000 genes in humans according to Human Genome Project. The number of
proteins about two lakhs is far greater than the number of genes because of
alternative splicing. Genes are located on chromosomes. Each chromosome
contains many number of genes arranged in a linear order. Eukaryotic genes are
split genes, which means that their coding sequence is not contiguous but it is
interrupted by noncoding or intervening sequences called introns. The coding
sequences or the expressed sequences are called as exons. In addition to the
coding and noncoding sequences, there are flanking regions which are important
in regulation and have ‘start’ and ‘stop’ signals. These include promoter which is
located at the 5’ end of the gene and a sequence that is present at the 3’ end which
provides the signal for the addition of poly A tail to the 3’ end of mature mRNA.
DNA
1↓ 1. Transcription
Primary transcript
2↓ 2. Post transcriptional
m RNA modification
3 4. Translation
m RNA
4↓ 5. Post translational
protein modification and folding
5↓
active protein
14
Here you should note the point that only a small proportion of the total DNA Introduction to Molecular
Genetics
(1.5%) is coding. Moreover, all the genes that are transcribed are not translated
that is the end product of some genes is RNA itself eg: tRNA, rRNA etc.
1.6.1 Transcription
It’s a process in which single stranded RNA is generated from one of the strands
of the DNA. It occurs in nucleus in 5’→ 3’ direction. It needs RNA polymerase,
ribonucleotides and several proteins for initiation. Only one of the two strands
of the DNA acts as a template. RNA that is synthesized is complementary to the
template but similar in sequence and orientation to that of nontemplate strand
(except U is present in place of T). Therefore nontemplate strand is called sense
strand and template strand is called antisense strand. Whenever we want to give
a gene sequence, it’s customary to give the sequence of sense strand in 5’ to 3’
direction.
Transcription
5’____________________________3’ RNA
ACAUGCCUAUACCGACCAGCUAUU
Fig. 1.10: Process of transcription showing the similarity between RNA and sense strand
The first base that’s transcribed is denoted +1 and the bases that are proceeding
in the right side (5’→ 3’) are indicated by positive numbers and the direction is
called downstream. Conversely the bases towards the left side of +1 are indicated
by negative numbers and the direction is called upstream. The promoter which
is present in the upstream region of the sense strand contains a group of short
sequence elements called TATA box, GC box, CAAT box etc. These elements
will be recognised by proteins called transcription factors (TFs). Only when TFs
bind to the promoter, followed by binding of RNA polymerase, then transcription
occurs. There are three kinds of RNA polymerases in humans. RNA polymerases
I and III transcribe the genes which code for tRNA, rRNA and various small
RNAs. Structural genes (genes which code for proteins) are transcribed by RNA
polymerase II. Termination occurs in them by endonucleolytic cleavage
(downstream to a sequence AAUAAA) followed by addition of poly(A) tail.
15
Human Molecular Genetics 1.6.1.2 Messenger RNA (mRNA)
It’s this RNA, which carries the message present in the gene to the cytoplasm
where synthesis of protein occurs. Only the central part of the mRNA is translated.
The region of the first exon and the last exon which are not translated are denoted
as 5’UTR and 3’UTR. Each group of three mRNA bases constitutes a codon
which specifies an amino acid. The length of different mRNAs vary considerably
basing on the length of the gene.
About 80% of the total RNA is rRNA. Generally the largest of the RNAs, along
with ribosomal proteins it forms the ribosome. A ribosome is made up of two
subunits, both of which join at the time of protein synthesis.
Larger subunit: 3 kinds of rRNAs (28S, 5.8S and 5S) + about 50 ribosomal
proteins. Smaller subunit: single rRNA (18S) + more than 30 ribosomal proteins
We’ve already discussed about alternative splicing due to which we are getting
about 2,00,000 proteins from the 25,000 genes we have. In simple terms,
alternative splicing means getting more number of mRNAs from a single gene.
This is possible by differential splicing in different tissues. For eg. a sequence
which acts as an intron in one tissue may act as a coding sequence in another
tissue thereby changing the sequence of the polypeptide in different tissues.
16
Introduction to Molecular
Genetics
Fig. 1.12: Alternative splicing where liver is using only two exons whereas all the three are
used in the muscle
1.6.3 Translation
It’s a process in which the information present in an mRNA is decoded into the
amino acid sequence of a protein. It requires mRNA, tRNA, ribosomes, ATP and
various protein factors. It occurs on ribosomes in the cytoplasm. It also occurs in
5’→3’ direction. The 5’ end of mRNA corresponds to the amino terminus of the
protein. Translation starts from the initiation codon and ends with the termination
codon. That’s the reason why most of the polypeptides start with methionine.
Initiation of translation requires several factors which include a cap binding
protein, initiation factors, smaller subunit of the ribosome, initiator methionyl
tRNA, all of which bind to the 5’ cap region of the mRNA. The initiation complex
formed scans the mRNA for the initiation codon. In the elongation step, larger
subunit attaches to the initiation complex. The codon next to the AUG is then
Gene
recognised by another tRNA which brings the mRNA
second amino acidpolypeptide
of the
polypeptide chain. A peptide bond is formed between the two amino acids and
5’ successive amino acids 3’ are incorporated
liver into the growing polypeptide chain.
3’ This process continues5’till the termination codon is reached
AAAA which is recognised
1 by a protein
2 but 3not tRNA. Finally the caplast1 tRNA
3 will be released from the
ribosome,
exons the two subunits of the
muscle ribosome separate and the new polypeptide
will be released. AAAA
Cap 1 2 3
It’s a waste of energy for the cell to produce the proteins which are not needed by
it. Cells have their own methods, by which they can regulate the expression of
genes. Interestingly it’s the proteins which are largely responsible for regulation
of gene expression. Regulation occurs at three levels.
5’ 3’ gene
3’ 1 2 3 ↑ 4 ↑ 5’
exons poly A1 poly A2
Liver muscle
m RNA
AAAA AAAA
cap 1 2 3 cap 1 2 3 4
polypeptide
Fig. 1.14: Alternative polyadenylation where liver uses polyA1 signal and muscle
usespolyA2 signal
Kidney Heart
Translation
protein
Fig. 1.15:174
RNA amino acids
editing showing substitution of a single base in 7877
th amino acids
codon, thereby converting
it into a stop codon in heart. Thus, a single gene expresses as 174 amino acid
F protein in kidney and 77 amino acid protein in heart.
19
Human Molecular Genetics
1.8 SUMMARY
Molecular Genetics deals with the study of gene expression and its regulation.
Revolutionary changes occurred in the field of molecular genetics due to the
invention of molecular techniques. It has several applications like diagnosis of
genetic as well as infectious diseases, treatment of the disease, personal
identification etc.
Genetic code is the relationship between the nucleotide sequence of mRNA and
amino acid sequence of protein. The genetic code is triplet, degenerate,
nonoverlapping, commaless and universal.
Gene expression is a two step process. First the information present in DNA is
transcribed to RNA. Later the information in the mRNA form is decoded to
amino acid sequence of the polypeptide by translation. The polypeptide that is
formed during translation, undergoes folding and post translational modifications
to form a functional protein.
Gene expression is highly regulated. Each cell contains all the genes present in
the total DNA. However to save energy, cells express only the proteins needed
by it, in required amounts and at needed time. This kind of control over gene
expression is achieved largely by proteins. Gene expression is regulated at
different levels like transcription, post transcription, translation. Major control
occurs at the transcriptional level. Same gene can produce different forms of
proteins in different tissues by mechanisms like alternative splicing, alternative
polyadenylation and RNA editing.
20
Suggested Reading Introduction to Molecular
Genetics
Strachan, T and Read, A.P. 2004. Human Molecular Genetics. Wiley-Liss.
Lewin, B. 2004. Genes VIII. Prentice Hall.
Watson, J.D, Baker, T.A, Bell, S.P, Gann, A, Levine, M and Losick, R. 2004.
Molecular Biology of the Gene. Pearson Education.
McConkey, E. H. 1993. Human Genetics. The Molecular Revolution. Jones and
Barlett Publishers.
Sample Questions
Short Notes
i) MtDNA
ii) Genome
iii) RNA and its Types
21
Human Genetics
UNIT 2 METHODS OF HUMAN GENETIC
STUDY
Contents
2.1 Introduction
2.2 Pedigree
2.3 Chromosome Analysis
2.4 Karyotype Analysis
2.5 Cytogenetic Methods
2.6 DNA and Recombinant Technology
2.7 Biochemical Methods
2.8 Paternity Testing
2.9 Twin Studies
2.10 Immunological Methods
2.11 Summary
References
Suggested Reading
Sample Questions
2.1 INTRODUCTION
At first sight, man appears to be an unfavourable object for genetic study. Plant
and animal geneticists use breeding methods to raise successive generations under
similar environmental conditions.
In man, however, the genetic diversity of individuals is great and
uncontrolled, and biological and social environment vary greatly. In man,
as we cannot do experimental crossing, so the studies on inheritance pattern
are based on a series of generations.
23
Human Genetics For human genetical study, the observer, that is the geneticist, and the object of
his observation, a family, or pedigree, of say three to four generations, is restricted,
as the duration of a generation is alike in the observer and in the object of
observation. Many factors affecting transmission of hereditary traits obey
statistical laws and are best studied when large numbers of offspring are available.
In man, these numbers are always small, even large human families fall far short
of the size desirable for statistical deductions.
Methods of human genetic studies may be taken up at the family / pedigree level
by simple or clinical observation, while at the cellular level through chromosomal
studies of particular cases in families. At the population level for understanding
human variation of different morphological anthropometric traits,
deramtoglyphics and other anatomical traits, population sero-genetical markers
like blood groups, PTC, ABH secretion etc., and biochemical traits like G6PD,
haptolobin and tranferrin, and other red cell enzyme polymorphisms through
electrophoretic methods are being conducted. Lately DNA fingerprinting
techniques are being used to assess migration and population affinities of different
ethnic groups and their biochemical relationship at different levels. These are
highly specialised methods of study of human population groups at the genic
level.
We will discuss briefly about all these methods of human genetic studies at the
family and population level, so as to make you aware about the different methods
of human genetic studies now normally being used by human geneticists.
2.2 PEDIGREE
A pedigree is a diagram of family relationships in which symbols are used to
represent people, and lines are used to represent genetic relationships. These
diagrams make it easier to visualize the relationships within the families,
particularly large extended families. Pedigrees are also often used to determine
the mode of inheritance of genetic diseases (Strachan and Read. 1999).
24
Various symbols used in pedigree analysis: Methods of Human Genetic
Study
(p= proband)
(Adapted from www.bios.niu.edu/johns/genetics)
The major characteristics are following:
• It manifests in the heterozygous state i.e. in a person possessing both an
abnormal and normal allele,
• Gene is located on autosome,
• Both males and females are equally affected, and
• Vertical family history may be seen and male to male transmission is possible.
Example: Marfan syndrome, Huntington’s disease.
25
Human Genetics Autosomal recessive inheritance
27
Human Genetics Mitochondrial inheritance
Chromosome spreads can be photographed, cut out, and assigned into the
appropriate chromosome number or they can be digitally imaged using a computer.
The chromosomes can be divided into seven groups (A-G) based on descending
order of size and position of the centeromere. The standard nomenclature for
describing a karyotype is based on the International System for Human
Cytogenetic Nomenclature (ISCN) (www.science.jrank.org).
30
Karyotype analysis is important for some abnormalities: Methods of Human Genetic
Study
Klinefelter syndrome
A male with the genotype 47, XXY with extra X chromosome leads which to
features of the condition commonly known as Klinefelter syndrome.
31
Human Genetics
Turner’s syndrome: A female with genotype (45, X), with one X chromosome
missing
32
Methods of Human Genetic
2.5 CYTOGENETIC METHODS Study
36
polymorphisms to the total genetic variance. Recent advances in statistical Methods of Human Genetic
Study
modeling allow simultaneous analysis of many variables in relatives such as MZ
and DZ twins.
1) Agglutination Tests
2) Coomb’s Test (Antiglobulin Test)
3) Precipitation tests
4) Immunoelectrophoresis
2.11 SUMMARY
Modern techniques like Cytogenetic methods identify the underlying genetic
causes of various diseases/disorders. Immunological methods help to identify
the various infectious agents that aid in the manifestation of the diseases and
thus help in the cure. Methods like DNA fingerprinting are very important to
solve the paternity disputes and also help in forensics to identify the right culprit.
DNA recombinant technology brings hope and opportunity to cure the genetic
disorders that are otherwise incurable. Thus understanding and application of
the genetic methods is very important for better disease control and good public
health.
References
Adams, J. 2008. Paternity Testing: Blood Types and DNA. Nature education 1(1).
Biroccio, A., Leonetti, C. and Zupi, G. 2003. The Future of Antisense Therapy:
Combination with Anticancer Treatments. Oncogene 22:6579–6588.
Boomsa, D., Busjahn, A. and Peltonen, L.2002 Classical Twin Studies and
Beyond. Nature publishing group 3.
Burgess, R.R. 2008. Protein Purification. In: H. G. Nothwang and S. E. Pfeiffer
(Eds.), Proteomics of the Nervous System, Chapter 1, pp. 1-18. Weinheim;
WILEY-VCH Verlag GmbH & Co.
Comai, L. 2005 The Advantages and Disadvantages of Being Polyploid. Nature
Reviews, Genetics. 6:836-46.
Fenech, M. 2002. Micronutrients and Genomic Stability: A New Paradigm for
Recommended Dietary Allowances (RDAs). Food Chem Toxicol 40: 1113–1117.
Graff J.C. 2006. Community Nursing: Medical Care for Children and Adults
with Developmental Disabilities. 2nd edition.
38
Gupta, V. 2005. Recombinant DNA Therapy in Medicine. Keio J Med 54 (2): 85–94. Methods of Human Genetic
Study
Mayer, G. 2006. Immunology - Chapter Seven Immunoglobulins- Antigen-
Antibody reactions and selected tests.: 67-74.
Muller, R.F. and Young I.D. 2001. Emery’s Elements of Medical Genetics (11th
edition). Edinburgh; Churchill. Livingstone. Rooney DE .
Peruski, A., and Peruski, F. 2003 Immunological Methods for Detection and
Identification of Infectious Disease and Biological Warfare Agents. Clinical and
Diagnostic Laboratory Immunology. 10: 506–513.
Rowley, J. 2001. Chromosome Translocations. Nature Reviews Cancer 1: 246.
Strachan, T. and Read, A,P. 1999. Human Molecular Genetics (2nd edition).
New York; Wiley-Liss.
Tseng, C.C. 1995. Human Chromosome Analysis. Proceedings of the 16th
Workshop of the Association for Biology Laboratory Education 16: 33-36.
www.biotech.about.com accessed on November 18, 2010
www.bogari.net accessed on January 17, 2011
www.bookrags.com accessed on November 18, 2010
www.docstoc.com accessed on November 18, 2010
www.doctorsmedicalopinion.com accessed on April 29, 2011
www.dramarabiochem.blogspot.com accessed on March 10, 2010
www.genetics.emory.edu accessed on March 10, 2011
www.genetics.emory.edu accessed on March 11, 2011
www.nature.com. accessed on March 10, 2011
www.pathmicro.med.sc.edu accessed on April 10, 2011
www.science.jrank.org accessed on March 10, 2011
www.scientific-web.com accessed on March 10, 2011
www.scribd.com accessed on April 29, 2011
Yang, L., Li, S., Hatch, H., Ahrens, K., Cornelius, J.G., Petersen, B.E. and Peck,
A. 2002. In vitro Trans-Differentiation of Adult Hepatic Stem cells into Pancreatic
Endocrine Hormone Producing Cells. Proc Natl 99: 8078–8083.
Suggested Reading
Gardner, E. J., Simmons, M.J. and Snustad, D.P. 1991. Principles of Genetics.
New York, John Willey & Sons.
Lewis, R. 2003. Human Genetics: Concepts and Applications 5th edition. Boston,
WCB McGraw Hill.
39
Human Genetics Whittinghill, M. 1965. Human Genetics and Its Foundations. Calcutta, New
Delhi, Oxford and IBH Publishing Company.
Sample Questions
1) Identify the mode of inheritance in the given below pedigree?
40
Methods of Human Genetic
UNIT 3 POPULATION GENETICS Study
Contents
3.1 Introduction
3.2 Mendelian Population
3.3 Genetic Polymorphism
3.4 Hardy-Weinberg Law
3.5 Deviations from Hardy-Weinberg Law or Factors Affecting Gene Frequencies
3.6 Consanguineous and Non-consanguineous Mating
3.7 Genetic Load
3.8 Summary
References
Suggested Readings
Sample Questions
3.1 INTRODUCTION
Genetics, a discipline of biology, is the study of fundamental units of inheritance
called genes, heredity, and variation in living organisms. This hereditary material
(gene), whether as a unit of segregation, recombination, mutation, or function, is
the unifying idea basic to the field of genetics. In 1866, Gregor Mendel put
forward the mechanisms for heredity and variation. The Mendelian laws: the
independent segregation and recombination of dominant and recessive characters
constitute the cornerstone of the modern science of genetics. Mendel’s
monumental work (1866) on the principles of inheritance, that is, Mendel’s Laws
of inheritance, remained long ignored, and only received attention in 1900, sixteen
years after his death (1884). It was not until 1900, when three botanists, de Vries,
Correns, and Von Tschermak independently rediscovered the Mendelian
Principles. Later Mendel’s experiments were extended to many species of plants
and animals including man.
41
Human Genetics Human genetics is a subject of special interest to us as students of anthropology.
Human genetics itself is further subdivided into the areas of medical genetics,
biochemical genetics, cytogenetics, somatic cell genetics, immunogenetics, formal
or mathematical genetics, population genetics, and anthropological genetics.
These subdivisions of human genetics are closely interrelated and interdependent.
For example, the study of the distribution and evolution of the abnormal
haemoglobins in human populations witnessed the union of medical genetics,
biochemical genetics, formal genetics, and population genetics.
Population Genetics
Study of a whole population is, in fact, often superior to the collection of large
pedigree, because pedigree has unusual characteristics and is of specific interest,
and thus is not representative of a population. Within many populations an
equilibrium of genotypes prevails. This was first pointed out in 1908
independently by the mathematician G. H. Hardy and the physician W. Weinberg
whose several contributions laid the foundations of the genetic study of natural
populations of man and wild animals. The foundations by Sewall Wright, R. A.
Fisher and J. B. S. Haldane helped the formation of modern population genetics.
The mathematical theory of population genetics was developed in the early
twentieth century due largely to the work of Sewall Wright, Ronald Fisher, and
J. B. S. Haldane. So the population genetics deals with the consequences of
Mendelian laws on the composition of the population with special reference to
the effects of mutation, selection, migration, and chance fluctuation of gene
frequencies.
42
mating patterns, gene flow, natural selection, etc. The genetic approach uses the Population Genetics
concept of the Mendelian population, which Dobzhonsky has defined as “a
reproductive community of sexual and cross fertilizing individuals which share
in a common gene pool”. If the isolate or the Mendelian population is not changed
by natural selection, nor by mutation, nor by migration, and if the population
size is large and if individuals are not mating assortatively (that is, random choice
of partners), then the isolate is said to be in equilibrium. These assumptions are
fundamental to population analysis and for maintaining an equilibrium of
genotypes from generations to generations.
Although, all human gene pools are open to varying degree, it is evident that
panmixis does not take place within the total species. The more important
mechanisms maintaining genetic isolation of populations today are cultural rather
than geographical.
Breeding Population
In addition to the problem introduced by the biological openness of human-
population systems, accurate definition of a human Mendelian population is
complicated by the fact that man clusters in social groupings which may or may
not serve as biological breeding units. So the first problem of the population
geneticist, therefore, is to identify and describe, as accurately as possible, the
biological population before he can undertake an analysis of the gene pool and
forces acting on it. Because direct analysis of a population’s gene pool is
impossible, all conclusions regarding its composition are necessarily inferential,
and must be made on the basis of direct examination of the phenotypes of the
reproducing individuals. To infer the composition of a gene pool at a single
point in time the population geneticist must first enumerate and describe the
actual progenitors, that is, the parents in a population. These progenitors constitute
the breeding population.
One of the oldest known such polymorphism is the ability to taste phenyl-thio-
carbamide (PTC), or phenyl-thio-urea (PTU). For some people PTC has only a
faint taste or no taste at all; for others it has a very bitter taste. More specifically
there is a single dominant gene T (with incomplete penetrance) that determines a
high sensitivity for the taste of PTC. Non-tasters are homozygous for the recessive
allele t. When both parents are non-tasters, all their children are non-tasters.
When one parent is taster and the other is not, either all or half of their children
will be tasters, depending on whether or not the parent of the dominant (tasting)
type is homozygote or heterozygote.
Male gametes → P q
↓ Female gametes
P P2 pq
Q pq q2
Genotype frequencies: p2+2pq+q2
Let us examine what would be expected under random mating in a simple and
general case of an autosomal locus with two alleles A and a with frequencies, p
and q and the corresponding genotypes AA, Aa and aa with the corresponding
frequencies, p2:2pq:q2. The various mating types and the expected progeny are
given in the following table.
46
Applications of Hardy-Weinberg Law Population Genetics
• Non-random mating
Random mating, or panmixis, refers to the selection of a partner regardless of
that partner’s genotype. Non-random mating can lead to an increase in the
frequency of affected homozygotes by two mechanisms, either assortative mating
or consanguinity.
Assortative mating
Assortative mating is the tendency for human beings to choose partners who
share characteristics such as height, intelligence and racial origin for marriage. 47
Human Genetics Consanguinity
Consanguinity is the term used to describe marriages between blood relatives
who have at least one common ancestor no more remote than a great-great
grandparent. Widespread consanguinity in a community will lead to a relative
increase in the frequency of affected homozygotes with a relative decrease in the
frequency of heterozygotes.
• Mutation
The validity of the Hardy-Weinberg principle is based on the assumption that no
new mutations occur. If a particular locus shows a high mutation rate then there
will be a steady increase in the proportion of mutant alleles in a population. In
that case the law will not be applicable.
• Selection
In the ‘ideal’ population there is no selection for or against any particular genotype.
In reality for deleterious characteristics there is likely to be negative selection with
affected individuals having reduced reproductive fitness in genetical sense, as the
genes would not be transmitted in the next generation. In the absence of new
mutations this reduction in fitness will lead to a gradual reduction in the frequency
of the mutant gene and will cause disturbance of Hardy-Weinberg equilibrium.
Selection can act in the opposite direction by increasing fitness. For some
autosomal recessive disorders there is evidence that heterozygotes show a slight
increase in biological fitness as compared with unaffected homozygotes. This is
referred to as heterozygote advantage. The best understood example is sickle-
cell disease in which affected homozygotes have severe anemia and often show
persistent ill-health. However, heterozygotes are relatively immune to infection
with Plasmodium falciparum malaria because if their red blood cells are invaded
by the parasite they undergo sickling and are rapidly destroyed. In areas in which
this form of malaria is endemic, carriers of sickle-cell anemia, who are described
as having sickle-cell trait, are at a biological advantage as compared with
unaffected homozygotes. Therefore, in these communities, there will be a tendency
for the proportion of heterozygotes to increase relative to the proportions of
normal and affected homozygotes. Once again this will result in a disturbance of
Hardy-Weinberg equilibrium.
We have earlier discussed about selection favouring heterozygotes as in sickle-
cell anaemia, and thalassaemia. There is also the opposite situation, that is
selection against heterozygotes, as we find in maternal-foetal incompatibility
(Erythroblastosis fetalis) as is observed for the allele R (Rh blood group), and
also for other blood group genes (Rh-ABO incompatibility).
Mutation alters genotype frequencies by introducing new alleles.
Heterozygotes and new mutations maintain the frequencies of deleterious
alleles in populations.
Different alleles are more likely to confer a survival advantage in different
environments. Cycles of infectious disease prevalence and virulence often
reflect natural selection.
In balanced polymorphism, a disease-causing allele persists because
heterozygotes resist a certain infectious illness or environmental condition.
Gene flow alters genotype frequencies by adding and removing alleles from
populations.
48
Population Genetics
Clines are gradual changes in allele frequencies between neighboring
populations.
Geographical barriers and language differences often create great differences
in allele frequencies.
Genetic drift occurs when a subset of a population has different allele
frequencies than the larger population.
The founder effect occurs when a few individuals leave a community to
start a new settlement. The resulting population may, by chance, either lack
some alleles from the original population or have high frequencies of others.
•` Genetic drift
In a large population the numbers of children produced by individuals with
different genotypes, assuming no alteration in fitness for any particular genotype
will tend to balance out, so that gene frequencies will remain stable. However, in
a small population it is possible that by random statistical fluctuation one allele
could be transmitted to a high proportion of offspring by chance, resulting in
marked changes in allele frequency from one generation to the next, so that
Hardy-Weinberg equilibrium is disturbed. This phenomenon is referred to as
random genetic drift. If one allele is lost altogether then it is said to be extinguished
and the other allele is described as having become fixed (www. faculty.ksu.edu).
• Gene flow (migration)
If new alleles are introduced into a population as a consequence of migration
with subsequent intermarriage, this will lead to a change in the relevant allele
frequencies. This slow diffusion of alleles across a racial or geographical boundary
is known as gene flow. The most widely quoted example is the gradient shown
by the incidence of the B blood group allele throughout the world. This allele is
thought to have originated in Asia and spread slowly westward as a result of
admixture through invasion.
50
Fig. 4.1: The possible types of matings between different relationships
Population Genetics
People choose partners for marriage, and they do not contribute the same
numbers of children to the next generation. The marriage practices change
allele frequencies in populations.
Traits lacking obvious phenotypes may be in Hardy-Weinberg equilibrium.
Consanguinity and endogamy increase the proportion of homozygotes in
a population.
Effect of Consanguineous Marriages
The main genetic consequence of inbreeding is an increase in the proportion of
homozygotes. Through inbreeding recessive genes are more easily brought to
the fore.
Inbreeding Depression
Usually, inbreeding causes deterioration and outbreeding causes improvement
of most of the characters. Animal breeders noticed that inbreeding particularly
always lead to a deterioration in many important qualities; fertility for instance,
tends to decrease and many an inbred stock, has lost because the fertility level
became too low for the maintenance of the line in generations. In addition, some
traits such as overall general size also decrease. This phenomenon of deterioration
on inbreeding is known as inbreeding depression.
Heterosis
In contrast to inbreeding depression, if two independent pure lines are crossed,
the hybrids between them (at least in the first generation) mostly show a
considerable increase in size, fertility and many other desirable traits. This has
been called hybrid vigor or heterosis, and clearly has a great potential for
application in agriculture and animal husbandry. The first practical application
of hybrid vigor as a technique for crop improvement was applied to corn and it
led to a very significant increase in production. This practice is now being
extended to other plants and animals. These inbreeding and outbreeding
consequences are also seen in man. The genetic effects of inbreeding are similar
to positive assortative mating. Both increase the frequency of homozygous
genotypes at the expense of heterozygotes, relative to Hardy-Weinberg
proportions. So it is clear that the inbreeding affects genotype frequencies and
inbreeding along with selection modifies gene frequencies in a population.
It should be emphasised that the increasing homozygosity i.e., the general effect
of inbreeding does not predict whether inbreeding is good or bad. It depends on
the nature of the homozygotes. Many instances can be cited of talented persons
whose parents were first cousins or otherwise closely related. Presumably
consanguinity made it easier for ‘good’ genes to come together in these cases
(example: Charles Darwin).
On the other hand, there is considerable evidence that homozygous recessives,
albinism, alkaptonuria, etc., and the lethals are encountered with greater frequency
in consanguineous marriages than in marriages of unrelated persons. Studies in
Japan, where inbreeding is greater have shown increased rates of infant mortality
and congenital abnormalities. Studies in France, Sweden, United States, and
Japan have shown increased frequencies of certain physical diseases, and mental
disorders among children of first cousin mating.
51
Human Genetics
3.7 GENETIC LOAD
Among source of variability affecting Darwinian fitness (adaptive value) may
lead to a genetic load. Crow (1970) proposed three definitions of genetic load of
which mostly used one is that the (expressed) genetic load is the fraction by
which the average population fitness is decreased in comparison with the genotype
showing the highest fitness.
3.8 SUMMARY
A population is a group of interbreeding members of the same species in a
particular area. Their genes constitute the gene pool. Population genetics considers
allele, genotype, and phenotype frequencies to reveal microevolution. Phenotypic
52
frequencies can be determined empirically. Genotype frequencies change if Population Genetics
migration, nonrandom mating, genetic drift, mutations, or natural selection
operate. In Hardy-Weinberg equilibrium, frequencies are not changing. Hardy
and Weinberg proposed an algebraic equation to explain the consistency of allele
frequencies. The Hardy-Weinberg equation is a binomial expansion used to
represent genotypes in a population. According to Hardy-Weinberg equilibrium
all individuals mate with the same frequency and choose mates without any
consideration to phenotype. This seldom happens. We choose mates based on
certain characteristics, and some people have many more children than others.
Consanguinity increases the proportion of homozygotes in a population, which
may lead to increased incidence of recessive illnesses or traits.
Clines are changes in allele frequencies from one area to another. Clines may
reflect geographical barriers or linguistic differences and may be either abrupt or
gradual. Genetic drift occurs when a small population separates from a larger
one, or its members breed only among themselves, perpetuating allele frequencies
not characteristic of the larger population due to chance sampling. A founder
effect occurs when a few individuals found a settlement and their alleles form a
new gene pool, amplifying their alleles and eliminating others. Mutation
continually introduces new alleles into populations. Mutation does not have as
great an influence on disrupting Hardy-Weinberg equilibrium as the other factors.
The genetic load is the collection of deleterious alleles in a population.
Environmental conditions influence allele frequencies via natural selection.
Alleles that do not enable an individual to reproduce in a particular environment
are selected against and diminish in the population, unless conditions change.
Beneficial alleles are retained. In balanced polymorphism, the frequencies of
some deleterious alleles are maintained when heterozygotes have a reproductive
advantage under certain conditions.
Reference
Jurmain, R., Kilgore, L. and Trevathan, W. 1998. Essentials of Physical
Anthropology. Belmont California; Wadsworth.
www. faculty.ksu.edu accessed on February 19, 2011
Suggested Reading
Cavalli-Sforza, L. L. and Bodmer, W. L. 1971. The Genetics of Human
Populations. San Francisco; W. H. Freeman and Company.
Ford, E. B. 1967. Genetics for Medical Students. Sixth edition. London; Methuen
& Co. Ltd.
Hartl, D. L. and Clark, A. G. 2006. Principles of Population Genetics. 4th Ed.
Sunderland; MA. Sinauer Associates.
Mange, E. J. and Mange, A. P. 1994. Basic Human Genetics. Sunderland; MA.
Sinauer Associates.
Mueller, R. F. and Young, I. D. 1998. Emery’s Elements of Medical Genetics.
New York; Churchill Livingstone.
Stern, C. 1960. Principles of Human Genetics. San Francisco and London;
Freeman and Company.
53
Human Genetics Sample Questions
1) What is a population? List three populations.
2) Explain the differences among an allele frequency, a phenotypic frequency,
and a genotypic frequency.
3) What does Hardy-Weinberg equilibrium mean?
4) What are the conditions under which Hardy-Weinberg equilibrium cannot
be met?
5) Why is knowing the incidence of a homozygous recessive condition in a
population important in deriving allele frequencies?
54
Meaning and Scope
UNIT 1 MEANING AND SCOPE
Contents
1.1 Introduction
1.1.1 Inheritance-Historical Development
1.2 Unit of Study
1.2.1 Gene Pool
1.2.2 Breeding Isolation
1.3 Mating Patterns
1.3.1 Random Mating
1.3.2 Assortative Mating
1.4 Inbreeding
1.4.1 Consanguineous Marriages
1.4.2 Types of Inbreeding/Consanguineous Marriages
1.4.3 Consequences of Inbreeding
1.4.4 Measures of Inbreeding
1.4.5 Inbreeding Coefficient
1.4.5.1 Inbreeding in Families (Pedigree)
1.4.5.2 Inbreeding in Populations (Fp)
1.4.6 Extent of Consanguineous Marriages in India
1.5 Summary
Suggested Reading
Sample Questions
Learning Objectives
&
After reading this unit, you will be able to:
Ø define biological inheritance and describe its historical development;
Ø discuss breeding isolation and its implications in human population genetics;
Ø define and outline various mating patterns;
Ø explain inbreeding and types of consanguineous marriages; and
Ø measure inbreeding in families and in populations, its consequences of
inbreeding/consanguineous marriage.
1.1 INTRODUCTION
Population Genetics can be defined as the study of genetic transmission in
populations of interbreeding organisms. It is the study of the nature and source
of the inherited differences and involves predicting the changes that may take
place in relative frequencies of different genes that may be found in a population,
and determining a condition under which equilibrium between forces affecting
their frequencies may be obtained.
The science of population genetics deals with Mendel’s laws and other genetic
principles as they affect entire populations of organisms. The organisms may be 5
Human Population Genetics human beings, animals, plants or microbes. The populations may be natural,
agricultural or experimental. The environment may be city, farm, field or forest.
The habitat may be soil, water or air. Because of its wide ranging purview,
population genetics cuts across many fields of modern biology. A working
knowledge has become essential in genetics, evolutionary biology, systematic,
plant breeding, animal breeding, ecology, natural history, forestry, horticulture,
conservation and wildlife management. A basic understanding of population
genetics is also useful in medicine, law, biotechnology, molecular biology, cell
biology, sociology and anthropology.
Population genetics also includes the study of the various forces that result in
evolutionary changes in species through time. By defining the framework within
which evolution takes place, the principles of population genetics are basic to
broad evolutionary perspectives on biology. Many oddities in biology become
comprehensible in the light of evolution: they result from shared ancestry among
organisms, and they attest to the unity of life on earth. One of the purposes of
population genetics is to study the mechanism of origin and maintenance of
genetic variability. The genetic variability is studied in terms of polymorphism
of various genetic markers, as polymorphism usually refers to alternative
hereditary forms that can easily be distinguished from each other and whose
inheritance is clearly understood. Human populations are polymorphic for a large
number of genetic loci. These polymorphic loci are useful for constructing linkage
maps, genetic counselling, paternity testing and studying the evolutionary
relationships of human populations. The association between gene frequencies
and environmental factors has been made for number of polymorphic loci. It
seems that this type of association study is an effective way to make an inference
about selective mechanisms, which could be done by having the data on the
distribution of gene frequencies among various populations, provided that the
population is endogamous. If there are gene frequencies for a number of loci in
a population, the heterozygosity for individual locus can be calculated and average
heterozygosity per locus of a population is obtained. The average heterozygosity
indicates the magnitude of genetic variation that exists within a population.
Evolution and genetics are inextricably connected because the biological changes
that occur in organisms through time are due to changes in their hereditary
information changes in their genes. To a geneticist, evolution refers to changes
in gene and genotype frequencies that arise and accumulate through time in
populations and organisms (it is populations, not individual organisms, which
evolve). These cumulative changes in gene and genotype frequencies are subject
to natural selection, a process originally proposed by Charles Darwin. Charles
Darwin, in his landmark work ‘On the Origin of Species by Means of Natural
6
Selection’ altered the course of intellectual history in the Western World. Like Meaning and Scope
Newton, Copernicus, Galileo and others, Darwin proposed a mechanistic
explanation for natural phenomena. Darwin argued that the diversity of life on
earth could be accounted for by the operation of simple and observable processes
that are part of our everyday experience. Darwin made the assumptions that
phenotypic variation is partly determined by hereditary differences between
individuals. It is remarkable that the mechanisms of heredity transmission were
not then known because as Darwin himself realised, the theory of evolution by
natural selection depended critically on the way in which hereditary information
is passed from generation to generation in interbreeding populations, which he
himself was unable to account for. Darwin realised that for his theory of natural
selection to be plausible and for the adaptive modifications, observed as
phenotypes, to be passed on from one generation to the next, a mechanism of
hereditary transmission was required otherwise the offspring will not resemble
their parents and fitness-enhancing traits will not spread through the population
but he was not able to shed light on this. The fact that he could not explain the
mechanism of inheritance was the main objection to his theory of evolution. He
accepted a weak form of Lamarck’s use and disuse theory to explain origin of
variation and attempted to work out a way for explaining mechanism of
inheritance by assuming that in response to environmental stimuli, somatic cells
of body would release entities called ‘gemmules’. According to him, these
‘gemmules’ carried information on the traits of the organism and would
accumulate in germ cells and get passed on to the next generation. But he could
not prove this. He knew that for selection to operate in a population and gradually
alter it, continuous supply of variation was required. There were scholars who
believed in importance of selection for creating new adaptive changes. Others
doubted that selection acting on continuous variations was sufficient to transform
one species into another. Still others advocated Lamarckism. It took the discovery
of genes and mutations in the 20th century to render natural selection feasible and
unavoidable as an explanation for evolution.
Historically the first and still the most conclusive evidence for the existence of
genes come from the phenomenon of segregation of traits observed in the offspring
of hybrids between individuals or strains that differ in some recognizable aspect.
The principle behind the transmission was for the first time demonstrated by
Austrian monk Gregor J. Mendel (July 20, 1822 – January 6, 1884). His
publications on the results obtained from the very carefully selected breeding
experiments on ‘hybridisation’ conducted on Pisum sativum in monastery gardens
of Austria for eight years (1856-1863) indicated that the transmission of these
(seven) characters (height, size and shape of seed, colour of flowers etc. among
pea plants) are particulate in nature. The hereditary transmission of the above
traits follows specific pattern what has termed as law of independent assortment
and law of segregation. According to Mendel’s laws, given the parental phenotype/
genotype combination, it is possible to predict the likelihood genotype/phenotypes
of the offspring. Another important aspect of the discovery of Mendel’s laws is
that the transmission of hereditary traits from parents to offspring follows simple
binomial expectation with stochastic perturbation, which is more likely to be
true in a large sample size.
Possibly, people expected that the results obtained by Mendel is more related to
hybridisation and are of importance to breeding animals and the implications
that Mendel’s discovery of hereditary units, the secret behind the heredity and its
implications to overall biology, was possibly realised by a few, until after three
decades later by the rediscovery of his laws in 1900 simultaneously by Hugo De
Vries in Holland, Carl Correns in Germany and Erich Von Tschermak in Austria,
who found Mendel’s forgotten paper and proclaimed its importance. Immediately
his conclusions began to be confirmed and extended by experiments carried on
in various parts of the world on many kinds of plants and animals.
It was from the Mendel’s rediscovery of laws of hereditary that describes how
the characters that he selected – e.g., height, seed colour – among plants follows
simple principles of transmission, it became clear that the cause for the hereditary
transmission of a particular (Mendelian) character is governed by what Mendel
hypothesised as ‘hereditary unit’. This hereditary unit was later described as
‘gene’ by William Bateson and the subject that deals with the heredity and its
transmission rules and regulations is the discipline of ‘Genetics’. The hereditary
transmission of traits, its variation or extent of diversity among regional
populations, how its changes over time, what are the factors and causes that
influence these changes all are important for us and the study that deals with it in
brief is the ‘human population genetics’. It also deals with theoretical and
empirical studies to understand the how different traits change over time and
factors governed its mechanism at the population level, at amino acid, enzyme,
molecular level etc.
It may not be less worth mentioning here that genotype frequencies are determined
in part by pattern of mating. To deduce the genotype frequencies from the
estimated allele frequencies, British mathematician, G.H.Hardy and German
Physician, W.Weinberg independently formulated a model in 1908 describing
the relationship between the gene and genotype frequencies, and this relationship
is now popularly known as Hardy-Weinberg principle or Hardy-Weinberg
equilibrium (H.W.E), which eventually laid down the foundation of genetic
analysis of population.
Population genetics deals with the changes in gene frequency over generations
in a population. In the context of evolution, according to Darwin, it is the species
living in a given eco-niche evolves over time and this is brought by what he
called as ‘natural selection’, the driving force for the evolutionary change among
species. The unit of study in the biological realm of Darwinian evolution is the
species. Apart from the phenotypic characters that is/are characteristic (identity)
of given species — what we can understand from the common English usage
that is quite opt to the topic, for example, “birds of the same feather flock
together”, — interbreeding within a species is prime distinguishing character
that defines a species, the study unit. This is in a way identified by characteristic
species specific phenotypic traits. In general, in nature, mating is restricted to
within the species; as such the phenotypic and genetic characters are transmitted
through generations and become restricted to a given species. Therefore, mating
within a species is compatible and matings between species are unlikely and are
supposed to be incompatible. However, Man was successful in bringing out
interspecies matings between related species e.g. Lion and Tiger, Horse and
Donkey, etc. in artificial circumstances (cross-breeding) creating some unusual
types such as ‘tigon’ and ‘mule’ (was supposed to be infertile). The mating within
a species or a group restricts the transmission of characters through generations
within the group or a species. This is similar to water pond or pool/lake where
the water is contained and restricted to its geographical space.
The urban population tend to have large and higher values of MMD and their
gene pool extend over a large spatial distance. Among these populations they are
characteristic of lower endogamy rates, which become difficult to define them
as breeding isolates or gene pools. Another difficulty is in urban communities
10
are tend to show higher interbreeding with other communities, which poses Meaning and Scope
problems for considering them as breeding isolates or gene pools for population
genetic studies. Though there are very few studies about the interbreeding or
admixture in various populations, but in general such rates are about 1-2 per
cent among the rural endogamous groups and among urban communities it can
vary as high as 10%. Due to socio-economic reasons such admixture or
interbreeding is increasing among urban societies.
CY - Challa Yanadi
IY - Insular Yanadi
P1 - Upper Plateau Yanadi
P2 - Lower Plateau Yanadi
HF - Hill Forest Yanadi
11
Human Population Genetics
1.3 MATING PATTERNS
Hereditary transmission of characters from generation to generation depends on
type and selection of males and females that they participate in sexual selection
leading to reproduction. Both in animals and human populations mating behaviour
is very complex and it is non-random. The selection of male and female is
characterised by a variety of patterns and certain pattern is characteristic of some
groups. Charles Darwin while elucidating his hypothesis of origin of species by
natural selection, considered sexual selection is an important criterion that plays
a role in the successive reproduction that might lead to proliferation of desired
qualities in the offspring. Those who are not so successful in selecting a mate
will have least possibility of successful reproduction of their abilities being
transmitted in the next generation. These abilities or characters stands eliminated
in successive generations. In human populations, there is a wide variety of mating
patterns and marriage norms, rules and regulations. These vary in different
societies and communities.
The non-random nature of choice of mate or mate selection can lead to significant
genetic changes. There are different types of mating. The genetic significance of
each type of mating can be investigated theoretical and its theoretical expectation
of the possible genetic changes over generations can be worked out or marriages
in diverse societies. These are described below.
12
1.3.2 Assortative Mating Meaning and Scope
In all human populations, from simple societies of tribes and to complex societies
of urban in metropolis, people usually like to select their marriage partners, mates
or spouse, i.e., non-randomly, with desirable characters of their liking. This is
referred as ‘assortative mating’, an important factor of non-random selection of
mates that exists in all human societies. Assortative mating is one of the deviations
from random mating assumption of Hardy-Weinberg equilibrium. According to
H W Law the gene frequency in a population is expected change as a result of
non-random mating due to assortative mating.
Choice of mate selection is more concerned directly with respect to some specific
phenotypic characters (rarely genotypes are involved) and it might involve,
indirectly, other characters which are associated or related to selected traits or
characters among spouses or mates. For example, choice of marriage partner
could be based on such desired or preferred traits e.g., skin colour, age preferences,
intelligence, social status etc. In case one selects intelligence as the criterion it
might be associated with high social status, which may not be desired trait.
In general, the institution of marriage, in human populations, prescribes rules
and regulations that allow members of the community choice to select his/her
spouse or marriage partner. Assortative mating refers to the preferential marriages
(or mating) between individuals that involve either similar traits such as
intelligence or phenotypic characters such as height, skin colour etc. or it might
involve different traits of phenotypic characters. Assortative mating is one type
of non-random mating that commonly occurs among human populations.
Assortative mating could be of two types: positive and negative mating. In positive
assortative mating (homogamy) type both the spouses choose or select their mates
on the basis of common phenotype or of similar characteristics. Conversely, the
negative assortative (heterogamy) mating types are those where the partners select
their mates based on different or dissimilar phenotypic traits.
For example, if tall and fair people choose to marry those with similar traits of
equally tall and fare peoples, then it is assortative mating involving phenotypic
characters of tall and fair skin colour. Similarly the opposite can also happen
where people choose their mates unlike themselves or with dissimilar or opposite
traits. In general, in some societies, in mate selection, there is preference (or
selective advantage value) for fair skin colour people to get married. Conversely,
people with dark skin colour are avoided or least preferred as ones’ spouse. In a
patrilineal society, it is observed that males with dark skin colour prefer to marry
fair skin brides. In these communities, there is negative assortative mating
involving selection of dissimilar characters (dark and fair skin colour) between
the males and females. In simple positive assortative mating people marry their
spouse who are similar to them and in negative assortative mating spouse avoid
similar characters or marry their spouse with dissimilar or diverse phenotypic
traits.
1.4 INBREEDING
In many societies marriages takes place between relatives. In general, breeding
among close individuals within a group is referred as ‘inbreeding’, and it is 13
Human Population Genetics applicable in case of plants and animals. The extent of inbreeding depends on
the amount of common ancestry shared by the parents of the ‘inbred’ child (the
progeny of a consanguineous marriage or inbreeding) or in genetic terms it is the
proportion of genes that the parents have in common. It is opposite to outbreeding
referring to breeding with the individuals from outside the group or unrelated
individuals.
In human societies the marriages contracted among relatives and are referred as
‘consanguineous marriages’ or ‘inbreeding’. Consanguineous is more with
reference to cultural context and inbreeding is more with reference to general
breeding that include Man and other organisms.
The cousin marriages could be of different types: for example, parallel, cross
and double cousin marriages etc. The marriage between the cousins who were
descendents of two brothers or sisters (or whose (either) parents are either brothers
or sisters) is referred as parallel cousin marriages. An individual marries his or
her paternal uncle’s daughter or son is referred as parallel cousin marriage. The
word ‘parallel’ refers to same sex (either brothers or sisters) at the parental level.
In case of cross cousin marriages, it is the marriage between the offspring (cousins)
who’s (either) parents are brother and sisters. In cross cousin marriage an
individual marries his or her maternal uncle’s daughter or son is the cross cousin
marriage type. Apart from the above two there could be one more type of cousin
marriages, it is called as double cross cousin marriages. In double cross cousin
marriage, the marriages between a brother and a sister of a family marry their
cousins a sister and a brother of their uncle or aunts respectively. In cross cousin
marriage either a boy or a girl marries his or her uncle’s daughter or son (cousin)
respectively. In double cross cousin marriage type both a boy and a girl marry
their uncle’s or aunts’ girl or son (cousins) respectively.
15
Human Population Genetics Such cases pose health and survival problems of deleterious or debilitating
diseases. This is health and socio-economic burden to the society and to the
country. Increase of deleterious characters as a result of inbreeding is referred as
‘inbreeding load’.
In case the population is large enough, some of the undesirable characters which
are deleterious, over long inbreeding in a population, suppose to get eliminated
by selection and thus attributes to better fitness and increased survival advantage
to the population.
The above theoretical expectations differ from the empirical studies conducted
on the consequences of inbreeding and its effects in human populations. These
results are not uniform across populations and there has been a debate on the
deleterious or harmful effects of inbreeding in human populations. This could
be partly due to problems of study design, the methodology used and the history
of inbreeding in the population. Some studies show significant differences with
respect to some characters considered among the inbreeding and non-inbred
population, while others have not found such differences in other populations
studied. These studies on inbreeding effects are concerned with characters such
as fertility, offspring mortality, morbidity, diseases, and rare genetic disorders,
etc.
There are at least two types of inbreeding measures. These measures can be
calculated or estimated at different levels or type of data: pedigree data, population
data and based on variety of traits: phenotypic, genetic and genomic information.
The two measures are:
16
1) A genetic similarity measure to find out how or to what extent two related Meaning and Scope
individuals are genetically similar; and
2) The effect of inbreeding on the fitness of inbred offspring, described as
‘inbreeding depression’
Malecot (1948) defined inbreeding coefficient ‘F’ based on the probability that
the homologous genes of uniting gametes are ‘identical by descent (ibd)’.
Therefore, F is the probability of autozygosity
Inbreeding coefficient == coefficient of consanguinity
== coefficient of ancestry
An inbred individual has genes that are likely to be same with the ancestor.
The inbreeding coefficient can be calculated (estimated) by different methods
for pedigrees and populations and for a variety of data as well.
In the above diagram first cross cousin and parallel cousin marriages are shown.
X is the inbred ( ), his or her parents are cousins and an example of
consanguineous marriage ( = ).
The right hand side of the diagram is short form of representing the inbreeding
in the pedigrees. Here the ancestors are not themselves are inbred, so that the
term (1 + FA) is zero for the above pedigree.
The inbreeding coefficient of the x in the above can be calculated as per the
above formulae: The pedigree shows two loops. Here FA is zero as the ancestors
are unrelated and not inbred.
18
If one wants to count number of paths, then there are six paths (lines) (p) that Meaning and Scope
connect x through one common ancestor and another six paths (lines) (p) through
the other common ancestor.
By using any one of the formulae it is easy to calculate FX for example:
FX = Σ [(1/2) na (1 + FA)] = (1/2)5 + (1/2)5 (1) = (1/16)
FX = Σ [(1/2) np —1 (1 + FA)] = (1/2)6-1 + (1/2)6-1(1) = (1/16)
The above inbreeding coefficient refers to autosomal loci. But the same can be
extended to estimate the inbreeding coefficient for sex-linked chromosomes (Fs)
as well. In that case there is no inbreeding coefficient for a male offspring and
the path if there are two consecutive males Fs will be zero.
Here for example, we have a one such complex inbreeding drawn from field
work studies among tribal villages which shows one such large complex
inbreeding network involving several families (see box 1). Indeed to calculate
the inbreeding coefficient for such complex pedigree will be difficult. But now a
days there are several methods of drawing the related marriages and luckily there
are softwares on the internet services they can provide quick way of drawing the
pedigree of complex nature and to calculate the inbreeding coefficient as well.
19
Human Population Genetics
Box 1
In some populations the inbreeding
marriages may run in several
generations. Here is one such short
pedigree of 5 generations showing only
those individuals leading to
inbreeding. This is drawn from large
pedigree involving 20 families from a
tribal village. The pedigree shows four
inbred individuals with varied
inbreeding coefficient. I expect you
will be interesting to calculate the
inbreeding coefficient of the four
individuals
Fp == Σ (ci .Fi)
20
Table 1.2: Extent of consanguineous marriages and inbreeding among muslims in Meaning and Scope
different states of India
State/ No. of Type of Marriage Inbreeding
Region Marriages UN I.C Total Coefficient
Andhra Pradesh 356 3.37 32.87 36.2 0.025
Tamil Nadu 6116 0.88 16.29 19.5 0.012
Kerala 215 — 16.74 22.3 0.012
Maharashtra 2014 — 14.00 20.71 0.010
Madhya Pradesh 351 7.41 19.09 59.3 0.026
Rajasthan 412 — 31.55 41.3 0.022
Uttar Pradesh and 1000 — 27.7 49.4 0.020
Delhi 1483 — 11.4 27.6 0.010
West Bengal 835 — 20.36 22.2 0.013
471 — 8.28 19.3 0.007
1.5 SUMMARY
1) An understanding of the human population genetics starts with an idea of
the concept of heredity, historical development of the concept and to the
present knowledge of the concept of Mandelian hereditary unit and genetics
and its developments.
21
Human Population Genetics 2) In human populations the study of population genetics is the gene pool, the
study unit. To identify and investigate the extent of gene pool requires
understanding of the breeding isolation, especially who marries whom and
where. This demographic information helps us to understand the extent of
endogamy.
3) Sexual selection is one of the important mechanism that can significantly
influence the pattern of gene transmission in a population. In case of random
mating, where everybody can marry anybody as per HW equilibrium the
genetic pattern is expected to be influenced by selection, drift and mutational
pressures.
4) In human populations mating is non-random. Each population follows a
variety of rules and regulations in selecting their marriage or mating partners.
There are preferences or criterion of mate selection, one such criterion is
based on e.g., morphological characters, intelligence, socio-economic status
and is referred as assortative mating. One can choose to marry a partner
with desirable similar characters as ones mate, where it is called as positive
assortative mating or dissimilar or opposite characters where it is called as
negative assortative mating.
5) Several human populations prefer to marry their own relatives. Such related
mating or marriages are called inbreeding. Consagnuineous marriages in
Man are one of the common type of marriage. There are a variety of types of
related marriages and all result in inbreeding. Inbreeding leads to a greater
chance of inheriting two copies of the homologous genes from one or more
common ancestors. This is referred as identity by descent (ibd). In case of
inbreeding there is decrease in variability of a trait. There is decrease in
heterozygosity of several characters. This decrease in survival and fertility
due to inbreeding is called inbreeding depression.
6) Theoretically it is possible to investigate the extent of genetic similarity
between related individuals. One such measure is the inbreeding coefficient.
By knowing types of consanguineous type or inbreeding practiced, one can
calculate the inbreeding coefficient for different types of related marriages.
One can also calculate the inbreeding coefficient in a population and examine
the trends of levels of inbreeding practiced over time and region among
diverse populations.
Suggested Reading
Charles Darwin 1859. Origin of Species by Natural Selection.
Charles Darwin 1871. Descent of Man and Selection in Relation to Sex.
Cavalli-Sforza, L.L. and W.F. Bodmer. 1971. The Genetics of Human Populations.
22 San Francisco: W.H. Freeman.
Crawford M.H and P.L Workman, 1973. Methods and Theories of Anthropological Meaning and Scope
Genetics. Albuquerque: University of New Mexico Press.
Harrison, G.A and A.J Boyce. 1972. The Structure of Human Populations. Oxford:
Clarendon Press.
Malhotra, K.C and T.S Vasulu. 1993. Structure of Human Populations in India.
In. “Human Population Genetics: A centennial tribute to J.B.S.Haldane”.(ed.).
P.P. Majumder.207-233. New York: Plenum Press.
Curt Stern. 1973. The Principles of Human Genetics. (3rd.). San Francisco: W.H.
Freeman.
Sample Questions
1) What is gene pool? How do we investigate the extent of gene pool in human
populations.
2) What is Assortative mating and how it is different from random mating and
inbreeding.
23
Human Population Genetics
UNIT 2 HARDY-WEINBERG EQUILIBRIUM
Contents
2.1 Introduction
2.2 Hardy Weinberg Equilibrium (HWE)
2.2.1 Importance and Implications of Hardy Weinberg Equilibrium
2.3 Applications in Human Population Genetics
2.4 Departure from HWE
2.4.1 Factors Affecting Change in Gene Frequency
2.4.1.1 Mutation
2.4.1.2 Genetic Drift
2.4.1.3 Natural Selection
2.4.1.4 Gene Flow
2.4.1.5 Genetic Equilibrium
2.5 Summary
Suggested Reading
Sample Questions
Learning Objectives
&
After reading this unit, you will be able to:
Ø define what is Hardy-Weinberg Equilibrium or Law;
Ø depict the importance of HW Equilibrium and the field of population
genetics;
Ø explain the method how to estimate the genotype and phenotype frequencies
from HW theorem and to calculate in empirical situation; and
Ø evaluate the theory behind the deviations from H-WE, especially the gene
frequency changes with respect to Mutation, Genetic drift, Selection, Gene
flow and how to investigate them in empirical situations in human
populations.
2.1 INTRODUCTION
Living organisms are endowed with unique abilities, traits that allow them to
survive in a given environment. These traits or abilities may show or exhibit
enormous variations within species and across species. Some of these traits are
unique to that species; some traits are common within and across species with
little variation, these are adaptive characters and gives survival advantage.
These traits are the ‘phenotypic’ forms that can be observed as a quantitative
trait (or measurable) or classified as types or categories. These traits are hereditary
and transmitted across generations: either in the same form or in slight variable
form. At times some new traits or variations of the trait appear among the
offspring. Some of these traits are governed by ‘genes’ or located in the ‘genome’
of an organism. The nature of heredity of some of these traits could be complex
24 and/or it could follow some simple principles of transmission.
Human population genetics deals with how these traits or variation change in a Hardy-Weinberg
Equilibrium
population over space and time (generations)? What are the factors that influence
the variation of these traits in the population? To what extent these traits are
hereditary and are influenced by environment? Can we understand them by simple
theoretical models? Can we study how different forces operate differentially in
different populations to give a characteristics distribution of gene and genotype
frequencies?
BOX 2.1
Brachydactyly in a population: All the mating types are:
The mating types include individuals Normal and Brachydactyly (a Dominant
Mendelian trait)
N – Normal and B –Brachydactyly a NN – NN = All the offspring N
a. Both parents are normal — All the offspring are N b NB – NN = ½ : ½ = N : B
c BB – NN = all are B
b. One parent is N and the other B (heterozygous)
d NB – NB = 1 N : 1 B: 2 B
c. One parent is N the other B
e BB – BB = All the offspring B
d. Both parents are brachydactyly B (heterozygous)
e. Both parents are brachydactyly B (homozygous)
Of the 5 possible combinations of parental mating types 4 types of matings results
brachydactyly offspring.
Therefore, B are more frequent than N in a population as per Mendelian expectation.
However Normal individuals are more frequent than Brachydactyly in a population.
# there is apparent contradiction between what is observed and what is expected
(Mendelian)!
GH Hardy has solved the puzzle theoretically and published the theorem in
Science (Hardy, 1908). GH Hardy’s proof illustrates that the gene (or allele)
frequency, — here in this case, frequency of brachydactyly individuals in a
population, — will not increase over generations, but remain the same, under
equilibrium conditions or in the absence of confounding variables. In 1908,
Dr. W. Weinberg independently also published similar results (Weinberg, 1908)
and is called as HWEqulibirium. (See Box 2.2)
Codominant: Where both the alleles are equally expressive in the offspring.
A diploid individual can carry two copies (alleles) of the gene in each of the
chromosome that he or she gets from his or her parents. The two copies
could be of the same type (form/status) or of different type (form/status).
Homozygous: The two alleles that an individual carries are of the same or
identical types.
Heterozygous: The two alleles that an individual carries are of different type.
For example, in case of a ‘biallelic’ gene say A, B two forms (alleles) of the
gene that occur in each of the two sets of the chromosomes. There could be
three different genotypes: AA, AB, BB.
AB = BA : heterozygote (genotype).
A B
types. This can be extended to multiple alleles.
A AA BA
Polymorphism: If a gene exists in more than one
form or morph (alleles) and that occurs in stable B AB BB
frequency in a population. Genotype
27
Human Population Genetics BOX 2.4: Hardy-Weinberg theorem or principle: Proof
In case of genetic trait that has positive family history in a population, let us
assume that the gene is biallelic and therefore the two alleles are: B1 and B2
and let
‘p’ is the frequency of ‘B1 allele’ and
‘q’ is the frequency of B2 allele,
N is the total individuals and
So that (p + q = 1) or p = (1 – q) or q = (1 – p)
An individual in the population can have three types of genotypes: B1B1,
B1B2, and B2B2. And let the frequency of the above three genotypes in the
parental population are: P, H and Q respectively.
...................................................................................
Gene (alleles) Genotypes
..................................... ...................................
B1 B2 B1B1 B1B2 B2B2
...............................................................................................................
Frequencies p q P H Q
...............................................................................................................
If there are total N individuals in the sample, there will be
P individuals with genotype B1B1 type,
H individuals with genotype B1B2 type and
Q individuals with genotype B2B2 type
So that sum of (P +H + Q) = N,
Assuming all the individuals of the three genotypes are equally fertile, then
given the genotypes, one can calculate the frequencies ‘p’ and ‘q’ in the
population, by gene counting method:
The gene (allele) frequency ‘p’ = [P + ½ (H)]1/N = (B1B1)/N + ½ (B1B2/N), and
The gene (allele) frequency ‘q’= [Q + ½ (H)]1/N = (B2B2)/N + ½ (B1B2/N)
This is the gene (allele) frequencies of ‘p’ and ‘q’, which are also the gametes
produced in the population.
Only some of the gametes form zygotes that will eventually become individuals
in the next generation. The allele (gene) frequency in the zygote is unchanged
provided there is no reproductive advantage of either of the allele and the
zygotes formed represent a large sample of the parental gametes.
Random mating between individuals is equivalent to random union among
their gametes. Therefore, in the next generation, the genotype frequencies
among the zygotes (fertilized eggs) are the result of random union of two
types of gametes. The genotype frequencies among the progeny are therefore
can be worked out by Punnet’s square. Or it is the multiplication of the
frequencies of the gametic types produced by the parents. Viz.,
------ ----------------------- -- Allele B1 B2
Genotype
Genotype B1B1 2B1B2 B2B2
B1B1 B1B2 B2B2
Frequency p2 2pq q2
--------------------------------
Absolute freq. P H Q
Frequency p2 2pq q2
28 -------------------------------
Hardy-Weinberg
BOX 2.4 (Contd.) Equilibrium
Hardy-Weinberg theorem or principle: Proof
In a population there will be three different types of genotypes among males and
females, who will mate randomly and they will give rise to their offspring who
will represent the same genotypes in the next generation. We will have to work
out the frequencies of offspring genotypes given the three genotypes among the
male and female parents. This is worked out easily by Punnet’s square: the
frequencies of different mating types among the male and female genotypes in
the population and different possible genotypes among the offspring are.
Frequency of different mating types and the offspring genotypes
- ----------------------- ------------------
Male Parent — Genotype
Female Parent B1B1 B1B2 B2B2
2
Freq. p 2pq q2
------------------------------------------
B1B1 p2 p4 2p3q p2q2
B1B2 2pq 2p3q 2p2q2 2pq3
2 2 2 3
B2B2 q pq 2pq q4
------------------------------------------
Once we know the possible offspring genotypes as a result of random mating
among the three parental genotypes we can calculate the expected frequencies
among the offspring genotypes for different combination of mating types in the
population. Given the three genotypes six possible mating types are possible in
the population and each mating type will give rise to offspring of different possible
combination of genotypes. These are worked out in the following table and this
gives the allele frequencies in the offspring population in the next generation:
Frequency of different mating types and the offspring genotypes
- ----------------------- --------------------------------
Parent Offspring — Genotype
Female X Male B1B1 B1B2 B2B2
(Genotype) Freq.
----------------------------------------------------------
B1B1 X B1B1 p2 p4 — —
3 3 3
B1B1 X B1B2 4p q 2p q 2p q —
B1B2 X B1B1 }
B1B1 X B2B2 2p2q2 2p2q2
B2B2 X B1B1
} — —
• When an allele is rare, there are many more heterozygotes than homozygotes
for it. Thus, rare alleles will be impossible to eliminate even if there is
selection against homozygosity for them.
30
Hardy-Weinberg
BOX 2.5 Equilibrium
The relationship between gene frequency and genotype frequency
It is interesting to know the relation between the gene and genotype frequency
for a biallelic loci which is under H-W equilibrium. The graph shows the
changes in the three genotype frequencies as against the change in allele
frequencies A1 and A2 from 0 to 1 in Cartesian coordinates (drawn on x and
y axis).
A1A1/A2A2 – homozygotes, A1A2 – heterozygotes
Relationship between genotype frequency and gene frequency
- biallelic GENE
G 1.0
E
n A1A1
o
A2A2
t
y
p
e
0.5
f
r A1A2
e
q
u
e
n 0.1
c
y
0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1.0
Gene frequency A2
Fig: Left top curve – A1A1, Right top curve – A2A2, Lower curve – A1A2
ü And this can occur when the gene frequency of ‘p’ = ‘q’ = 50%
ü When one of the gene frequencies of an allele is low, the rare allele
predominantly occurs as heterozygotes and there will be few heterozygotes.
BOX 2.6
HWE – Gene frequency estimation: Gene counting method
Given the information about the genotypes, HWE helps us to estimate the
allele frequency by ‘gene counting method’ (how many alleles a genotype
contains). For example,
Ø As each homozygote carries two alleles and each
Ø Heterozygote carries one allele, therefore, estimate of an allele frequency
in a population of size N individuals (or 2N alleles) will be
= (2 homozygotes + heterozygote) *(1/2N)
Ø In a population there will be three genotypes and their absolute frequency
will be say N1, N2 and N3 (where N1 + N2 + N3 = N). If there are two
alleles say ‘A’ and ‘a’ with a frequency ‘p’ and ‘q’ respectively (where p
+ q = 1).
Ø By gene counting method assuming HW law the gene (allele) frequencies
of p = (1/2N) * (2N1 + N2), q = (1/2N) * (2N3 + N2) and p = (1 – q)
2.4.1.1 Mutation
Mutation is a random change in phenotypic or genotypic forms that occur once a
while in a population. The probability or likelihood of occurrence, in a population,
in general, is of the order of one over several lakhs or tens of thousand of individuals.
For example, several of the Mendelian syndromes and disorders that have been
discovered in human populations are the result of mutation. In general, it is
observed to be a single mutation or point mutation. At molecular level, mutation
primarily refers to changes in the DNA sequences (or SNPs — Single Nucleotide
Polymorphism) in the genome of an individual (population) with phenotypic
manifestations resulting to non-normal cases, some of them are clinically or
medically identified as diseases or a syndrome. If one can search web resources,
there is a data base created by Hopkins institute and or by NIH (America) on a
list of Mendelian syndromes, which can be found by a search criterion OMIM
(Online Mendelian Inheritance in Man). One can also find such data bases from
a variety of sources.
Some examples will help us to get an idea of mutation and its effects. Sickle cell
anaemia (or HbS condition), is a disease related to Haemoglobinopathies. Its
inability to synthesize Oxygen (O2) to its full capacity by an individual who is
suffering from the disease or the trait, which results a risk to survival liability.
This is identified as due to a point mutation or single mutation at the 6th position
of the â-globlin chain of the haemoglobin gene. The single aminoacid substitution
(â6 Glu to Val) changes the haemoglobin structure, which is phenotypically
identified as sickle cell shaped form (or half moon shaped form) of the RBC.
Mutation is an important factor or ingredient leading to the appearance of new
characters in the population. The fate of the mutation as a new character in a
34 population depends on its advantage or disadvantage that it can impinge to the
survival fitness of the population. For example, mutation is a significant Hardy-Weinberg
Equilibrium
evolutionary force which can change allele frequency variation in a population
under a favourable environment. How we can know the relation between the
mutation and allele frequency change from HWE.
Therefore, the mutations that occur at HV1 and HV2 regions of mitochondrial
genome help us to investigate the short-term evolution or micro-evolutionary
35
Human Population Genetics trends in sub-populations. This has helped us to address some of the questions of
human origins or to verify the Darwin’s hypothesis that the Africa is the origin
of Man. This also helps to enquire the antiquity and past genetic history of diverse
populations and their diversity and relationship with other human populations.
To understand how the genetic drift can happen or possible, one can investigate
and/or understand by attempting some simple examples or simulation exercises.
These are available on the online resources. One such example is illustrated in
Box 2.8.
a) Bottle-neck effect
Genetic Drift can happen in a variety of ways due to different events that
populations experiences in empirical situation. These have been referred as
part of ecological factors that disturb the population size (see 2.4.1).
Historically the world has experienced several pandemic diseases in the
past: e.g. Syphilis, Plague, leprosy, malaria, HIV infection, etc. which has
killed or wiped out bulk of the population. The natural geographical events
like earthquakes, tsunami etc. had killed vast majority of the populations.
Even the political and man interfering events like explosion of atomic bombs,
world wars etc. have affected the demographic size of the populations. Each
such event is followed by a drastic reduction in population sizes. In genetic
terms it means reduction in genetic diversity (at the time of the event), and
those survived will have different allelic profile or gene frequency and the
stability of a particular allele over generations depends on the demographic
structure of the population.
b) Founder effect
The word ‘founders’ refers to the ancestors or the earliest settlers who
colonised or founded the new population in alien territories. It could be an
historical adventure of ware fare, or exploration to a new island or new area
or it could also be due to chance factors like surviving from a sudden
calamities like ship wreck, etc. or it could be serial migration of people at
different timing to other places: in all the cases, a few founders start living
and establishing a new subpopulation.
In genetic scenario, the few founders represent a random sample of the genes
from the original population or gene pool from which they got separated. It
is possible that, some of the rare alleles that are in the large population, by
chance, may not be present in the founder individuals. It could be that,
among the founders, especially if the founders are related, by chance, some
of alleles may be of a higher frequency than the original population.
Therefore, in the new colony after generations the gene pool will have either
absence of the allele or higher frequency of the rare allele than when
compared to the original population.
37
Human Population Genetics c) Serial founder effect
It is possible that people or organisms migrate repeatedly over time or waves
of migration from a region to found new colonies. Such repeated waves of
migration at different time periods produce successive subpopulations or
gene pools whose genetic profile will be different. There appears to be waves
of out of Africa migration to other continents that had happened at different
time periods in the past, whose genetic signature can now be traced among
the extant populations in South Asia, Europe, and America etc. The
mitochondrial, X and Y chromosomal haplogroup distribution of continental
populations can be explained as a result of founder effect of out of Africa
hypothesis of human origins.
BOX 2.9
Studies on Genetic Drift
Ø Amish population, USA: All most all the Amish population (~249K)
descended from about 200 founders from German during 18th century.
The population is endogamous, they show high frequency of genetic
disorders as a result of founder effect that include dwarfism, metabolic
disorders, unusual distribution of blood types, metabolic disorders etc.
38
Hardy-Weinberg
traits which are expected to be due to genetic drift and founder effect. Equilibrium
Some of them include:
– Complete lack of A2, cde, K, pc, and AK2 genes, lack of isozyme
ALDH-1 (Roychoudhury and Nei 1997), a high prevalence (about
50%) of lactase malabsorption (Flatz 1987).
Due to differential reproductive success involving these variant of the trait, there
will be more offspring with the variant than those individuals with other variant
of the trait. In Darwinian sense ‘fitness’ (‘Darwinian Fitness’) refers to ability to
contribute successfully to the next generation. This is also referred as ‘adaptive
value’ or ‘selective value’. Therefore, if the differences of fitness are in a way
associated with the presence or absence of a particular allele (or gene) in the
individual’s genotype then selection operates at the genetic level.
When a gene is subjected to selection (or under selective pressure), its frequency
in the offspring is not the same as in the parents (or in the previous generation)
as parents with different genotypes pass on their genes unequally to the next
generation. This leads to change in gene frequency and consequently also of
genotype frequency, as a result of selection (of a particular gene). The theoretical
investigation of change in gene frequency of an allele under selection pressure is
more complex, than factors like mutation, migration. There could be different
situations under which selection can operate in a population and different
situations need to be incorporated in theoretical models. Here we will consider a
few of those situations (types of selection) in a more descriptive way, rather than
theoretically, which is beyond the scope of the present purpose.
39
Human Population Genetics Theoretically, selection is measured by ‘fitness’ (‘W’) or by selection coefficient
(‘s’). Fitness refers to ‘relative rate of survival’. The selection coefficient (‘s’) is
defined as ( 1-W ) and the value varies between 0 and 1. Once the fitness is
quantified and defined the different types of dominance can be taken as degrees
of dominance with respect to fitness (this is different from the dominance effect
of the gene). In general, most mutant genes are completely recessive compared
to the wild type as can be observed from phenotypic form of the trait. This does
not imply that the heterozygotes are equally fit when compared to homozygote.
BOX 2.10
Types of dominance or degree of dominance and fitness
A2A2 A1A2 A1A1
a. No dominance: I———————I————————I
1–s 1 – 1/2s 1
A2A2 A1A2 A1A1
b. Partial dominance: I————————I———————I
1–s 1 – hs 1
A2A2 A1A2,A1A1
c. Complete dominance: I————————--———————I
1–s 1
A2A2 A1A1 A1A2
d. Over dominance: I————!——--——-——————I
1 – s2 1 – s1 1
a) Types of selection
Selection is a systematic force and operates in different ways. Selection takes
place when there is differential fitness of a heritable trait. Based on the effect on
the allele frequencies, the selection can be seen operating into three types.
Directional selection: occurs one extreme value or allele is selected. In case if
one of the allele of a variety of the trait has greater fitness and producing more
offspring of that allele or a variety, then the selection is said to be directional.
The effect of directional selection is fixation of allele with greater fitness and the
loss of the allele with least fitness. For example: well known cases come from
the parasitic world, especially resistance to antibiotics in case of some of the
vector-borne diseases. Initially as a result of antibiotic the parasite growth comes
down to zero, but the parasites develops some mutant or new variant which gets
resistance against the antibiotics or better fitness in the presence of antibiotics,
in due course, the less fit variant is replaced by new variant which can survive
against antibiotics. This can be illustrated as a shift in the mean of the character
40 of a distribution (See box 2.12).
Hardy-Weinberg
BOX 2.11: Change in gene frequency under selection Equilibrium
First we will consider the basic formulae for the change in gene frequency that is
achieved in one generation of selection. Under the similar notation that has been
used above for other factors (p = gene freq. of A1 and q = gene freq. of A2), the
below table shows the genotype frequencies under HWE before selection to the
allele for the three genotypes (first line).
........................................................................................................................
Genotypes
A1A1 A1A2 A2A2 Total
........................................................................................................................
Initial frequency p2 2pq q2 1
Coefficient of selection 0 0 s
Fitness 1 1 1–s
2 2
Genetic contribution p 2pq q (1—s) (1 – sq2)
........................................................................................................................
Here we consider selection acting on the recessive genotype A2A2 with a selection
coefficient: ‘s’ acting against it. This will have a differential fitness to the genotypes
that will be as given in the second line. By multiplying the initial frequency by the
fitness values gives the frequency of each genotype after selection. This is the third
line – the genetic contribution to allow to selection to operate over life cycle.
Therefore, after selection, there will be a loss of fitness that is proportional to an
amount (1 – sq2). From this we can calculate the frequency of A2 gametes produced
(frequency of A2 genes in the progeny). The new g.f. is (where p = (1 – q)
q1 = [q2 (1 – s ) + pq] / (1 – sq2)
= [q – sq2] / (1 – sq2)
The change in gene frequency ∆q, resulting from one generation of selection is
∆q = q1 – q = sq2 (1 — q) / (1 – sq2)
This tells us that the effect of selection on gene frequency depends not only on the
intensity of selection s, but also on the initial gene frequency (of the recessive allele).
Different type of selection
What we have considered above is in general selection with respect to recessive
allele q under selective pressure. But there are variety (or types) of selection that
can act on the allele frequency. Depending upon the type of selection the change in
gene frequency will consequently change. These are shown in the following table.
Initial freq. & fitness New gene frequency Change in gene frequency
of Genotypes due to selection at q
BOX 2.12
Different types of selection. Change in gene frequency in
case of Stabilizing, Directional and disruptive (balancing)
selection
42
Balanced Selection: In case of balanced selection, the heterozygotes have higher Hardy-Weinberg
Equilibrium
fitness than either of the homozygotes. This is also called heterozygous advantage
or over-dominance. The best example is the sickle cell anaemia. In non-malarial
environment the homozygote state of the sickle cell anaemia will have low fitness
and as a result the allele gets lost in the population in due course of time. However,
in malarial environment, Homozygote sickle cell anaemic individuals have the
better fitness as equal to the normal homozygote individuals; as such both the
alleles will be maintained in the population. (See Box 2.12).
Disruptive selection: both the extreme value (alleles) of a trait gets selected. It is
one form of balanced selection. In case of disruptive selection, the extreme values
or the alleles (low and high) of a trait will have a higher fitness when compared
to the average value. As a result of disruptive selection the extreme values will
increase as against the average values of the trait. This can be explained as leading
to bimodal distribution (See Box 2.12).
The total selection intensity (as defined by Crow) has two components: A fertility
component (If) and mortality (Im). The fertility and mortality patterns depend on
several factors that vary across populations such as age at marriage, menarche,
and survival to reach to fertility age, variation in fertility and age of death etc.
Likelihood of these occurring needs to be calculated based on age-sex structure.
The fertility and mortality also include embryonic development and birth; these
have been incorporated to make it more rigorous and efficient estimate by
Johnston and Kensinger (1971). More details of the Crow Index and the
relationship are given in Box 2.13.
The estimates of ‘total intensity of selection’ have been studied in wide diverse
populations. In Indian scenario, tribal populations show larger ‘Index of mortality
than fertility components. There is also an overall declines in Im and It among
urban communities as a result of socio-economic and public health facilities.
More details of the trends of the Crow’s Index in Indian populations are described
by Gautam (2009).
43
Human Population Genetics
BOX 2.13
Index of opportunity for selection
Crow (1958) and Johnston & Kensinger (1971)
The total selection intensity (It), is computed based on
Im = index of opportunity for natural selection due to pre-reproductive
mortality (mortality from birth to reproductive age, i.e. below 15 years).
If = index of opportunity for natural selection due to fertility.
X = average number of live births per women who have completed their
reproductive life span (aged 45 years and above).
Vf = variance (average deviation from mean) of number of live births.
Pd = proportion of pre-reproductive deaths.
Ps = proportion of survivors from birth to reproductive ages.
The proportion of pre-reproductive deaths (Pd) is calculated from children
ever-born to mothers aged 45 years and above (who have completed their
fertility) and pre-reproductive deaths.
The proportions of survivors were calculated by subtracting Pd from 1:
It = Im + If/Ps
Im = Pd/Ps & Ps = 1/Pd
If = Vf /X2
The crow’s Index of opportunity for selection was modified by Johnston and
Kensinger (1971) to account for the survival and mortality component during
conception, before the birth of an infant.
This include Ime = the selection due to prenatal mortality, Ped = the probability
to die before birth,
Pb = the probability to survive till birth, Imc the index of total selection
due to postnatal mortality,
Pd = the probability to die before reaching reproductive age,
Ps = the likelihood to survive til reproductive age, If = selection due to
fertility,
V = varience due to fertility among women who had completed their
fertility,
X is the mean number of births, Pd and Ps are proportion of deaths and
survivors.
The modified total intensity index It is:
It = Ime + (Imc/Pb) + (If/Pb) Ps
Ime = Ped/Pb, Pb = 1 – Ped
Imc = Pd/Ps
Ps = (1 – Pd)
If = V/X2
44
2.4.1.4 Gene Flow Hardy-Weinberg
Equilibrium
a) Migration
Migration or gene flow is an important factor that can change the gene frequency.
Emigration or immigration of individuals between populations can alter or change
in the gene frequency. In genetic terms it is either loss of genetic diversity due to
emigration or increase of genetic diversity due to immigration of individuals.
There is loss of gene flow from a gene pool or gain of gene flow into a
subpopulation from other gene pool. The quantitative estimate of the effect of
migration in case of an allele at a single locus has been estimated by Bernstein
and it has been shown (Box 2.14).
BOX 2.14
Change in gene frequency due to migration (m) / gene flow or
genetic admixture
Suppose if migration is unidirectional from mainland to a nearby island and
is random, then suppose
‘m’ is the rate of migration per generation from mainland to island
a) Pi be the frequency of gene A in immigrating individuals
‘p0’ is the frequency of gene A in the island
b) The gene freq of A in the island after migration is
pam = mpi + ( 1 – m ) p0
‘m’
The change in gene freq in one generation is
A
pam – p0 = [ mpi + (1-m) p0] – p0 pi
A
= m (pi – p0) + p0 – p0 mpi
b) Genetic admixture
Gene flow can happen between two subpopulations through random mating or
admixture or marriages. The American Blacks, Anglo Indians, are examples of
genetic admixed populations. The Latin American countries are populated by
admixed populations contributed by native tribes, African, European and other
settlers. The estimates of admixture proportion can be estimated for a gene located
at a specific locus of interest or for a set of genetic markers located at different
loci. The above formula (Box 2.14) can be used to estimate the ‘m’ the admixture
45
Human Population Genetics in a hybrid population. It is also possible to estimate the admixture proportions
based on genetic distances and from principal component analysis (for multilocus
allele frequencies).
Since gene flow can occur in different scenarios, there are a variety of theoretical
models to account for different situations of spatial gene exchange or flow. For
example, Sewall Wright has proposed ‘island’, ‘neighbourhood’ and ‘isolation
by distance’ models and ‘steppingstone’ model by Kimura and Weiss.
Steppingstone model: The island model is too realistic to realise, therefore other
models have been proposed which is more close to geographically structured
populations. Kimura and Weiss (1964) proposed the ‘stepping stone model’. In
46
‘one-step-linear (one dimensional) stepping stone model, the populations are Hardy-Weinberg
Equilibrium
arranged, rather in a linear fashion, on a long chain. The migration occurs between
the neighbouring populations. This situation allows the distant populations with
least migration between them are expected to behave differently than the
neighbouring populations that are expected to change the gene frequency of the
extreme populations as against the neighbouring populations. Kimura and Weiss
(1964) have shown that the correlation in gene frequencies ( r ) between demes
decreases approximately exponentially as a function of the number of steps ( x )
between deems.
Box 2.15
Calculating Equilibrium Allele Frequencies with Balancing Selection
Genotypes: AA Aa aa
Relative fitnesses: 1–s 1 1–t
Frequencies: P2 2pq q2
Average-relative fitness: w̄ = P2 x (1–s) + 2pq x 1 + q2 x (1–t)
Frequency of A in the next
generation after selection: P1 = [P2 (1 – s) + (1/2) 2pq] / w̄ = p(1–sp) / w̄
Change in frequency
of A due to selection: ∆ p = P1 - p = pq(tq-sp) / w̄
At equilibrium, p∆ = 0 P = t / (s + t) and q = s / (s + t)
47
Human Population Genetics Balancing Selection
One type of dynamic equilibrium arises when selection favors the heterozygotes
at the expense of each type of homozygote in the population. In this situation,
called balancing selection or heterozygote advantage, one can assign the relative
fitness of the heterozygotes to be 1 and the relative fitness of the two types of
homozygotes to be less than 1:
Genotype: AA Aa Aa
Relative fitness 1– s 1 1– t
In this formulation, the terms 1 – s and 1-t contain selection coefficients that are
assumed to lie between 0 and 1. Thus, each of the homozygotes has a lower
fitness than the heterozygotes. The superiority of the heterozygotes is sometimes
referred to as ‘overdominance’.
As an example, let’s suppose that the AA homozygotes are lethal (s = 1) and that
the aa homozygotes are 50 percent as fit as the heterozygotes (t = 0.5). Under
these assumptions, the population will establish a dynamic equilibrium when p
= 0.5/(0.5 + 1) = 1/3 and q = 1/(0.5 + 1) = 2/3.
The answer is that there is moderate selection against homozygotes that carry
the wild-type allele HbA . These homozygotes that carry the wild-type allele HbA..
These homozygotes are less fit than the Hbs HbA heterozygotes because they are
more susceptible to infection by the parasites that cause malaria, a fitness-reducing
disease that is widespread in regions where the frequency of the HbS allele is
high.
48
We can schematize this situation by assigning relative fitness to each of the Hardy-Weinberg
Equilibrium
genotype of the â-globin gene:
If one assumes that the equilibrium frequency of HbS is p = 0.1 – a typical value
in West Africa – and if one notes that s = 1 because the HbS HbS homozygotes
die, one can estimate the intensity of selection against the HbA HbA homozygotes
because of their greater susceptibility to malaria:
P = t/ (s + t)
0.1 = t/ (1+t)
t = (0.1)/(0.9) = 0.11
This result tells us that the HbA HbA homozygotes are about 11 percent less fit
than the HbS HbA heterozygotes. Thus, the selective inferiority of the HbS HbS
and HbA HbA homozygotes compared to the heterozygotes creates a balanced
polymorphism in which both alleles of the â-globin gene are maintained in the
population.
Mutation-Selection Balance
Another type of dynamic equilibrium is created when selection eliminates
deleterious alleles that are produced by recurrent mutation. For example, let’s
consider the case of a deleterious recessive allele a that is produced by mutation
of the wild-type allele A at rate u. A typical value for u is 3 X 10-6 mutations per
generation. Even though this rate is very low, over time, the mutant allele will
accumulate in the population, and, because it is recessive, it can be carried in
heterozygous condition without having any harmful effects. At some point,
however, the mutant allele will become frequent enough for aa homozygotes to
appear in the population, and these will be subject to the force of selection in
proportion to their frequency and the value of the selection coefficient s. Selection
against these homozygotes will counteract the force of mutation, which introduces
the mutant allele into the population.
If one assumes that the population mates randomly, and if one denotes the
frequency of A as p and that of a as q, then one can summarize the situation as
follows:
Mutation: Selection:
Produces a eliminates a
A→ a Genotype: AA Aa aa
rate = u Relative fitness: 1 1 1-s
Frequency: P2 2pq q2
49
Human Population Genetics Mutation introduces mutant alleles into the population at rate u, and selection
eliminates them at rate sq2
Population
sq2 Elimination by
Selection
Mutation-Drift Balance
The random genetic drift eliminates variability from a population. Without any
50 counteracting force, this process would eventually make all populations
completely homogeneous. However, mutation replenishes the variability that is Hardy-Weinberg
Equilibrium
lost by drift. At some point, the opposing forces of mutation and genetic drift
come into balance and a dynamic equilibrium is established. The genetic
variability can be quantified by calculating the frequency of heterozygotes in a
population- a statistic called the heterozygosity, which is symbolized by the letter
H. The frequency of homozygotes in a population- often called the homozygosity-
is equal to 1-H. Over time, genetic drift decreases H and increases 1-H, and
mutation does just the opposite as shown in the figure below (Box 2.16).
Let’s assume that each new mutation is selectively neutral. In a randomly mating
population of size N, the rate at which drift decreases H is ( )H. The rate at
which mutation increases H is proportional to the frequency of the homozygotes
in the population (1-H) and the probability that one of the two alleles in a particular
homozygote mutates to a different allele, thereby converting that homozygote
into a heterozygote. This probability is simply the mutation rate µ for each of the
two alleles in the homozygote; thus, the total probability of mutation converting
a particular homozygote into a heterozygote is 2µ. The rate at which mutation
increases H in a population is therefore equal to 2µ(1 - H).
Box2.16
Box 2.16
Mutation pressure
Introduces variation @ rate u)
Heterozygotes Homozygotes
Genetic Drift H
(eliminates variation)
When the opposing forces of mutation and drift come into balance, the population
will achieve an equilibrium level of variability denoted by H. This equilibrium
value of H can be estimated, by equating the rate at which mutation increases H
to the rate at which drift decreases it:
2µ(1 - H) = H
2.5 SUMMARY
1) Understanding of Population genetics principles, requires the basic concepts
of Mendelian genetics: the result of segregation, the concept ‘gene’,
‘phenotype’, ‘genotype’, ‘dominant’ , ‘recessive’ traits, ‘allele’ etc. Parental
mating types and expected distribution of genotypes among the offspring.
3) HWE law states that under the absence of intervening factors, especially in
a large population, given random mating, no selection of any sort, no mutation
and absence of demographic factors like migration, differential fertility and
mortality etc., the allele frequency remain constant over generations. This
can be proved theoretically, easily, for a ‘biallelic locus and it can be extended
to multilocus as well.
7) HWE is the bench mark of qualitative test to check whether a trait, an allele,
SNP, is in equilibrium. It tells how to distinguish between the effects of
evolutionary forces from the demographic factors.
10) Founder effect is one form of genetic drift. The founders are a sample
(represent a fraction of the genetic diversity) of original populations. The
descendents of a few founders have the gene frequency that is dependent on
the genetic composition and genetic structure of the founders. It can also
happen as bottleneck effect, especially as a result of sudden population size
reduction in a population, due to reasons such as natural causes or man-
made causes or socio-cultural regulations. There could be serial founder
effect as a result of waves of migration at different times. The mitochondrial
investigation of human origins suggests that the human origins and migration
to other continents appears as a result of serial founder effect from Africa.
11) Natural selection is one of the complex systematic forces that can influence
significant changes in gene frequency. Selection can operate in multitude
ways and it is a slow process than to the effect of migration or admixture
etc.
13) The effect of ‘directional selection’ to shift the mean allele frequency towards
its extremes. Or it could be stabilizing selection that shifts the allele frequency
of extreme alleles as a result the heterozygote frequency will increase. Or it
could be disruptive selection where the extreme allele frequency increases
as against the heterozygote frequency.
16) There are theoretical models to investigate the effect of spatial gene flow or
population structure between populations. Island model, stepping stone
model, neighbourhood model help us to investigate the spatial gene flow in
different situations of population structure.
Suggested Reading
Crow, J.F. and Kimura M. 1970. An Introduction to Population Genetics Theory.
New Jersey: Blackburn Press.
Li, C.C. 1976. First Course in Population Genetics. USA: Boxwood Press.
Cavalli Sforza L.L. and Bodmer W.F. 1971. The Genetics of Human Populations.
Sanfrancisco. USA: W.H. Freeman,
Falconer, D.S, 1980. Introduction to Quantitative Genetics. Second edition.
London and New York: Longman.
Christiansen, B, Freddy, and Feldman W Marcus. 1986. Population Genetics.
Victoria: Blackwell Scientific Publications (Australia) Pvt. Ltd.
Gautam, R.K (2009). Opportunity for natural selection among the Indian
population: secular trend, covariates and implications. J. Biosoc. Sci. 41:705-
745.
Kimura, M. and G.H, Weiss 1964. The steppingstone model of population
structure and the correlation with distance. Genetics. 49:561-576.
Majumder, PP. 1993. Human Population Genetics. A centennial tribute to JBS
Haldane. Ed. PP Majumder. New York: Plenum Press.
Malhotra, K.C. 1988. Statistical Methods in Human Population Genetics. Ed.
KC Malhotra. Calcutta: Eka Press.
Dobzhansky, T. 1951. Genetics and the Origin of Species. New York: Columbia
University Press.
Sample Questions
1) A total of 120 individuals were tested for M, N blood group and the observed
genotype frequencies of MM, MN and NN are 34, 62 and 24 respectively.
Calculate the gene (allele) frequencies?
2) If ‘ì’ is the mutation rate (‘ì’ = 10 – 5) per generation for a gene frequency of
A then how many generations are required to reduce the gene frequency by
a factor of ½.
3) What is Hardy-Weinberg equilibrium? Explain why HWE is important in
genetic of populations?
4) In case in a population the observed gene frequencies of a particular bi-
allelic locus are in HW equilibrium for the locus, does this imply the
population satisfies the assumptions of the HW equilibrium? Explain?
5) What is genetic drift and how it operates in populations? Explain with
54 Examples.
Hardy-Weinberg
UNIT 3 GENETIC POLYMORPHISM Equilibrium
Contents
3.1 Introduction
3.2 Balanced Polymorphism
3.3 Transient and Balanced Polymorphisms
3.4 Serological Markers
3.5 Biochemical Polymorphisms
3.6 Molecular Markers
3.6.1 Repetitive DNA Sequence Variants
3.6.2 Non- Repetitive DNA Sequence Variants
3.6.3 Lineage Markers
3.7 Tools for Studying Polymorphisms
3.8 Genetic Markers and Disease
3.9 Genetic Mapping of Disease Gene on Human Chromosome Using
Polymorphic Markers
3.10 Use of Polymorphic Markers in Forensic Testing
3.11 Use of Polymorphic Markers in Population Studies
3.12 Summary
Suggested Reading
Sample Questions
Learning Objectives
&
After reading this unit, you will be able to:
Ø define the concept of genetic polymorphism;
Ø explain genetic polymorphism with respect to serological, biochemical and
molecular markers;
Ø explain the genetic markers in disease association; and
Ø discuss the use of polymorphic markers in population and forensic studies.
3.1 INTRODUCTION
Genetic polymorphism can be defined as the occurrence together in the same
population two or more than two alleles such that the frequency of rare allele is
always >1%, and is maintained in the population not merely by the recurrent
mutation. Polymorphism can be in a coding region (coding region means the
portion of DNA which code for a gene, it may be synonymous or non-
synonymous) or more commonly, in the noncoding regions (which does not code
for functional region), often vary by ethnicity. Basic information about the types,
frequencies and distribution of common polymorphisms are essential not only
for the understanding of pathological entities, but also to know our evolutionary
past and provide guidance about our biological future. The most common
polymorphism in our genome are single base pair sequence variation i.e. SNP
55
Human Population Genetics but other types like copy number changes, insertions, deletions, duplications
and rearrangements also occur. The methods to asses this diversity is variable.
Few examples of polymorphic markers are listed in table 3.1.
Blood groups 1910-1960 ~20 May need fresh blood, rare antisera.
Genotype cannot always be inferred
from phenotype because of dominance.
No easy physical localization.
Human Leucocyte 1970 1 (multi locus One linked set highly informative. Can
Antigens (HLA) haplotype) only test for linkage to 6p21.3
It is known since long that malaria is a quite common in the tropical regions of
Africa. Sickle shape red blood cells provide selective advantage as malarial
parasite cannot grow in these cells. Therefore, along with malaria the sickle cell
anemia also increased in these parts of Africa. The sickle cell disease is less
common in Caucasians due to the less frequency of malaria. This shows the
heterozygous advantage of sickle cell as it provides protective effect.
The rise of sickle cell disease goes hand in hand with the cultural development
with the advent of cultivation of crops gave a breeding ground to Anopheles
mosquitoes as the malaria rose the selective pressures gave rise to the change in
the shape of the RBCs from elliptical to sickle shaped and when it occurred in
homozygous condition the disease was caused otherwise it had selective
advantage. The spread of sickle cell disease is associated to the migratory events.
Africa by people migrating from Southern Arabia and India, or it may have arisen
by mutation directly in East Africa.
Settlements with large numbers of sickle cell carriers escaped devastating malaria.
They were therefore strong enough to clear even more land to grow food-and
support the disease-bearing mosquitoes. Even today, sickle cell disease is more
prevalent in agricultural societies than among people who hunt and gather their
food.
G6PD Deficiency
It is a sex-linked enzyme deficiency. It affects 400 million people throughout the
world. It results into hemolytic anemia which is life-threatening. It is under the
influence of certain environmental conditions like eating fava beans, inhaling
certain types of pollen, taking certain drugs, or catching certain infections. It has
been seen in Africa that hemizygous males and heterozygous males for this
enzyme deficiency are at less risk for malaria again revealing a selective advantage
for heterozygotes. Therefore, natural selection acts in two directions hence it
could be one of the example of balanced polymorphism.
Mendilian Population
A population is a group of individuals who share a common gene pool where the
characters are transmitted in a Mendelian fashion from one generation to the
next generation. A group of individuals within which marriages are performed is
called a Mendelian population. In a given Mendelian population, which is under
Hardy-Weinberg equilibrium, the resultant genotype and phenotype frequencies
are more or less permanently established.
58
Genetic Polymorphism
3.5 BIOCHEMICAL POLYMORPHISMS
There is marked difference between individuals on the basis of biochemical
markers like G6PD, human enzymes and proteins etc. This has been explained
in the above section. However, here we would like to throw some light on the
molecular basis of G6PD variants.
Y-chromosomal Markers
Like mtDNA, Y- chromosome has a uniparental inheritance but in the male line
and can thus be used for tracing paternal ancestral lineages. In absence of
recombination, Y-chromosome is more or less transmitted unchanged from one
generation to next and the few changes that may occur usually do not have any
effect as around 98% of the DNA is in non-coding region.
Hardy-Weinberg equilibrium
The Hardy-Weinberg equilibrium predicts that in the absence of evolutionary
forces, both allelic and genotypic frequencies remain constant in a population
and that if the equilibrium is disturbed a new equilibrium will be reached within
one generation based on the allelic frequencies of the remaining population. The
conditions that must be met for the predictions of the Hardy-Weinberg equilibrium
to be valid are described below:
1) Random mating: Mating patterns must randomly reflect the entire breeding
population, with no dependence on genotype or closeness of relationship
60 (either positive or negative).
2) No sex bias in allelic frequencies: The distribution of alleles must be the Genetic Polymorphism
same in both sexes.
3) All genotypes equally viable and fertile: There must not be any selective
advantages or disadvantages. This is seldom true in a real population, and
often must be taken into account in terms of evolutionary pressures.
4) Mutation rate too low to alter ratios: The basic assumption is that alleles are
stable through many generations and are not altered or degraded significantly
by mutation. In practice this is generally not a serious problem.
6) Population must be large: The population must be large enough so that there
are no confounding effects due to genetic drift (random events altering allelic
frequencies by pure chance) or due to “founder” effects, where a recessive
gene becomes fixed in a population because too many of its members are
descendants of a single individual.
The Hardy-Weinberg law can also be applied to multiple alleles and X-linked
alleles. The genotypic frequencies expected under Hardy-Weinberg equilibrium
will differ according to the situation.
Electrophoresis: It is one of the few techniques that has been in use since the
beginning of study of classical genetic markers and is still in use for molecular
markers. It is the method of separating macromolecules (both proteins and nucleic
acids) on the basis of size, electric charge or other physical properties under the
influence of electric field.
The selection of technique and markers depends upon the purpose of study. In
the following section we have discussed the uses of polymorphic markers.
Uses of polymorphisms: All the markers listed in table 3.1 can be used for
population diversity studies. Now a days most extensively studied markers are
Single nucleotide polymorphisms. Genomics and specially SNP research can be
used to improve health care through gene therapy, to yield new targets for drug
discovery, to renew the process of drug development and to discover new
diagnostics.
First draft was released in 2001 followed by the complete draft in 2003. Some of
the main findings from the draft sequence are as follows:
• Total number of genes was estimated at 30, 000.
• The average gene was found to consist of 3000 bp but sizes vary greatly.
• Repeated sequences that do not code for proteins (“junk DNA”) make up at
least 50% of the human genome.
• About 1.4 million locations with SNPs were identified.
Findings from HGP are already having profound impact on diverse areas of
research including molecular medicine (improved diagnosis of disease, earlier
detection of genetic predispositions to disease, rational drug design etc.),
bioarchaeology, anthropology, evolution and human migration, DNA forensics
(identification), agriculture, livestock breeding etc.
Indian Genome Variation (IGV): IGV was the first large scale effort to document
and understand the genomic structure of enormously varied Indian populations.
The study found high degree of genetic differentiation among the different ethnic
groups.
The clinician is likely to encounter many situations in which a genetic test may
be useful. Sometimes genetic testing is required from diagnosis when it cannot
be made by clinical criteria alone. The fragile X syndrome is the most common
genetic form of mental retardation. Although the diagnosis may be suggested by
the presence of the characteristic signs—large ears, protruding chin, and large
testes—the only way to diagnose fragile X is by genetic testing. For the various
forms of spinocerebellar ataxia, there is considerable overlap. Yet, these can be
readily distinguished by their specific mutations. Patients with atypical forms of
certain diseases may have a negative gold standard test, but positive genetic test.
For most patients with cystic fibrosis, the diagnosis can usually be made by a
sweat chloride test. However, a number of individuals have been described with
pulmonary disease suggestive of this condition for whom the sweat chloride test
is normal. For these patients, the diagnosis has been based on observation of
mutations in both copies of their CFTR genes.
For some conditions, the signs of disease may not yet have developed, yet on the
basis of one’s family history, one may want to know about the risk of developing
disease. This is true for the person whose parent(s) may have died from
Huntington’s disease, a progressive neurodegenerative disease or for the person
whose mother and sister may have died from breast or ovarian cancer, suggesting
a heritable risk. For these individuals, a positive genetic test result will indicate
an increased, although not necessarily absolute, risk for developing the disease.
Genetic testing is used for assessing reproductive risks—by testing the parents
for carrier status and by testing the fetus. Individuals with a positive family history
of genetic disease (usually autosomal recessive or X-linked) or who come from
ethnic groups with an increased prevalence of autosomal recessive or X-linked
diseases are candidates for carrier screening. Currently, carrier screening for cystic
fibrosis, fragile X syndrome, and spinal muscular atrophy is recommended in
the United States. For people of Mediterranean, African, or South Asian ancestry,
hemoglobinopathy screening is recommended. For individuals of Ashkenazi
Jewish ancestry, screening for Tay-Sachs disease, Canavan disease, cystic fibrosis,
Gaucher disease, Bloom syndrome, Fanconi anemia, Niemann-Pick disease,
familial dysau-tonomia, maple syrup urine disease, glycogen storage disease,
and familial hyperinsulinism is available. An individual who is a carrier for a
certain condition may choose not to marry another individual who is a carrier for
the same condition. Alternatively, if a carrier couple is identified, they may choose
to have prenatal diagnosis to determine whether their fetus is affected with this
condition. This can be performed either at 10-11 weeks using the procedure of
chorionic villus sampling where a bit of placenta is obtained under ultrasound
66
guidance. As another option, an amniocentesis can be performed at 15-18 weeks Genetic Polymorphism
of pregnancy to obtain cells from the amniotic fluid. These couples might also
choose to have pre- implantation genetic diagnosis with selection implantation
of only those embryos that are deemed unaffected.
Not all genetic testing involves looking for heritable mutations. Sometimes it is
used to look for genetic alterations that are confined to a specific population of
cells. These alterations may cause certain cells to become cancerous, or if
cancerous, to progress to a more aggressive stage. Genetic testing can be used to
identify chromosomal translocations between two non-homologous chromosomal
segments and in the process diagnose a specific form of leukemia. For example,
the translocation between chromosomes 1 and 19 in leukemic cells is diagnostic
of the acute promyelocytic form of this disease and the translocation between
chromosomes 9 and 22 is diagnostic of the chronic myelogenous form. The
expression patterns of RNA transcribed from many genes can be assessed to
predict the natural history of the disease. This approach has been used to predict
breast cancer outcome and whether more or less aggressive therapies should be
used to treat patients.
Individuals might also have genetic tests of identity. These might be voluntary
and selected to test specific questions, such as whether they are members of a
known patrilineal lineage, such a people with a specific surname. These tests
analyze a series of polymorphic genetic markers on the Y chromosome. On the
basis of the general pattern of markers, or “haplogroup,” they may be told of the
geographic region where their Y chromosome originated. According to the number
of markers that match with people who are suspected to be of the same lineage,
individuals may be advised about the common ancestors or other people in that
lineage. Such testing is also possible for matrilineal lineages by testing
mitochondrial DNA markers.
Collect all the pedigrees where the disease is found. Analyse all the members
against various polymorphisms and perform linkage analysis.
Linkage study entails collecting blood cells from members of several two – and
three – generation families or from individuals of a large multiple generation
family with a specific genetic disorder. The blood can be cultured and cell lines
can be maintained large number of polymorphic markers (probes), representing
sites from all parts of all autosomes, are used. A two –point (two – locus) LOD
score is calculated for each polymorphic locus and the site of the genetic disease
from all informative parent offspring combinations and finally the linkage is
established. However, genotyping errors can give –ve or +ve LOD score. Hence
perfect genotyping is must to get the correct results.
67
Human Population Genetics
3.10 USE OF POLYMORPHIC MARKERS IN
FORENSIC TESTING
Polymorphic markers have great utility in personal identification. As mentioned
above no two individuals are alike. These differences are at both phenotypic and
genotypic levels. The genetic differences can be identified by testing these
markers. This testing is provided by commercial firms that market directly to
consumers. Identity genetic analysis may also be involuntary and used for paternity
testing of children or fetuses or for identification of forensic samples in murder,
assault or rape cases, in which the perpetrator of the crime left a tissue sample of
blood, semen, hair, or other tissue type from which DNA can be extracted and
the test can be performed. However, it must be kept in mind that there are ethnic
differences in the distribution of these markers. Hence every population should
have its own genetic profile.
3.12 SUMMARY
It is difficult to attribute any functional significance to genetic polymorphisms.
However, the non-coding sequences of the genes which are located far away
from the functional region of the gene may affect the function of the gene.
However, these sequences are otherwise useful in studying population diversity,
disease gene mapping, forensic investigations etc. Recently after the advent of
microarray genes for many complex disorders have been found by using genome
68 wide association studies.
Suggested Reading Genetic Polymorphism
Gardner, E.D, Simmons, M.J and Snustad, D.P. 2003. Principles of Genetics, 8th
Edition, New York: John Wiley and Sons.
Simmons, S and Simmons, M.J. 2003. Principles of Genetics, 3rd Edition, New
York: John Wiley and Sons.
Sample Question
1) Define polymorphism with few examples.
2) What are the evolutionary forces that affect gene frequency of polymorphic
markers?
3) Give some uses of polymorphic markers.
4) What is law of Hardy Weinberg?
5) What is genetic testing?
6) Describe the utility of studying molecular markers in anthropological
genetics.
69
Human Molecular Genetics
UNIT 2 DNA POLYMORPHISMS
Contents
2.1 Introduction
2.2 Different Forms of DNA Polymorphisms
2.3 Human Evolution with Special Reference to Mitochondrial DNA and
Y-Chromosome Polymorphisms
2.3.1 mt DNA Polymorphism-Human Evolution
2.3.2 Y Chromosome Polymorphism-Human Evolution
2.4 DNA Polymorphisms and Disease Association
2.4.1 Monogenetic Disease
2.4.2 Multifactorial Disease
2.5 Techniques in Molecular Genetics
2.5.1 Polymerase Chain Reaction
2.5.2 Restriction Fragment Length Polymorphism
2.5.3 DNA Sequencing Methods
2.5.4 Microarray
2.6 Summary
References
Suggested Reading
Sample Questions
Learning Objectives
&
After having studied this unit, you will be able to:
Ø understand Human DNA polymorphisms;
Ø explain types of DNA polymorphisms;
Ø discuss DNA polymorphisms role in disease manifestation; and
Ø describe Single Nucleotide Polymorphism’s role in reconstructing Human
evolution and modern Human migrations.
2.1 INTRODUCTION
Human genome (entire genetic material present in a cell) consists of 3 billion
bases. There are about 10 million Single Nucleotide Polymorphisms. The DNA
sequence will carry code of information for carrying genetic information from
parent to child (generation to generation). A person or plant or animal
phenotypically looking different, means that there are variations in the genetic
material of the organism. Any change in the DNA sequence will bring change in
the genetic information, inturn brings change in phenotypic expression and
biological function. The change in the DNA sequence is called Mutation. If the
mutation frequency is more than 2 per cent in a population, it is called as
polymorphism. Hence, we can define DNA polymorphism as DNA having more
than one form, with a frequency of above 2 percent in a population.
22
DNA Polymorphisms
2.2 DIFFERENT FORMS OF DNA
POLYMORPHISMS
DNA polymorphisms can be studied in the form of Single Nucleotide
Polymorphisms (SNPs), Restriction site Polymorphisms (RSPs) or Restricted
Fragment Length Polymorphisms (RFLP) and Variable Number of Tandem
Repeats (VNTRs).
Single Nucleotide Polymorphisms (SNPs): A single nucleotide is substituted
by a different nucleotide.
a) GA GA GA GA GA – it is dinuleotide repeat
b) TAT TAT TAT TAT- it is trinuleotide repeat
Mini-satellite polymorphism: A collection of moderately sized arrays of
tandemly repeated DNA sequence which are dispersed over considerable portions
of the nuclear genome.
c) TTAGGGTACCGG TTAGGGTACCGG TTAGGGTACCGG –this
array of 12 nucleotides repeats from 3-20 Kbp(thousand base pairs).
N haplogroup
M haplogroup
L3 haplogroup
L2 haplogroup
L1 haplogroup
L0 haplogroup
Based on the above table the tree has been constructed which is as follows.
28
DNA Polymorphisms
Fig.2.4: Y-Chromosome tree. Mutation names are indicated on the branches. A to T are
branch names. Sub trees are not shown in this figure (Karafet, 2008)
29
Human Molecular Genetics Another frequent type of polymorphism, present also in Y chromosome, is tandem
repeats, mostly in non-coding DNA regions. According to their length, these
repeats are classified as satellite-DNAs (repeat lengths of one to several thousand
base pairs), mini-satellites or variable number of tandem repeats (VNTRs),
ranging from 10 to 100 bp, and microsatellites or short tandem repeats (STRs),
with motifs less than 10 bp, mostly 2 to 6 bp long. In Y-chromosomal studies
microsatellites are widely used, than mini-satellites. Microsatellites are multi-
allelic markers with different allele numbers ranging from 3 to 49 in locus. Their
mutation rate is much higher than that for biallelic markers and, therefore, they
are widely used in phylogenetic studies to investigate details of demographic
events that have occurred in a more recent time scale. In evolutionary studies
STRs are valuable in combination with binary haplogroup data, as they enable
us to study diversity within a haplogroup. STRs are particularly widely explored
in forensic work. So far the number of widely used Y chromosomal STRs has
been quite low (about 30) but in a recent study 166 new and potentially useful
STRs were described.
Based on the Phylogenetic analysis it was concluded that, all humans have
originated from an African ancestor. About 70,000 thousand years ago modern
man came out of Africa and peopled all the continents.
Thus the combination of molecular age and geographical structure makes mtDNA
and the NRY a sensitive genetic index capable of tracing the micro evolutionary
patterns of noval modren human diversity. Mitochondrial DNA and Y
chromosome studies in Indian populations reveals affiliation with Europeans,
East Asians, Austro-Melanesians and in situ development of deep rooted ancestry
whose relative clustering and coalescence ages suggest shaping of Indian gene
pool during late pleistocene.
30
2.4.1 Monogenetic Disease DNA Polymorphisms
Example: Sickle cell anaemia is a disease passed down through families in which
red blood cells form an abnormal crescent shape (Red blood cells are normally
shaped like a disc.) Sickle cell anaemia is caused by an abnormal type of
haemoglobin called haemoglobin S. Haemoglobin is a protein inside red blood
cells that carries oxygen. Haemoglobin S changes the shape of red blood cells,
especially when the cells are exposed to low oxygen levels. Then the red blood
cells become crescent shaped or sickles. The sickling occurs because of a mutation
in the haemoglobin gene. The haemoglobin beta(HBB) gene is found in region
15.5 on the short (p) arm of human chromosome 11. In sickle cell haemoglobin
(HbS) the glutamic acid in position 6 is mutated to valine in a beta chain. This
change allows the deoxygenated form of the haemoglobin to stick to itself and
become crescent shape.
31
Human Molecular Genetics The fragile, sickle shaped cells deliver less oxygen to the body’s tissues. They
can also get stuck more easily in small blood vessels, and break into pieces that
interrupt healthy blood flow.
Sickle cell anaemia is inherited from both parents. If you inherit the haemoglobin
S gene from one parent and normal haemoglobin (A) from your other parent,
you will have sickle cell trait. People with sickle cell trait do not have the
symptoms of sickle cell anaemia. The children of both sickle cell parents will
get sickle cell anaemia.
Sickle cell disease is much more common in people of African and Mediterranean
descent. It is also seen in people from South and Central America, the Caribbean,
and the Middle East.
32
About 5 ml of blood is transferred to a sterile 15ml conical bottom polypropylene DNA Polymorphisms
tube and equal amount of RBC lysis buffer is added. Shake the tube gently for 3
to 5 minutes. The contents of the tube transforms into transparent red colour
upon the lysis of RBC. We have to ensure that RBC is completely lysed before
proceeding to further step. Once RBC is lysed, transfer the tubes into the
centrifuge. Run the centrifuge at 1500 rpm for 15 mts at 20oC. Upon the
completion of the run carefully, remove the tubes from the centrifuge and decant
the supernatant without disturbing the pellet at the bottom. Now add 4 ml of
RBC buffer to the tube and break the pellet using hand or vortex. Repeat the
centrifugation step as earlier with same settings. Decant the supernatant, if pellet
is still red repeat the RBC lysis. If pellets are light pink or white proceed for
further step.
Now add 250ul of 5M sodium per chlorate to the tube and gently mix the contents
by partially inverting the tube. Now add 500ul of tris saturated phenol, 500ul of
24:1 chloroform isoamyl alcohol, mix the contents thoroughly and adjust the
centrifuge at 4ºC, 4000 rpm and 15 minutes. Take a fresh tube, carefully transfer
the supernatant using the 1ml pipette and cut tips into the fresh tube. Now add
500ul of 24:1 chloroform and isoamyl alcohol, and repeat the centrifugation
step with same settings. Carefully transfer the supernatant using a cut tip into a
fresh tube. Add double the volume of chilled alcohol; gently invert the tube for
a minute. A milky white fibrous DNA is visible. Now transfer the DNA into a
1.5ml tube, add 1 ml of 70 % alcohol, spin at 12,000 rpm for 10 minutes, and
repeat the step for one more time to eliminate the remaining protein contamination.
Dry the pellets and add 200ul of TE buffer and mix the contents thoroughly and
transfer into the hot water bath/dry bath for digesting the DNA. This process
usually takes 2 hours. Transfer tubes for -80ºC for long term storage.
Details of the buffers and reagents used for DNA extraction are given below.
After DNA was completely dissolved in the TE buffer, its quantity and quality
was checked by both spectrophotometry and gel electrophoresis.
Procedure
2µl DNA sample was diluted to 200 µl with Double Distilled water (Dilution
1:100). Spectrophotometer was set to auto zero with the Double Distilled water.
Optical Density (OD) of the diluted DNA aliquot was measured at 260 nm and
280nm using quartz crystal cuvette.
Quality Assessment
A ratio of OD values at 260nm and 280nm indicates the purity of the extracted
DNA sample. If the ratio is within range of 1.6 to 2.0, then DNA sample is
considered as clear and free from contaminants like residual protein and mRNA.
An OD ratio less than 1.6 indicate the residual proteins or phenol contamination,
whereas ratio of more than 2.0 indicates residual RNA contamination.
Quantity Assessment
Electrophoretic analysis of DNA using agarose gels can confirm DNA integrity.
Typically intact genomic DNA will be up to 40KB in size, depending upon the
species. Prepare 1% agarose gel has to be by adding required quantity of agarose
to 1X Tris-Acetate-EDTA (TAE) buffer and mix well. Heat the mixture in
microwave oven until it became clear and take care to avoid over boiling and
evaporation. Cool the mixture to ~500 C and add ethidium bromide to make a
final concentration of 0.001ug/ml. Pour the entire mixture into a tray in which
combs are fixed to make wells in the gel. After gel formation, place the tray in
buffer tank containing 1X TAE buffer for submerged gel electrophoresis and
remove the combs with care to avoid rupture of wells. Mix 1µl of each DNA
sample with 1µl of loading dye and load the mixture into the wells. Subject the
Gel to electrophoresis at 90V for 30 minutes and visualise using gel documentation
system where it is exposed to Ultraviolet rays. Under Ultraviolet rays exposure,
DNA will give luminance which indicate the presence of DNA in the sample as
shown in the below figure.
34
DNA Polymorphisms
Primer designing
The main limitation of PCR technique is to provide short pieces of single-stranded
DNA (primers) that are complementary to a part of target sequence. With the use
of human genome sequence available we can now design primers to any region
of interest in the human genome. The most critical step in PCR experiment is
designing oligo-nucleotide primers. As poor primers could result in little or even
no PCR product, alternatively they could amplify unwanted DNA fragments.
Either will affect the downstream analysis. Many of the factors which affect the
primers specificity and sensitivity like product size, primer size, tm, GC content,
GC clamps and dimer formation can be adjusted as per the user requirement.
Primers which fit the specified criteria can be checked for their specificity using
NCBI BLAST.
35
Human Molecular Genetics
36
2.5.2 Restriction Fragment Length Polymorphism DNA Polymorphisms
If two different samples show VNTRs of different lengths, the samples could
not have come from the same person. On the other hand, two samples showing
VNTRs of the same length could have come from the same person, or from two
people who happen to have VNTRs of the same length at that location. By
comparing enough VNTRs from two individuals, however, the likelihood of a
coincidental match can be reduced to nearly zero. RFLP testing requires hundreds
of steps and weeks to complete, and it has been largely replaced by newer, faster
techniques.
Fig. 2.8: Restricted enzyme EcoR-I identifies its specific GAATTC sequence and Cuts
between G and A of the DNA strand. a) Showing the cutting positions. b) Showing
resulted four strand fragments after enzyme digestion
STRs can be amplified and sequenced using PCR and Sequencing techniques.
Analysis is based on the number of repeats present in the sample.
37
Human Molecular Genetics
Fig.2.9: a) One DNA strand showing 7 repeats (STRs) of AATG. b) Another DNA strand
showing 8 repeats of AATG.
Unlike repeated portions of DNA like STRs and VNTRs, in the case of SNPs it
is the sequence itself, not its length that is useful to forensic scientists. SNPs are
commonly occurring every 100 to 300 bases along the entire length of the human
genome. Mutations in SNPs are very rare, so the sequences tend to be passed
unchanged across generations. But because any given SNP is relatively common
in the population, an analyst must examine dozens of SNPs to derive a true DNA
fingerprint. For this reason, SNP analysis is rarely used in forensic cases.
40
DNA Polymorphisms
2.5.4 Microarray
A DNA microarray (also commonly known as gene chip, DNA chip, or biochip)
is a collection of microscopic DNA spots attached to a solid surface. Scientists
use DNA microarrays to measure the expression levels of large numbers of genes
simultaneously or to genotype multiple regions of a genome. Each DNA spot
contains picomoles (10-12 moles) of a specific DNA sequence, known
41
Human Molecular Genetics as probes (or reporters). These can be a short section of a gene or other DNA
element that are used to hybridize a cDNA or cRNA sample (called target) under
high-stringency conditions. Probe-target hybridisation is usually detected and
quantified by detection of fluorophore, silver, or chemiluminescence-labelled
targets to determine relative abundance of nucleic acid sequences in the target
Principle
Many types of arrays exist and the broadest distinction is whether they are spatially
arranged on a surface or on coded beads: (i) The traditional solid-phase array is
a collection of orderly microscopic “spots”, called features, each with a specific
probe attached to a solid surface, such as glass, plastic or silicon biochip
(commonly known as a genome chip, DNA chip or gene array). Thousands of
them can be placed in known locations on a single DNA microarray. (ii)The
alternative bead array is a collection of microscopic polystyrene beads, each
with a specific probe and a ratio of two or more dyes, which do not interfere with
the fluorescent dyes used on the target sequence.
References
Rao V.R. and A.R.Sankyan, 2007. Human origins, genome and people of India.
Anthropological Survey of India. Allied publications Pvt Ltd, New Delhi .
Chandrasekar, A et al. YAP insertion signature in South Asia. Ann Hum Biol.
34(5):582-586 (2007).
Palanichamy MG, Sun C, Agrawal S, Bandelt H-J, Kong Q-P, et al. 2004.
Phylogeny of mitochondrial DNA macrohaplogroup N in India, based on complete
sequencing: implications for the peopling of South Asia. Am J Hum Genet 75:
966–978.
Web resources:
http://ycc.biosci.arizona.edu/
http://yhrd.org
http://mitomap.org
http://phylotree.org
http://projects.tcag.ca/variation/decipher
http://ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/projects/SNP/
43
Human Molecular Genetics Suggested Reading
Tom Strachan and Andrew P. Read. 2004. Human Molecular Genetics. Garland
publishing, Taylor and Francis Group, London and New York.
Human Genome Nature Issue (15 February 2001) Nature 409, 813-958. http://
www.nature.com/genomics/human/
Human Genome Science Issue (16 February 2001) Science 291, 1177-1351. http:/
/www.sciencemag.org/content/vol291/issue5507/index.shtml
Sample Questions
1) Define what in DNA polymorphism and its forms?
2) Explain how mtDNA polymorphism helped in understanding modern
humans in Indian subcontinent?
3) Discuss the Y-chromosome tree?
Short Notes
1) Polymerase Chain Reaction?
Sanger method of DNA sequencing?
RFLP and its uses?
Microarray and its usage?
44
Population Genetics
UNIT 4 CHROMOSOMAL ABERRATIONS
IN MAN
Contents
4.1 Introduction
4.2 Changes in Chromosome Number
4.3 Specific Autosomal Abnormalities
4.4 Sex Chromosomal Abnormalities
4.5 Mosaicism
4.6 Structural Abnormalities or Chromosome Rearrangements
4.7 Summary
Suggested Reading
Sample Questions
4.1 INTRODUCTION
Chromosomes and genes
A chromosome is an organised thread-like microscopic structure found in the
cell nucleus of living organisms including man. Until 1956, it was thought that
the number of chromosomes in man was 48, when it was established that it is 46.
Each human cell, except for the gametes, i.e. ovum (egg) and the sperm cells,
contains 23 pairs of chromosomes (22 pairs of autosomes and one pair of sex
chromosome). Women possess two identical chromosomes called the X
chromosomes while men possess one X chromosome and one Y chromosome.
The ovum and sperm cells each contain 23 chromosomes (22 autosomes and
one X or Y chromosome). The behaviour of chromosomes at somatic cell division
in mitosis provides a mechanism that ensures the daughter cells to retain its own
complete genetic component. Similarly their behaviour in the reproductive cells
during gametes formation in meiosis enables each mature ovum and sperm to
contain a unique single set of parental genes.
In earlier lectures we have discussed about gene mutations, where a change occurs
from one allelic form to another, and such changes led to new inherited properties.
However, there are other type of changes, namely, changes in the quantity of the
chromosomal material and changes in its arrangement. The cellular and
developmental functioning of an organism depends not only on the presence of
the necessary alleles, but also on their harmonious interaction with each other.
Generally, the chromosomes remain unchanged but under certain natural or
artificial adverse circumstances certain structural changes may occur in the
55
Human Genetics chromosomes which alter the positions of gene or loss of some genes or changes
in chromosomal number. Any alteration in the number of chromosomes or changes
in gross structure of chromosome that disrupts this genetic balance generally
produces developmental abnormalities with profound phenotypic effects in the
form of physical effects and sometimes accompanied by mental imbalances. These
structural and numerical alterations which affect the phenotype of the organisms
in various degrees are collectively called chromosomal aberrations or anomalies
or abnormalities. These accumulated sets of abnormalities so produced are called
syndrome. If several specific abnormal traits present in the same individual are
transmitted to his offspring as a unit, as they often are, it can usually be assumed
that they depend jointly on a single gene. In medicine such group of characters is
called a syndrome. A well-known example of a syndrome is Marfan’s syndrome,
or Arachnodactyly (spider-fingeredness), so called because of the excessive length
of the bones of fingers and toes. Though abnormal chromosomes account for at
least 50 per cent of spontaneous abortions, only 0.65 per cent of newborns have
abnormal chromosomes as most embryos and fetuses with abnormal
chromosomes stop developing before birth.
Chromosomal Changes
Normally, every somatic cell contains a pair of each type of autosome, each pair
of autosomes has numerous pairs of homologous loci, and at each of these loci is
one of a pair of alleles. The harmonious genic action depends on the twofold
presence of each locus. Occasionally, however, abnormalities in the division or
the distribution of the chromosomes or of chromosomal sections may result in
some loci existing in triplicate or singly instead of as a pair. The abnormal
chromosomal types in many plants and animals have shown that development
does not proceed normally. Such imbalance in the genetic content of the zygotes
– two alleles of most loci but three, or one, of the loci of certain chromosome –
may result in early death of the zygote. Sometime, however, full development of
the zygote may occur but the individual will not be normal. One of the most
remarkable and abnormal syndromes in man is that called Down’s syndrome or
Mongolism, first described as a clinical syndrome in 1866 by Langdon-Down of
England. Affected individuals are characterised by physical abnormalities of the
face, eyelids, tongue, and other parts of the body and are greatly retarded both
physically and mentally. The incidence at birth is about 1/700 among Europeans.
This is caused due to the presence of a very small 47th chromosome, and the
small chromosome is present in triplicate, instead of duplicate, on chromosome
number 21, suggesting the synonym Trisomy 21.
56 Source: www.science.com
By 1959 a variety of chromosomal aberrations was demonstrated in man. Different Chromosomal Aberrations
in Man
types of abnormalities which can occur are divided into numerical, structural
and a third category consisting of different chromosome constitutions in two or
more cell lines. A chromosome anomaly or abnormality or aberration reflects an
atypical number of chromosomes or a structural abnormality in one or more
chromosomes. A karyotype is a full set of chromosomes arranged in an order of
their size from an individual which can be compared to a “normal” karyotype for
the species via genetic testing. Any anomaly in the chromosome may be detected
or confirmed in this manner. Chromosome anomalies usually occur when there
is a fault in cell division following meiosis or mitosis. These chromosome
anomalies can be organised and summarized into two basic groups, numerical
and structural anomalies (Table 4.1).
Table 4.1: Chromosomal abnormalities
Numerical
Aneuploidy – Monosomy
– Trisomy
– Tetrasomy
Polyploidy – Triploidy
– Tetraploidy
Structural
Translocation – Reciprocal
– Robertsonian
Deletions
Insertions
Inversions – Paracentric
– Pericentric
Rings
Isochromosomes
Different cell lines (Mixoploidy)
– Mosaicism
– Chimaerism
58
The meiotic error that causes aneuploidy is called non-disjunction. Non- Chromosomal Aberrations
in Man
disjunction is the failure of two members of homologous chromosome pair to
separate during cell division so that both pass to the same daughter cell. It is not
clear how non-disjunction is caused. But the factors implicated for the cause of
nondisjunction are aging, radiation and delayed fertilization after ovulation. The
principal cause of aneuploidy is an accident in meiosis that leads to an unequal
distribution of chromosome pair (www.scribd.com).
In meiotic cell division there are two instances in which non-disjunction can
occur – during first meiotic division or second meiotic division (see figure 4.1).
In either case, the result is the production of one or more gametes that carry an
extra chromosome and one or more gametes that lack a chromosome.
Source: Nagle, J.J. 1974 Heredity and Human Affairs. Saint Louis, The C.U. Mosby Company p. 256
4.5 MOSAICISM
Mosaicism
All forms of aneuploidy are not clear as discussed earlier as mixtures of aneuploidy
and normal cell lines are possible to exist within the same person. These are
called chromosomal mosaicism. Mosaicism is defined as the presence of two or
more cell lines in an individual or in a tissue which differ in their genetic
constitution and are derived from the same zygote (Fig.4.2). The degree of
abnormality may range from severe to negligible. Mosaicism may occur in two
ways. The most common one is the mitotic non-disjunction — that occurs at an
60
early stage of embryonic development and in this case one daughter cell will be Chromosomal Aberrations
in Man
trisomic for the chromosome in question and the other daughter cell will be
monosomic. Thus the individual is a chromosomal mosaic – an individual with
two or more chromosomally distinct cell lines.
62
Chromosomal Aberrations
in Man
Deletions (Deficiencies)
In deletion or deficiency type aberration, a chromosome lacks either in an interstitial
or terminal chromosomal segment which may include only a single gene or part of
a gene. If break occurs near the end of a chromosome a small piece of the terminal
end is lost and thus, terminal deficiency occurs. Sometimes two breaks may occur
at any two points, releasing an intercalary segment which may remain rod-shaped
or may become ring-shaped, if its broken ends join and fuse, a ring-shaped
chromosome called deletion ring is formed (www.microbiologyprocedure.com).
The broken ends of original chromosome are fused and have intercalary or
interstitial deficiency. A deletion is the loss of a portion of a chromosome and, in
effect, represents partial monosomy. Breakage may occur by any of a number of
agents such as irradiation, chemicals, drugs, and viral infections. Deletions occur
in one of two ways:
ü the chromosome breaks during interphase of the cell cycle and the broken
piece is lost when the cell divides, and
ü parts of chromosomes are lost due to unequal crossing-over during mitosis.
The syndromes caused by the deletion of either short arm or long arm are associated
with mental and physical retardation. The physical abnormalities tend to be variable
from patient to patient. However, children with partial deletion of the short arm of
chromosome 18 sometimes have malformations in their ear and jaws and those
with partial deletion of the long arm of 18 have severe eye and ear defects.
Duplications
Duplications are the chromosomes having an extra part and gene sequences.
Traditionally, only large duplications could be visualized in karyotypes and, in
general, the more genes involved, the more severe the associated syndrome. Small
duplications tend to be less severe than deletions of small sizes. Small duplications
involving only a few genes, called repeats can be tolerated. In fact, such
duplications are thought to be an important evolutionary mechanism for the origin
of “new genes”. Duplications of large unwanted copies of portions of the
chromosome most often arise from unequal crossing-over. Most disorders arising
from duplications are considered partial trisomies because large portions of one
chromosome are usually present in triplicate. 63
Human Genetics Inversions
An inversion (see Fig. 4.4) involves breaks (a) in one chromosome, followed by
repair in the form of reversal of the broken segment (b), and restitution of the
broken ends (c), resulting in an inverted chromosome (d). The normal order of
genes of this chromosome is ABCD, but in the inverted chromosome the order
of the genes is ACBD. Depending on whether or not the centromere is included
within the inverted section, two kinds of inversions can be distinguished:
v paracentric inversion when the centromere is outside the inverted segment and
v pericentric invesion when the centromere is included in the inverted segment
of the chromosome.
Heterozygous inversions can cause problem during meiosis. When synapsis occurs
during prophase 1, all regions of the inverted chromosome try to pair gene for
gene with the corresponding regions of the normal chromosome. To accomplish
this, the inverted region in one of the chromosomes must form a loop (see Fig.
4.6); this loop will permit gene-for-gene pairing with homologue. Thus, except
for a relatively small region around the breakpoints themselves, the normal and
the inverted chromosomes can synapse all along lengths. The result is the
formation of four gametes from the Anaphase I cell (see Fig.4.6), one will carry
the normal chromosomes, one will carry the inverted chromosome, and two will
have major abnormalities as a result of the crossover. In addition, among the
phenotypically normal offspring (whether the inversion is large or small, and
whether a crossover occurs or not), half will inherit the inverted chromosome
and the other half will inherit its noninverted homologue.
Fig. 4.6: (a) Synapsis in an individual who is hetetozygous for a paracentric inversion
showing a crossover within the inversion loop. (b) Anaphase I configuration
resulting from the crossover in (a). One of the chromatids involved in the
crossover is dicentric (solid arrows); the other is an acentric (open arrows)
Source: Hartl, D.L, 1985. Our uncertain heritage: Genetics andHuman Diversity.
New York, Harper and Row Publishers, p. 186 65
Human Genetics Similar to paracentric inversions, synapsis in meiosis produces an inversion loop
and crossing-over within this loop resulting in abnormal chromatids in pericentric
inversions also (Fig.4.7). The chromatids involved in a crossover within the
inversion loop of a heterozygous pericentric inversion will carry duplications
and deficiencies and will lead to offspring who have major chromosomal
abnormalities. Among the phenotypically normal offspring of an individual who
is heterozygous for a pericentric inversion, half will receive the inverted
chromosome and the other half will receive its noninverted homologue.
Fig. 4.7: (a) Synapsis in an individual who is hetetozygous for a paracentric inversion
showing a crossover within the inversion loop. (b) Anaphase I configuration
resulting from the crossover in (a). One of the chromatids involved in the
crossover has a duplication of A and a deficiency of D (solid arrows); the other
chromatid has a deficiency of A and a duplication of D (open arrows)
Source: Hartl, D.L, 1985. Our uncertain heritage: Genetics andHuman Diversity.
New York, Harper and Row Publishers, p.185
The larger the segments in the duplication and deletion in the recombinant
chromosome, the greater the degree of imbalance and the more likely miscarriage
will result. Also the smaller the size of the inversion, the greater will be the
degree of imbalance which will result in miscarriage of recombinant conceptions.
Translocations
Translocation is another class of structural abnormalities commonly found in
man which involves the detachment of a segment of one chromosome and
reattachment to another, usually nonhomologous, chromosome. The genetic
significance of this structural rearrangement is that genes from one chromosome
are transferred to another. These are of two types: (1) Reciprocal translocation
and (2) Nonreciprocal translocation. The reciprocal translocation is referred to
the structural rearrangement when segments of two nonhomologous chromosomes
are interchanged without any net loss of genetic material (Fig. 4.8). A special
type of nonreciprocal translocation is a Robertsonian translocation, in which
the centromeric regions of two nonhomologous acrocentric chromosomes become
fused to form a single centromere (Fig.4.9) (www.udl.es/usuaris).
In the reciprocal translocation as illustrated in Figure 4.8 no chromosomal material
is gained or lost and also each chromosome is monocentric. An individual who
carries the parts of reciprocal translocation (see (c) of Figure 4.8) would also
carry the normal homologue of both chromosome (i.e., ABCDE and YZ). Such
an individual is said to carry a balanced translocation because the individual
carries all the normal genes in their proper dosage; only the order of genes has
been changed. Individuals who carry only part of reciprocal translocation and
thus have duplications and/or deficiencies are said to carry unbalanced
66
translocations. When the interchanged parts of the reciprocal translocation are
large, the individuals with unbalanced translocations will have large duplications Chromosomal Aberrations
or deficiencies and would be expected to undergo spontaneous abortion. in Man
Fig. 4.8: Origin of a reciprocal translocation (c) from breaks ubtwo nonhomologous chromosomes
(a) followed by repositioning of broken ends and restitution of the breaks (b)
Source: Hartl, D.L, 1985. Our uncertain heritage: Genetics andHuman Diversity
New York, Harper and Row Publishers, p.189
Isochromosomes have been observed for the X chromosome with some regularity,
but they are virtually unknown in autosomes, except possibly for chromosome
21 in a few cases of Down’s syndrome.
Ring Chromosomes
A portion of a chromosome gets broken off and forms a circle or ring. A ring
chromosome is formed when a break occurs on each chromosome leaving two
sticky ends on the central portion which reunites as a ring. This can happen with
or without loss of genetic material. Ring chromosomes can be a centric or acentric
event.
Chromosome rearrangements can cause deletions and duplications.
In a Robertsonian translocation, the long arms of two different acrocentric
chromosomes join.
In a reciprocal translocation, chromosomes exchange parts.
68
Chromosomal Aberrations
If a translocation leads to a deletion or duplication, or disrupts a gene, in Man
symptoms may result.
Gene duplications and deletions can occur in isochromosomes and ring
chromosomes, and when crossovers involve inversions.
An isochromosome has two identical arms, introducing duplications and
deletions.
Ring chromosomes form when telomeres are missing.
4.7 SUMMARY
A Chromosome is a thread-like structure located in the cell nucleus of living
organisms. Generally, the chromosomes remain unchanged but due to certain
natural or adverse conditions the chromosomal number changes or certain
structural alterations may occur in the chromosomes which modifies the positions
of gene or loss of some genes. Abnormal Chromosome Number: A euploid
somatic human cell has 22 pairs of autosomes and one pair of sex chromosomes.
Polyploid cells have extra chromosome sets. Aneuploids have extra or missing
chromosomes. Trisomies (an extra chromosome) are less harmful than
monosomies (lack of a chromosome), and sex chromosome aneuploidy is less
severe than autosomal aneuploidy. Nondisjunction is uneven distribution of
chromosomes in meiosis. It causes aneuploidy. Most autosomal aneuploids cease
developing as embryos.
There are two different types of abnormalities in chromosome number, (1) the
presence of extra entire sets of chromosomes, and (2) involves individual
chromosomes instead of entire sets of chromosomes. Monosomic and trisomic
zygotes are usually the consequence of non-disjunction during meiotic cell
division. Non-disjunction is the inability of two members of homologous
chromosome pair to separate during cell division so that both pass to the same
daughter cell and the result is the production of one or more gametes that carry
an extra chromosome and one or more gametes lack a chromosome. There are
three types of trisomies and one monosomy of sex chromosomes observed in
man. Turner’s syndrome is a monosomy (XO, 45,X) and Klinefelter’s syndrome
(XXY, 47,XXY), Trisomy X syndrome (XXX, 47,XXX), and Jacob’s (Double
Y) syndrome (XYY, 47,XYY) are the trisomics. Among the autosomes, only
one monosomy is observed which is very rare. It is called Al-Aish’s syndrome
(21, 0 or 45, -21). There are three autosomal trisomics in man and they are Patau’s
syndrome (13, 13, 13 or 47, +13), Edward’s syndrome (18, 18, 18 or 47, +18)
and Down’s syndrome (21, 21, 21 or 47, +21).
A mixture of aneuploidy and normal cell lines are possible to exist within the
same person. These are called chromosomal mosaicism. The presence of two or
more genetically distinct cell lines in an individual derived from more than one
zygote is called chimerism. Chromosomes are prone to accidents that break and
alter their individual structure. Deletions and/or duplications result from crossing
over after pairing errors in synapsis. Crossing over in an inversion heterozygote
can also generate deletions and duplications. A chromosome with a deletion
(deficiency) has certain genes missing. Small duplications involving only a few
genes, are thought to be an important evolutionary mechanism for the origin of
“new genes”. In a Robertsonian translocation, the short arms of two acrocentric
69
Human Genetics chromosomes break, leaving sticky ends on the long arms that join to form an
unusual, large chromosome. In a reciprocal translocation, two nonhomologous
chromosomes substitute parts. A translocation carrier may have an associated
phenotype and generate some unbalanced gametes. Isochromosomes repeat one
chromosome arm but delete the other. This happens when the centromere divides
in the wrong plane during meiosis. Ring chromosomes form when telomeres are
removed, leaving sticky ends that hold on.
Reference
www.dummies.com
www.microbiologyprocedure.com
www.udl.es
www.scribd.com
www.uqu.edu.sa
Suggested Reading
Borgaonkar, D. S. 1977. Chromosomal Variation in Man. New York, Alan R.
Liss.
Gardner, R. J. M. and Sutherland, G. R. 2004. Chromosome Abnormalities and
Genetic Counseling. London,Oxford University Press.
Stern, C.1960. Principles of Human Genetics. San Francisco and London, W.
H. Freeman and Company.
Therman, E. S. 1993. Human Chromosomes: Structure, Be haviour and Effects.
New York. Springer-Verlag.
Whittinghill, M. 1965. Human Genetics and Its Foundations. Calcutta, New
Delhi, Oxford and IBH Publishing Company.
Sample Questions
1) Distinguish among a euploid, aneuploid, and polyploid. State which of the
following involve in aneuploid number of chromosomes: diploidy,
duplication, haploidy, triplication, Trisomy 21, Turner’s syndrome, XXYY.
2) Discuss classification of some structural mutants, and illustrate them
diagrammatically.
3) How many chromosomes would a person have who has Klinefelter syndrome
and also trisomy 21?
4) Describe an individual with each of the following chromosome constitutions.
Mention the person’s sex and possible phenotype.
a) 47, XXX; b). 45, X; c) (47, + 21) trisomy 21
5) List three types of chromosomal aberrations that can cause duplications and/
or deletions, and explain how they do so. List three causes of Turner
syndrome.
70
Human Chromosome
UNIT 1 HUMAN CHROMOSOME
Contents
1.1 Introduction
1.1.1 Definition of Genetics
1.1.2 What are Genes?
1.2 What is Cytogenetics?
1.2.1 The Human Genome
1.2.2 Cell Theory
1.2.3 The Cell and its Types
1.2.4 Cell Cycle
1.2.5 Types of Cell Divisions
1.3 Human Chromosome Complement
1.3.1 Morphology of Human Chromosome
1.3.2 Classification of Chromosomes
1.3.3 The Groups of Chromosomes
1.4 Methods Used in Chromosome Analysis
1.4.1 Chromosome Preparation
1.4.2 Chromosome Banding Techniques
1.4.3 High Resolution Banding
1.5 Karyotype Analysis
1.5.1 Counting the Number
1.5.2 Analysis of the Banding Pattern
1.5.3 Idiogram
1.6 Summary
Further Reading
Sample Questions
Learning Objectives
&
After reading this unit, you would be able to:
Ø discuss the basics of Cytogenetics;
Ø understand difference in cell division;
Ø explain the basis of classification of human chromosomes;
Ø understand how the chromosome preparations are made;
Ø discuss different techniques available to stain the chromosome; and
Ø understand the methods used in chromosomal analysis and its importance.
1.1 INTRODUCTION
In this block you will learn about an important branch of human genetics known
as Human cytogenetics. But before that let me begin with the important elements
that will enable you to understand this block’s theme.
5
Human Cytogenetics 1.1.1 Definition of Genetics
Essentially, Genetics is the science of heredity and the study of genes. You might
be aware from the newspapers and other media about the rapid expansion of the
knowledge in the recent past in the field of genetics. You as an Anthropologist
need to understand that genetics will play a central role not only in the new
model of medical practice; but also in understanding the variations both normal
and abnormal among the diverse ethnic populations spread across World.
The next question is, “Where are these genes?” They are in you. Yes! They are in
each of your cell trying to maintain you in all ways, be it your growth, development
or disease resistance. They reside tightly packed in what is called as chromosome.
So, chromosomes are thread like structures where a linear end to end arrangement
of these genes exists.
Centromere
Telomere
Cell
Histones
Base pairs
DNA
Single celled prokaryotes (bacteria and archaebacteria) lack nuclei and have
simpler chromosome. The hereditary material that is faithfully passed on from
your ancestor to you resides in the chromosome.
Your body contains about 10 trillion cells. All of them came from just one cell,
the fertilised egg. Yet the 10 trillion cells you are made up of are now no longer
identical to each other. The skin, bones, muscles, brain, internal organs all are
made up of different somatic cells. Yet they are a product of two germ cells that
are also called as reproductive cells- the egg in your mother and the sperm in
your father that united sexually to produce the new individual called you. Around
200 different types of somatic cells exist; each specialised to perform one or
more unique functions.
Inspite of differences in the structure and function of the different cell types
there are certain basic structure and functions common to virtually all cells.
(Fig.1.3). But remember, that cells have complex organisations and multiple
roles. How they develop and carry on their work is taken care by the information
packed in their nuclei. The nucleus forms the large central compartment. As I
told you earlier the nuclear envelope consists of two membranes that contain
many pores, through which materials are exchanged with the surrounding
cytoplasm; within the nucleus, are at least one dark staining nucleolus and many
finely dispersed chromosomes.
Apoptosis
Check Point
DNA Damage
Check Point
Spindle
Assembly
Check point
9
Human Cytogenetics During the next phase called S phase, cell replicates its entire genome, each
chromosome replicates longitudinally held together by the centromere. This phase
lasts for 8-10 hours and synthesises protein required for the formation of spindle-
the structre that pull the chromosomes to the poles of the cells during anaphase
stage of cell division.
G2 phase occurs after the replication of DNA and before the cell enters the mitotic
divsion. In this phase cell synthesises more of protein, membranes are formed
from the proteins produced in G1 phase and stored in small vesicles that will
enclose the daughter cells at later stage.
There are certain check points (group of interacting proteins) that ensure that the
events happen in proper sequence. These points are a) DNA damage check point-
that acts during S phase. It inhibits cell cycle from proceeding further till the
damage is rectified, b) Apoptosis Check Point- which acts as the mitosis begins.
In apoptosis check point, proteins called “survivins” override the signals causing
cell death. Thus cells are kept at mitosis., c) Spindle assembly check points- take
care of spindle formation to which chromosomes are attached helping their
movement towards the poles during cell division.
Mitosis
Mitosis is the normal form of cell division. As a person develops from an embryo
through fetus and infant to an adult, cell divisions are needed to generate the
large number of cells required. Remember that many cells have a limited life
span, so there is a continuous requirement to generate new cells in the adult. All
these cell divisions occur by Mitosis. Mitosis is the normal process or cell division,
from cleavage of the zygote to death of the person. It is estimated that in the life
time of a human, there may be something like 1017 mitotic divisions.
Fig. 1.5: Mitosis (M) phase: The division of genetic material and cellular contents
Source:sparkcharts.sparknotes.com
10
Meiosis Human Chromosome
Meiosis is a specialized form of cell division giving rise to the sperm and egg
cells. Primordial germ cells migrate into the embryonic gonad and engage in
repeated rounds of mitosis to form oogonia in females and spermatogonia in
males. Further growth and differentiation produces primary oocytes in the ovary
and produces primary spermatocytes in the testis. These specialized diploid cells
can undergo meiosis.
An important point to remember is, that meiosis involves two successive cell divisions
first, reduction stage during which chromosome number is halved (i.e it becomes
haploid or n) and second, the multiplication stage (also known as equational stage)
with mitotic division maintaning the haploid number of chromosomes. Only one
round of DNA replication occurs so the products are haploid.
2 nm –10 nm –30 nm
Histome Portion of an
octamer interphase
chromosome
–200 bp
of DNA
In a diploid nucleus, the two members of a chromosome pair are called homologous
chromosomes or just homologs. Thus in diploids, each gene is present as a gene
pair. Although the nucleus in a human cell contains pairs of chromosomes, they
are not physically paired, in the sense of being next to each other.
Most of our knowledge of chromosome structure has been gained using microscope.
Fig. 1. 8: Electron micrograph of human chromosome showing the centromere and well
defined chromatids (Source: glaucoma-eye-info.com)
Special stains selectively taken up by the DNA have enabled each individual
chromosome to be identified. These are best seen during cell division when the
chromosomes are maximally contracted. During this contracted phase the
constituent genes can no longer be transcribed. At this point of time, you can see
that each chromosome consists of two identical strands known as chromatids, or
12 sister chromatids, which are the result of DNA replication having taken place
during the S (synthesis) phase of the cell cycle. The point or the primary Human Chromosome
constriction at which the two sister chromatids are joined is called as the
centromere. This is the spot that is responsible for the movement of chromosomes
at cell division. Each centromere divides the chromosome into short or petite
arm (designated as p) and long arm (designated as q). The tip of each chromosome
arm is known as the telomere. Telomeres seal the chromosome tips and their
DNA caps have a unique chemical structure that keeps chromosomes from
shortening during replication.
But with aging and with certain types of cancer there is a gradual accumulation
of changes (mutations) in telomeres. Please remember that for unknown reasons
the regions next to telomeres contain a high concentration of genes. Telomeres
are known to be highly conserved throughout evolution and in humans they
contain many tandem repeats of a sequence TTAGGG Sequence.
Morphologically chromosomes are classified according to the position of the
centromere.
If this is located centrally, the chromosome is metacentric, if terminal it is
acrocentric, and in case the centromere is located in an intermediate position, the
chromosome is sub-metacentic.
14
The regions in the chromosomes where genes are actively expressed stains lightly Human Chromosome
and these are called as euchromatin regions. On the contrary heterochromatin
regions stain darkly and is made up of largely inactive, unexpressed, repetitive
DNA.
Any tissue with living cells having a nucleus that can undergo cell division is
suitable for studying human chromosomes. The commonest method is to use
circulating lymphocytes from peripheral blood.
Some steps in the chromosome preparation are given below:
1) The venous blood sample is added to a small volume of nutrient medium
containing phytohemagglutinin, which stimulates T lymphocytes to divide.
2) The cells are cultured under sterile conditions in an incubator at 370C for
about for 72 hours, at the end of which the culture is terminated.
3) At 70 hours i.e. 2 hours prior to the termination of the culture, colchicine is
added to each culture which now stops the cell division at metaphase.
Colchicine is a chemical that has a special property of preventing formation
of the spindle. Once the spindle is not formed, the cell division gets arrested
at metaphase. Metaphase is the time when the chromosomes are condensed
to a maximum extent and because of this condensation are very clearly
visible.
4) Hypotonic saline is then added to the cultures, which causes the cells to
swell which helps in the lysing or breaking of the cells with ease.
15
Human Cytogenetics 5) Then the cell suspensions are dropped on the pre chilled glass slides by
holding the pipettes at a distance so that good metaphase spreads are obtained.
6) The cells are then fixed and mounted on a slide.
7) The slides are further processed for staining.
Fig. 1.14: Metaphase spread of unbanded chromosomes from a normal male (XY)
(source: physics.uwo.ca)
1.5.3 Idiogram
The banding pattern of each chromosome is specific and can be shown in a
particular style known as idiogram. The chromosome pairs are conventionally
presented in a karyotype also called as karyogram with each pair of chromosomes
arranged in descending order of their size.
18
Human Chromosome
So, having introduced the important steps to you, I will now sum up that, karyotype
is the chromosomal complement of a cell, individual, or species. It describes the
light microscopic morphology of the component chromosomes, so that their
relative lengths, centromere positions and secondary constrictions can be
identified. Attention should be paid to heteromorphic sex chromosomes
(homologous chromosomes that differ morphologically).
The karyotype is often illustrated with a figure showing the chromosomes placed
in order from largest to smallest as I mentioned earlier. This illustration is called
as idiogram, which can be constructed by aligning photomicrographs of individual
chromosomes, or it may be an inked drawing, summarizing the data from a series
of analyses of metaphase chromosome spreads.
1.6 SUMMARY
The normal human karyotype is made up of 46 chromosomes consisting of 22
pairs of autosomes and a pair of sex chromosomes XX in the female and XY in
the male. Specific banding patterns help to identify the different chromosomes
after using special procedures to culture the cells. Mitosis and meiosis are the
two types of cell divisions. Mitosis takes place in the somatic cells while meiosis
occurs during the final stage of gametogenisis. Homologous chromosomes at
this stage exchange segments and then segregate independently to the matured
daughter cells. DNA, the genetic material consists of two nucleiotide chains
wound in a helix. In the backbone of each chain the sugar deoxyribose alternates
with phosphate groups. Attached to the sugars of both strands are the paired
basis: A opposite T and G opposite C. Chromosomes are best seen during cell
division especially at metaphase when they are tightly coiled. Each replicated
chromosome at first consists of two identical chromatids joined by an undivided
centromere. Each chromosome can be identified in metaphase are late prophase
by its size, shape and banding pattern. Chromosome analysis is important to
detect the structural and numerical abnormalities, which lead to the development
of clinical conditions or syndromes.
Further Reading
Peter, D. Turnpenny and Sian Ellard. 2007. Emery’s Elements of Medical
Genetics, 13th Edition, Philadelphia : Elsevier Publications.
Robert, C. King and William, D. StansField. 2002. A Dictionary of Genetics. 6th
Edition, New Delhi: Oxford University Press.
Elaine Johansen Mange and Arthur, P.Mange. 1999. Basic Human Genetics, 2nd
Edition. Sunderland Publishers.
Thomas, D. Gelehrter and Francis S.Collins. 1993. Principles of Medical
Genetics, 3rd Edition. Williams and Wilkins.
Sample Questions
1) Write in brief about the human chromosome complement.
2) What is the basis for the classification of the chromosomes?
3) Highlight the seven classes of human chromosomes described in a karyotype.
4) What is a telomere?
5) What is the importance of chromosome analysis?
6) Define Idiogram.
7) Write on the various chromosome banding techniques available.
8) Differentiate between mitosis and meiosis.
9) Write briefly on the morphology of human chromosomes.
10) What is cell theory?
20
Human Chromosome
UNIT 2 CHROMOSOMAL ABERRATIONS
Contents
2.1 Introduction
2.2 Types of Chromosomal Aberrations
2.2.1 Numerical Aberrations
2.2.2 Structural Aberrations
2.3 Aneuploidy Changes in Humans
2.3.1 Autosomal Trisomies
2.3.2 Autosomal Monosomies
2.3.3 Allosomal Aberrations
2.3.4 Mosaicism and Chimerism
2.4 Structural Chromosomal Aberrations
2.4.1 Deletions
2.4.2 Duplications
2.4.3 Robertsonian Translocation
2.4.4 Reciprocal Translocation
2.4.5 Inversions
2.4.6 Isochromosomes and Ring Chromosomes
2.5 Causes of Chromosomal Aberrations
2.5.1 Non-disjunction
2.5.2 Robertsonian Translocation
2.5.3 Reciprocal Translocation
2.5.4 Inversions
2.6 Summary
Suggested Reading
Sample Questions
Learning Objectives
&
After reading this unit, you would be able to:
Ø explain different types of chromosomal aberrations;
Ø discuss the role of chromosomal aberrations in human disorders; and
Ø evaluate the causes and consequences of chromosomal aberrations.
2.1 INTRODUCTION
In this unit we shall discuss genetic changes at the level of the chromosomes and
their effects in humans. Almost all individuals of a species contain the same
number of chromosomes specific for that species. For example, you and I contain,
within each of our cells, a total of 46 chromosomes which is specific for Homo
sapiens. However, there are individuals who show variations from this normal
complement. These variations could be changes in number of chromosomes or
structural changes within and among chromosomes – together such changes are
called chromosomal aberrations.
The genetic component of an organism regulates its development and interaction
with the environment. Thus, any change in this genetic component leads to 21
Human Cytogenetics variation in phenotypic characters. Depending on the extent of the aberration,
these effects can range from being lethal to being harmless variations. We shall
discuss the different types of aberrations, their phenotypic effects, the causes of
such aberrations, and their roles in human disorders.
Numerical Structural
Structural aberrations are those that involve a change in the chromosome structure.
These include deletions, duplications and rearrangements (inversions and
translocations). Structural changes occur when chromosomes break and later
rejoin in combinations that are different from the original. When there is a net
loss or gain or chromosomal segments, the change is called an unbalanced
structural change. When there is no net loss or gain of chromosomal segments,
instead there is only a rearrangement; it is called a balanced structural change
(Figure 2.2). Thus, balanced changes usually do not show any abnormal
phenotypes, which unbalanced changes do. You should keep in mind that these
changes are not mutations in genes; they only cause the number and order of
genes to be changed.
As with aneuploidy changes, structural changes are also seen in humans, and
manifest in disorders such as Cri-du-chat syndrome, Wolf-Hirschhorn syndrome,
Prader-Willi syndrome and Angelman syndrome. We shall discuss each of these
changes and their effects later in the unit.
23
Human Cytogenetics
2.3 ANEUPLOIDY CHANGES IN HUMANS
As was discussed previously, aneuploidy conditions are non-lethal and result in
abnormal phenotypes described as syndromes. The effects of aneuploidy changes
differ significantly depending on the type of chromosome involved. For example,
changes in chromosomes involved in sex determination (allosomes) results in
changes in the primary and secondary sexual characters of that individual, whereas
changes in other chromosomes (autosomes) do not. As you can see, there are
various factors that affect the phenotypic manifestations of chromosomal
disorders. We shall now look at the different aneuploidy conditions in humans
and their clinical manifestations.
Down Syndrome
Down syndrome was one of the first reported chromosomal abnormalities in
humans. It was described as Mongolian Idiocy by John Langdon Down in 1866.
It wasn’t until 1959 that it was shown to be caused by the presence of an extra
chromosome 21, resulting in an increase of number of chromosomes to 47
(karyotype 47, XX / XY, +21). Thus, this disorder is also known as trisomy 21 or
Down syndrome. Figure 2.3 shows the karyotype of an individual with 3 copies
of chromosome 21, or trisomy 21. With an incidence of 1 in 800 live births, this
is one of the common trisomies seen in humans. This incidence increases to 1 in
350 when the woman conceives beyond 35 years of age and to 1 in 25 when she
conceives beyond 45 years. Down syndrome is caused by trisomy 21 in almost
90% of the cases. 6% of the cases are also shown to be caused by a translocation
rather than a numerical change (see Section 2.5.2) and the other 4 % are known
to be caused by mosaicism (see Section 2.3.4).
There are many phenotypic manifestations that are typical in patients of this
syndrome. However, as in other syndromes, not all affected individuals show all
the symptoms. Any single individual usually expresses only a subset of the
manifestations. Some of the most common are:
• Flat face, round head, and typical epicanthic fold of the eyes
• Short, broad hands
• Mental retardation
• Hypotonia – poor muscle tone
• Short stature
24
• Protruding furrowed tongue Chromosomal Aberrations
Fig. 2.3: Karyotyping of the Down syndrome and the image of an affected baby (http://
www.hhmi.org/news/media/981432.gif)
The most common cause of this trisomy is the non-disjunction (see Section 2.5.1)
or the failure of separation of the chromosomes during meiotic division. Due to
this one of the gametes undergoing fertilization contains two copies of
chromosome 21 instead of the normal one copy (gametes are haploid containing
one copy of each chromosome). This non-disjunction can occur at either meiosis
I or II. Chromosomal analysis has shown that 75% of the cases are due to non-
disjunction occurring at meiosis I. When such a gamete is fertilized by a normal
gamete, it results in trisomy 21.
A
Fig. 2.4: Turner syndrome. A:Karyotype showing the absence of one sex (X) chromosome
(http://www.geneticsofpregnancy.com/images/Turner_Syndrome.jpg); B:Classical
Features (http://img.tfd.com/mk/T/X2604-T-53.png).
• Horseshoe-shaped kidney
• Inability to produce gametes - sterility
Klinefelter Syndrome
The presence of an additional X chromosome in males causes abnormal sexual
development and is described as Klinefelter syndrome. This set of characteristics
was first described by Harry Klinefelter in 1942. In 1959 it was shown to be due
to the presence of an additional X chromosome in males by the presence of barr
bodies in these males (normal males do not show barr body). The additional X
chromosome results in an increase in the total number of chromosomes to 47
(karyotype 47, XXY). It has an overall incidence of 1 in 1000 live male births.
While most patients show the XXY condition, individuals showing variations
like XXXY or XXYY have also been reported (Fig. 2.5).
A B
Fig. 2.5A: Karyotype of individual with Klinefelter Syndrome. Note the presence of two X
chromosomes along with a Y chromosome (arrow) (source: http://www.geneticsof
pregnancy.com/images/Klinefelter_Syndrome.jpg); B: Symptoms of Klinefelter
Syndrome (Source: http://img.tfd.com/mk/K/X2604-K-07.png)
Individuals with this syndrome show hypogonadism and reduced fertility. These
males do no develop masculine secondary sexual characteristics and show female-
type characteristics. Some of the clinical manifestations include:
27
Human Cytogenetics • Primary male hypogonadism
• Reduced facial, body and pubic hair
• Small and soft testes
• Slight learning difficulties
• Increased breast tissue – gynacomastia
• Long limb bones and lanky body
• Azoospermia – absence of sperm production leading to infertility
A more permanent form of chimerism can develop if cells from a different zygote
get incorporated into the developing embryo. There is an increased risk of this
during in-vitro fertilization methods. Chimeric individuals often do not show
any abnormal phenotypes, but their fertility and type of offspring would depend
on which cell line gave rise to the reproductive organs. Especially, ambiguous
28 genitalia (genitalia that look neither completely like male nor female),
hermaphroditism, and intersexuality can result if one cell line is genetically female Chromosomal Aberrations
(XX) and the other is genetically male (XY).
Fig. 2.6: Formation of multiple cell lines in mosaic individual due to non-disjunction during
mitosis
2.4.1 Deletions
A deletion refers to the loss of a segment of a chromosome. This leads to the loss
of the genes present in the missing region. A single break in the chromosome
leads to the loss of the terminal segment and is called terminal deletion (see
Figure 2.2). Intercalary deletion, however, involves two breaks in the
chromosome, loss of the segment, and rejoining of the two chromosomal parts.
Very large deletions are usually lethal because the monosomic condition of the
large number of genes of the missing fragment reaches the level of genetic
imbalance that cannot sustain life. Usually any deletion resulting in loss of more
than 2% of the genome has a lethal outcome. Microdeletions, however, are
reported and documented for specific disorders.
Cri-du-chat Syndrome
This syndrome results from a deletion on the short arm of chromosome 5. It is
also known by other names such as 5p deletion syndrome and Lejeune’s syndrome.
The disorder gets its name from the characteristic cat-like cry of affected infants.
29
Human Cytogenetics Described first by Jérôme Lejeune in 1963, this disorder has an incidence of 1 in
25,000 live births. This disorder, being autosomal, should affect males and females
in equal frequencies; but incidence is seen to be more in females by a ratio of 4:3
of females: males affected.
Fig. 2.7: Chromosome 5 pair from karyotype of individual with Cri-du-chat syndrome.
Note the deletion (arrow)
2.4.2 Duplications
Duplications, like deletions, can cause abnormal phenotypic effects. They usually
arise by errors in homologous recombination (unequal crossing-over).
Duplications have their importance not only in medical genetics, but also in
evolutionary genetics. The presence of an extra copy of the gene virtually makes
it free of selection pressure. Thus, it contributes to diversification of protein
functions resulting in families of proteins. Proteins of such families have related
functions differing in the task they are specialized for. A classic example is that
of the globin genes. Different globin proteins express during different times of
30 development, each of which is specialized to transport oxygen under those
conditions. These differences arose by gene duplications. Without digressing Chromosomal Aberrations
too much we shall now look at the clinical significance of duplications exemplified
by Charcot–Marie–Tooth disorder.
2.4.5 Inversions
An inversion is a condition wherein a segment of a chromosome is inverted.
This is caused by two breaks in the chromosome and the subsequent rejoining in
a reverse manner. This changes the order of genes on that chromosome and does
not cause any changes in the chromosome number (Figure 2.11). Depending on
the involvement of the centromere, inversion are of two types – pericentric and
paracentric.
• Pericentric inversions occur when the inverted segment that includes the
centromere. The product after inversion can differ significantly in the arm
length and thus change the type of chromosome (eg: sub-metacentric to
metacentric as shown in Figure 2.11-a).
• Paracentric inversions occur when the inverted segment does not include
the centromere. The product after inversion remains the same type as the
original except for a change in the order of genes (Figure 2.11-b)
Ring chromosomes
Ring chromosomes are formed when a chromosome losses its telomere regions
and joins back on itself end-to-end. Breaks at the terminal regions cause the
chromosome to have “sticky ends” because of loss of telomere region. These
end, thus, join with each other causing the chromosome to become circular or
‘ring-like’ (Figure 2.13). Since the two terminal fragments are lost, loss of genes
in those regions can have an effect on the phenotype. If these regions have
important genes, their consequences can be serious abnormality in the phenotype.
34
Chromosomal Aberrations
Disorders caused by ring chromosomes are not due to the ring formation itself,
but due to the deletion of the genes in terminal regions. Also, ring chromosome
are unstable during mitosis, hence the daughter cells may have lost the
chromosome altogether. This results essentially in a monosomy. As much as 5%
of Turner syndrome cases are shown to be due to ring chromosome-X. Some of
the other disorders include ring chromosome 20 syndrome where a ring formed
by one copy of chromosome 20 is associated with epilepsy; ring chromosome 14
and ring chromosome 13 syndromes are associated with mental retardation and
dysmorphic (malformation) facial features; ring chromosome 15 is associated
with mental retardation, dwarfism and microcephaly (small head).
Table 2.2 gives an overview of the types of aberrations and the origin of their
causes. It is evident that the abnormality can occur not only during gamete
formation, but also in the previous generation as well as after fertilization. Since
the time of occurrence would lead to different consequences, it is important to
analyze existing aberrations and offer effective methods for those who are at
risk. Some of these methods are explained in the following unit. If an abnormal
child is born into a family, it is strongly advised that the family should undergo
genetic counseling. Finding the cause of the abnormality and taking steps to
reduce future abnormalities is just as important as learning to deal with an affected
child.
35
Human Cytogenetics Table 2.2: Causes of different chromosomal aberrations
2.5.1 Non-disjunction
Non-disjunction is the failure of separation of the chromosomes during mitosis
or meiosis. Normal division involves the separation of the two arms (mitosis
and meiosis-II) of the chromosomes or separation of the two chromosomes
(meiosis-I) during the anaphase stage. This ensure that one copy of each is moved
to each pole and consequently each daughter cell receives one copy. When this
separation fails, both copies will move to one pole. Hence, one of the daughter
cells will now have two copies while the other has no copies of that chromosome.
Simply put, this is the basis of aneuploidy changes where there is one extra copy
present or one copy missing in the cells. Figure 2.15 shows the normal meiotic
and mitotic division and the consequences of non-disjunction at meiosis-I,
meiosis-II and mitosis anaphase stages.
• Advanced maternal age has been well correlated with an increase in the
chances of non-disjunction. This is well illustrated in the fact that incidence
of Down syndrome increases drastically as the maternal age increases. Figure
2.16 shows a graph correlating maternal age and incidence of Down
syndrome (here Down syndrome is indicative of non-disjunction). This
increase is attributed to the aging of the primary oocyte as age progresses
and a reduction of the maternal competence to identify and abort abnormal
fetuses.
36
Chromosomal Aberrations
Fig. 2.15: (A) Normal segregation during meiosis-I and II. (B) Non-disjunction occurring
at meiosis-I producing gametes that can cause trisomy. (C) Non-disjunction at
meiosis-II producing gametes that can cause monosomy and trisomy. (D) Normal
mitotic division and Non-disjunction during early zygotic mitosis that can give
rise to different cell lines leading to mosaicism.
38
Chromosomal Aberrations
Fig. 2.18: Segregation products of a balanced translocation carrier. The last three
possibilities (monosomy 21, trisomy 14, and monosomy 14) are lethal conditions.
Only trisomy 21 is compatible with survival.
You should note that although these abnormalities do not cause true trisomies or
monosomies, they give rise to conditions that are akin to true trisomies and
monosomies. This is because, as stated before, the long arms of these
chromosomes contain the bulk of the genes for that chromosome; presence of
extra copies of the long arm has the same effect as having an extra copy of the
entire chromosome.
Fig. 2.19: Deletion of genes FGHI present in only one copy) and duplication of genes QR
(present in three copies). All other genes are present in two copies which is the
normal complement.
39
Human Cytogenetics Reciprocal translocations, wherein there is a mutual exchange of segments
between two chromosomes, cause abnormal meiotic segregation. This
abnormality is due to the formation of a quadrivalent of the four chromosomes
during pairing (Figure 2.20). This structure is formed because the chromosomal
segments always pair with their homologous regions. When such a complex
structure is formed, separation of the chromosomes can happen in different ways
depending on their orientation in the spindle. Figure 2.20 shows the different
possibilities of segregation of a quadrivalent formed from reciprocally translocated
chromosomes.
Fig. 2.20: Reciprocal translocation between two chromosomes (red and blue), subsequent
quadrivalent formation, and meiotic segregation
By analyzing the segregation products you should be able to predict the condition
of the offspring from such a gamete. The first two segregation patterns produced
phenotypically normal offspring. The next two segregation patterns may produce
surviving offspring, but they will show abnormal phenotype due to the deletion-
duplication condition. Depending on the size of the del-dup segment the severity
may vary. The last two segregation patterns are usually lethal. This is due to the
del-dup segments being very large in these cases. If you recall, deletions of over
2% of the genome is incompatible with survival.
40
2.5.4 Inversions Chromosomal Aberrations
Inversions are balanced genetic rearrangements that invert segments within the
chromosome. Depending on the involvement of the centromere they are either
paracentric or pericentric (see Section 2.4.5). It is important to distinguish between
these two types because the crossover products after meiosis is different for
each.
In Section 2.5.3 you saw how a reciprocal translocation gives rise to an abnormal
complex during meiotic pairing. By the same logic, inversions too cause the
formation of “inversion loops” during meiotic pairing. Because one of the two
homologous chromosomes contains the inversion, it folds back into a loop to
allow for maximum homologous pairing (Figures 2.21 and 2.22). Crossing over
is a unique event in meiosis that causes recombination between the homologous
pair of chromosomes. When crossing over occurs in a region within an inversion
loop, it gives rise to recombinant products that contain deletion and duplication.
Look at Figures 2.21 and 2.22. You can see that the formation of the inversion
loop produces maximum homologous regions to be paired up. In pericentric
inversions the inversion loop contains the centromere and in paracentric inversion
the centromere is outside the inversion loop. Crossing over outside the inversion
loop will give rise to normal chromosomes and inversion chromosomes. A cross-
over within the inversion loop, however, produces two non-recombinants (one
normal and one inverted) and two recombinants (that contain deletion and
duplication). These recombinants will contain duplication of certain genes along
with deletion of other genes.
Fig. 2.21: Pericentric inversion and its products due to crossing over within the inversion
loop. NCO-Non cross-over; SCO-Single cross-over.
41
Human Cytogenetics
Fig. 2.22: Paracentric inversion and its products due to crossing over within the inversion
loop. NCO-Non cross-over; SCO-Single cross-over.
In pericentric inversions the deleted and duplicated segments do not involve the
centromere; hence four types of gametes will be produced. Two of these will
contain the aberrations; depending on the extent of the aberration it may or may
not be compatible with survival. In paracentric inversions the deleted and
duplicated segments involve the centromere, hence we get one dicentric
(containing two centromeres) and one acentric (containing no centromere)
chromosome as recombinants. The dicentric chromosome forms a dicentric bridge
during anaphase and thus arrests cell division (does not produce a gamete). The
acentric chromosome is lost during division and thus doesn’t produce any viable
gamete. Hence, only two types of gametes are produced from such individuals –
one normal and one containing the inversion. These offspring will have normal
phenotype because the inversion itself is a balanced rearrangement. Hence, the
inversion itself will tend to persist in the population.
2.6 SUMMARY
Chromosomal aberrations are, broadly speaking, any kind of changes in the
number and structure of chromosomes. Changes in number are classified as
numerical changes; and changes in structure and size are classified as structural
changes. Changes in ploidy level (euploidy changes) are seen only in plants and
lower organisms. Aneuploidy changes are, however, seen commonly in animals
including humans. Trisomy disorders in humans are a commonly occurring
chromosomal aberration. They cause conditions such as Down syndrome (trisomy
21), Edward syndrome (trisomy 18), and Patau syndrome (trisomy 13). Changes
in the sex chromosome constitution causes conditions such as Turner syndrome
42 (monosomy X – XO) and Klinefelter syndrome (XXY).
Numerical aberrations needn’t necessarily be present in all of the affected Chromosomal Aberrations
individuals. Cases of milder symptoms have been shown to be due to mosaicism
whereby only a subset of the individual’s cells contains the aberration. The
presence of normal cells in the individuals lessens the severity of the symptoms.
The variability of the symptoms also depends on which organ’s cells contain the
aberration. If the aberrant chromosomal genes are not normally expressed in the
organ containing cells with the aberration, no symptoms will develop. Chimerism
is similar to mosaicism differing only in the origin of the different cell lines
being from different zygotes.
Suggested Reading
Peter, J. Russel. 2006. Genetics – A Molecular Approach. 2nd Edition, Chapter
17. Delhi: Pearson Education Inc.
Daniel, L. Hartl and Elizabeth W. Jones. 2005. Genetics – Analysis of Genes and
Genomes. 6th Edition, Chapter 8. New Delhi: Jones and Bartlett Publishers Inc.
43
Human Cytogenetics Benjamin A. Pierce. 2008. Genetics – A Conceptual Approach. 3rd Edition,
Chapter 9. New York: W. H. Freeman and Company.
Epstein C. J. 1988. Mechanisms of the Effects of Aneuploidy in Mammals. Annual
Review of Genetics. 22:51
Stewart, G. D, T. J. Hassold, and D. M. Kurnit. 1988. Trisomy 21: Molecular
and Cytogenetic Studies of Non-disjunction. Advances in Human Genetics. 17:99
Sample Questions
1) What are the structural chromosomal aberrations, give a note with examples?
2) Give an account of common genetic syndromes caused by aneuploidy.
3) Describe the phenomenon of Genetic Imprinting.
4) Write short notes on Non-disjunction and translocations?
44
Chromosomal Aberrations
UNIT 3 RECENT TRENDS IN HUMAN
CYTOGENETICS
Contents
3.1 Introduction
3.2 Cell Culture Medium: Peripheral Blood Lymphocytes for Chromosome
Studies in Humans
3.3 Chromosome Banding and the Human Karyotype
3.4 Cytogenetic Approaches to Map Genes
3.5 Fluorescence in Situ Hybridization (FISH)
3.6 Advances in Molecular Cytogenetic Analysis
3.6.1 Whole Chromosome Painting and M-FISH
3.6.2 Spectral Karyotyping (SKY)
3.6.3 Comparative Genomic Hybridization (CGH)
3.6.4 Array CGH (aCGH)
3.7 Flow Karyotyping
3.8 Summary
Further Reading and References
Sample Questions
Learning Objectives
&
After reading this unit, you would be able to:
Ø define the role of cytogenetics and understand the Human Karyotype;
Ø explain the efficacy and drawbacks in conventional karyotyping;
Ø elucidate the role played by molecular biology in the evolution of Molecular
Cytogenetics;
Ø discuss in detail the principle and process of Fluorescent In Situ
Hybridization; and
Ø describe the newer methods of FISH based cytogenetic analysis and their
applications and drawbacks.
3.1 INTRODUCTION
The branch of genetics which deals with the study of the structure and function
of the cell, especially the chromosomes is known as Cytogenetics. Cytogenetic
analysis can be carried out virtually for any cell in the body. However analysis of
certain cells such as lymphocytes yield the best quality of chromosomes for study.
Generally to undertand the complete chromosomal complement, Karyotyping is
done. A Karyotype is defined as the identification of chromosomes based on
their size, centromere location and banding pattern. When the chromosomal image
is organized based on the same criteria then we get an Ideogram. The normal
45
Human Cytogenetics human karyotype is written as 46, XX for females and 46, XY for Males. The
nomenclature and correct method of denoting the karyotype, normal chromosomes
and aberrations (which have been described in Unit 2) are done in accordance to
the International Society for Chromosome Nomenclature (ISCN) guidelines.
Peripheral blood forms an ideal source for studying Human Chromosomes. This
is because it contains lymphocytes and is easily collected without much discomfort
to the subject. These types of cultures are of the primary type as whole blood is
used, the culture is finite i.e the cells are only viable for a maximum period of 72
hours after it is initiated. These cells have large nuclei and yield high quality
Metaphases for analysis. Also genetic damages if present can be easily observed
on analysis. However the drawback of using these cells is that they are mature
cells. In in vitro cultures often a mitogen be used. The function of mitogen is to
stimulate division of the lymphocytes that are under culture. One commonly and
sucessfully used mitogen is Phytohemaglutinin (PHA) an extract from the plant
Phaseolus vulgaris. During culture in order to arrest the cells at metaphase
certain mitotic spindle inhibitors like Colchicine or Methotrexate are added at
two to four hours before the termination of the culture.
RPMI 1640 has traditionally been used for the serum-free expansion of human
lymphoid cells. (RPMI- Roswell Park Memorial Institute). It has traditionally
been used for growth of Human lymphoid cells. This medium contains a great
deal of phosphate and is formulated for use in a 5% carbon dioxide atmosphere.
Generally a bicarbonate buffer is required. However several modifications are
available. pH indicator is Phenol Red.
In early work, probes were labeled with radioactive isotopes and target sequences
were identified by autoradiography. This method of labeling and detection limits
both the sensitivity of the technique and its resolution. In particular, the original
protocol only allowed the detection of tandemly repeated sequences such as the
ribosomal genes and satellite DNA. By 1981, however, investigators had
optimized the insitu protocol for use in mapping single copy mammalian
sequences, and in 1984 an improved method was developed for better resolution
of chromosome banding patterns.
Nevertheless, the technique is still not ideal because with single-copy radioactive
probes, localization of genes can not be determined within the chromosomes of
a single cell; instead, it is necessary to perform a statistical analysis of silver
grain distributions in 50-100 sets of metaphase chromosomes.
Two critical changes in the protocol now allow the detection of single-copy
sequences and their high-resolution mapping through the direct observation of
single chromosomes. The first change made is in the nature of the label with the
substitution of fluorescent tags for radioactive ones and dramatic improvement
of the physical resolution of the hybridization site. The modified in situ protocol
that utilizes fluorescent tags is referred to as FISH (fluorescent in situ
hybridization).
The second change was in the nature of the hybridization cocktail. With the
inclusion of a large excess of unlabeled total genomic DNA, it is possible to
block dispersed repetitive sequences — present in essentially every genomic
region larger than a few kilobases in length — from hybridization to their targets
throughout the genome.
The FISH method involves four steps: fixation, hybridization, washing, and
detection.
50
Types of Probes Recent Trends in Human
Cytogenetics
A probe is a stretch of DNA sequence that hybridizes with DNA/RNA based on
the complementary base pairing property. When probes developed from known
sequence of a gene hybridize with test DNA sample, it indicates the presence of
the complementary sequence or the gene in the sample tested. The different types
of probes are:
b) Repeat binding probes: These probes bind to part of the human genome
that contains certain types of repeats. Some such elements include
Centromeric, Telomeric and Alu repeat (a type of transposon) probes. These
probes are used to detect the presence of the repeats and detect centromere
related aberrations.
e) Band specific probes: Band specific probes are capable of detecting small
chromosomal segments those involved in subtle translocations with break
points. These particular probes increase the resolution typically obtained
with whole chromosome probes when identifying chromosomal
abnormalities.
The NOR probe is specific for p-arm of acrocentric chromosome, where as the
Alu probe will detect Alu repeat sequences found in primate chromosomes.
The figure shows a translocation of SRY material to the q-arm of the del(X). The
X chromosome is painted in green and the Y chromosome in red/orange. Normal
cross hybridization of the Y painting probe is seen in proximal Xq of both the
normal X chromosome and the del(X), whereas normal cross hybridization to
Xp is only seen in the normal X chromosome as these sequences are missing
from del(X). The del(X) also shows a signal at distal Xq, corresponding to
translocated Y sequences. Inset (A): SRY material (red/orange) is located at distal
Xq while X centromere is in green. Inset (B): The G- banding of del (X) and
normal X.
Advantages
1) Easy to detect structural and numerical aberrations.
2) Each chromosome can be given a different label allowing screening of the
entire genome.
Disadvantage
1) Costly to label the entire genome using probe combinations.
2) Cannot detect paracentric inversions.
Advantages
1) Highly sensitive method can detect minor changes in copy number variations
(CNVs.)
2) A screening method that can screen the entire genome for CNVs.
Disadvantages
1) Whole genome labeling is expensive.
2) Can detect only gain/ loss in the sample’s DNA but can not detect any other
56 type of aberration.
3.6.4 Array CGH (aCGH) Recent Trends in Human
Cytogenetics
DNA microarrays allow for simultaneous analysis of genes products or DNA
copy numbers for thousands of loci. These microarrays contain defined human
chromosomal segments (isolated from a chromosomal library), that have been
‘spotted’ or fixed onto a glass slide. The spotting is done in a very precise manner
such that the location of each spot as well its content is clearly known. The
microarray will contain several hundreds of such ‘spots’. Once this is complete,
then standard CGH protocol will be followed to determine gain or loss of genetic
material for all the spots on the microarray. The microarray is then incubated
with the labeled test and control DNA. The array is then washed to remove DNA
that is not bound, and the positions in the microarray with labeled DNA fragments.
The resolution that can be achieved with this type of analysis is greater than
what can be done with conventional CGH. This is because the spots on the
microarray can have a defined size. In addition to this the analysis can be done
for Single Nucletide Polymophism which can be mapped using aCGH. However,
the resolution of SNP arrays is currently limited to about 10,000 SNPs per chip.
Fig. 3.10: Schematic Representation of the Array CGH Assay and Analysis of the Results
Source: http://www.ebioservice.com/sbc_2009/images/pic_11.jpg
Advantages
1) Highly sensitive, can carry out analysis for several thousands of variants
simultaneously.
2) CNV as well as SNP analysis can be done.
Disadvantages
1) Very costly to carry out due to high cost of array production and analysis.
2) Low reproducibility of tests.
3.8 SUMMARY
Traditional banding methods like GTG banding offer cost-effective methods for
screening chromosomes for structural changes. Development of ‘Molecular
Cytogenetics” techniques have revolutionarised the analysis of Human
Chromosomes. It involves the use of modern molecular tools to study different
aspects of chromosomal alterations. These newer techniques are more sensitive
and can detect smaller changes. The discovery of Fluorescent probes have enabled
wide spread use of molecular cytogenetics in a variety of fields. Techniques such
as SKY and CGH are being used to provide valuable insight into complex
chromosomal rearrangements as well as change in the copy number of the genes
(CNVs). Such cytogenetic analysis is particularly useful in the field of prenatal
genetic diagnosis and genetic counseling. Although each technique has several
advantages the disadvantages have limited their applications. Hence a more
common practice would be to combine more than one of the methods described
above. The type of analysis show that the focus is now shifting to cost effective
high throughput chromosomal analysis that is required for genetic diagnosis and
adoption of prophylactic/preventive measures.
Sample Questions
1) What is a Karyotype?
2) Describe the medium most commonly used for Lymphocyte Culture.
59
Human Cytogenetics 3) What are the drawbacks in conventional karyotyping?
4) Describe different Chromosomal banding techniques.
5) What is FISH? What are the different types of Probes used in FISH analysis
6) What is SKY? Describe its applications, advantages and disadvantages.
7) Describe in detail the methods of CGH and aCGH.
8) What is Flow Karyotyping?
60
MANE-001
Human Genetics
Indira Gandhi
National Open University
School of Social Sciences
Block
4
HUMAN BIOCHEMICAL GENETICS
UNIT 1
Meaning, Scope and Genetic Variation 5
UNIT 2
Enzyme and Protein Diversity in Human Populations 21
UNIT 3
Inborn Errors of Metabolism 31
Expert Committee
Prof. P. Dash Sharma (Retd.) Faculty of Anthropology
Dept. of Anthropology SOSS, IGNOU
Ranchi University, Ranchi
Dr. Rashmi Sinha, Reader
Prof. P. Veerraju (Retd.) Discipline of Anthropology
Dept. of Human Genetics IGNOU, New Delhi
Andhra University Dr. P. Venkatramana
Visakhapatnam Assistant Professor
Prof. S.M.S. Chahal Discipline of Anthropology
Dept. of Human Biology IGNOU, New Delhi
Punjabi University, Patiala Dr. Rukshana Zaman
Assistant Professor
Prof. A. Papa Rao Discipline of Anthropology
Dept. of Anthropology IGNOU, New Delhi
Sri Venkateswara University
Tirupati Dr. Mitoo Das
Assistant Professor
Dr. Roli Mathur Discipline of Anthropology
Scientist ‘C’ IGNOU, New Delhi
Division of Basic Medical Sciences Dr. K. Anil Kumar
Indian Council of Medical Research Assistant Professor
New Delhi Discipline of Anthropology
Dr. Seema Kalra IGNOU, New Delhi
Assistant Professor Academic Assistance provided by
Dept. of Biochemistry Dr. N.K. Mungreiphy, Research Associate
IGNOU, New Delhi (DBT) for the Expert Committee meeting.
Programme Coordinator: Dr. Rashmi Sinha, SOSS, IGNOU, New Delhi
Course Coordinator: Dr. P. Venkatramana, SOSS, IGNOU, New Delhi
Content Editor
Prof. P. Veerraju (Retd.)
Department of Human Genetics
Andhra University, Visakhapatnam
Authors are responsible for the academic content of this course as far as the copyright issues are concerned.
Print Production
Mr. Manjit Singh
Section Officer (Pub.), SOSS, IGNOU, New Delhi
July, 2012
Indira Gandhi National Open University, 2012
ISBN-978-81-266-6136-7
All rights reserved. No part of this work may be reproduced in any form, by mimeograph or any other
means, without permission in writing from the Indira Gandhi National Open University.
Further information on Indira Gandhi National Open University courses may be obtained from the
University's office at Maidan Garhi. New Delhi-110 068.
Printed and published on behalf of the Indira Gandhi National Open University, New Delhi by the
Director, School of Social Sciences.
Laser Typeset by : Tessa Media & Computers, C-206, A.F.E.-II, Okhla, New Delhi
Printed at :
BLOCK 4 HUMAN BIOCHEMICAL
GENETICS
Human genetic variation can be normal and abnormal. The nature of normal
variation is in general more frequent while that of abnormal variation is usually
rare. Further for most of the genetic characters/diseases described in literature so
far, biochemical basis is illustrated only in some conditions. The discussion of
these conditions (normal genetic characters as well as abnormal genetic diseases/
disorders) whose biochemical basis is identified constitute the subject matter of
human biochemical genetics. Therefore the discussion on metabolic diseases
falls under the purview of abnormal variation while that of genetic characters
such as blood groups, red cell enzymes and serum proteins falls under the purview
of normal variation and again the sum total of the discussion of these two
categories of variation fall within the framework of human biochemical genetics.
Concerning the normal genetic characters such as blood groups, red cell enzymes
and serum proteins, the techniques employed to detect these types of the characters
are different. While the agglutination techniques are employed for detection of
blood group antigens present on the surface of the red blood cell, the
electrophoretic techniques are employed for detection of enzymes found within
the red cell (that is, in the cytoplasm of the cell). For identification of the serum
proteins also electrophoretic techniques are employed. That is to say while the
corpuscular or cellular part of the blood, that is, the red cell is used for the
elucidation of blood groups and red cell enzymes, the liquid portion of the blood
i.e., the plasma or serum is used for illustration of plasma/serum proteins.
Here in this Block, you will be able to enlighten yourself with human genetic
variation having biochemical basis to enable us to detect these variations in a
way to focus further on treatment aspect of the genetic diseases, having a clinical
significance.
Human Biochemical
Genetics
4
Meaning, Scope and
UNIT 1 MEANING, SCOPE AND GENETIC Genetic Variation
VARIATION
Contents
1.1 Biochemical Genetics
1.1.1 History
1.1.2 Garrod’s Inborn Errors of Metabolism (IEM)
1.1.3 Beadle and Tautum – Genetic Analysis Led to the One-Gene-One Enzyme
Hypothesis
1.1.4 Genetic Code
1.1.5 Revisiting the Question about what is a Gene?
1.2 Biochemical or Metabolic Diseases
1.2.1 Disorders of Amino Acid Metabolism
1.2.2 Disorders of Branched Chain Amino Acid Metabolism
1.2.3 Urea Cycle Disorders
1.2.4 Disorders of Carbohydrate Metabolism
1.2.5 Disorders of Steroid Metabolism
1.2.6 Disorders of Lipid Metabolism
1.2.7 Lysosomal Storage Disorders
1.2.8 Lipid Storage Diseases
1.2.9 Disorders of Purine/Pyramidine Metabolism
1.2.10 Disorders of Copper Metabolism
1.3 Human Blood Group Substances
1.3.1 Introduction to Human Blood Groups
1.3.2 The ABO Blood Group System-History
1.3.3 ABO Blood Groups Substances
1.3.4 Antigens and Antibodies
1.4 Summary
Suggested Reading
Sample Questions
Learning Objectives
&
Once you have studied this unit, you will be able to:
Ø know about introduction to human bio-chemical genetics;
Ø describe one gene one polypeptide concept;
Ø depict Inborn errors of metabolism with typical examples; and
Ø elucidate human ABO blood group system and its fundamentals.
5
Human Biochemical 1.1.1 History
Genetics
Gregor Mendel (1822 – 1884) (Fig. 1.1) is well known as the founder of modern
genetics. He conducted breeding experiments from 1856 to 1863 and presented
his results in 1865. Using the different varieties of pea plants interms of the
flower colour, the seed coat type and many such simple characteristics carefully
chosen as the varieties, he analysed the pattern of transmission of these traits in
subsequent generations. This led to the discovery of principles of heredity which
is now known as Mendelian Inheritance in his honour.
The impact of this research, appeared to be initially minimal and no one realized
that Mendel has discovered the basic principles of inheritance. Unfortunately,
the work remained dormant for nearly 44 years.
In 1900, three botanists Hugo de Vries, Erich von Tschermark, and Karl Correns
did similar experiments with plants and arrived at conclusions similar to those
of Mendel.
Garrod’s analysis did not stop with the concept of metabolic blocks, however.
The brilliance of his proposal lay in the genetic connection that he and population
geneticist William Bateson were able to make. Garrod noted that alkaptonuria
tended to occur in several sibs of a family whose parents were unaffected and
also that many affected children were the offspring of first-cousin marriages.
This pattern of inheritance fit the requirements for a rare recessive trait, the first
human application of Mendel’s newly discovered laws.
Garrod classified Alkaptonuria and three other conditions that he called as Inborn
Errors of Metabolism. The four canonical inborn errors described by Garrod are
Albinism, Alkaptonuria, Cystinuria and Pentosuria. He suggested that these four
genetic conditions must represent only a tiny fraction of the errors of metabolism
that exist in human populations, pointing out that many of them may produce no
obvious externally manifesting phenotypic effects.
Archibald Garrod (Fig. 1.2) served from 1915 to 1919 as a colonel in the British
Army Medical Services in Malta. Then although Garrod’s medical career was
extremely successful and distinguished, his pioneering insights into the nature
of metabolic disorders and the principle of biochemical individuality was not
appreciated during his life time.
In these experiments they identified new mutations that each caused a block in
the metabolic pathway for the synthesis of some needed nutrients and showed
that each of these blocks corresponded to a defective enzyme needed for one
step in the pathway. The experimental approach now called genetic analysis was
important because it solidified the link between the genetics and biochemistry.
The classic experiments of Beadle and Tautum thus showed that the relationship
is usually remarkably simple: one gene code for one enzyme. The pioneering
experiments united genetics and biochemistry, and for the “one gene one enzyme”
concept Beadle and Tautum were awarded a Nobel prize in 1958.
Fig. 1.4: Watson (left) and Crick (right) (Source: A.Barrington Brown/Science Photo
Library/Photo Researchers).
Three nucleotides are necessary to specify a single amino acid. This is the basic
unit of the genetic code. So the set of basis that encode a single amino acid is
called as a codon. Using limitations in bacteriophage Francis Crick and his
9
Human Biochemical colleagues confirmed in 1961 that the genetic code is a triplet code in which
Genetics
three nucleotides encode each amino acid in a protein. Proteins are very important
to all living processes; they are in some cases enzymes, which are the biological
catalyst and conduct the chemical reactions of the cell. In other cases proteins
are structural components of a cell like muscle, nail, lens in the eye. Some proteins
help in the function of transporting substances others help in the regulation of
vital pathways, communication between cell to cell or in defending a cell from
external threat.
Every protein is composed of amino acids, aligned end to end. Twenty common
amino acids are known to constitute different proteins. Each amino acid has a
central carbon atom bonded to an amino group (NH3+), a hydrogen atom ,a
carboxyl group (COO-)and an R (Radical) group. The Radical group differs for
each amino acid. The amino acids in proteins are joined together by peptide
bonds.
Thus it is very important for you to remember some important concepts like
1) The products of many genes are proteins whose action produce the traits
encoded by these genes. Proteins are polymers consisting of amino acids
linked by peptide bonds. The amino acid sequence of a protein is its primary
structure.
2) This structure folds to create the secondary and tertiary structures; two or
more polypeptide chains may associate to create a quaternary structure.
3) The genetic code is a triplet code in which three nucleotides encode each
amino acid in a protein.
Fig. 1.5: Genetic Code (Source: Benjamin A. Pierce Genetics: A Conceptual Approach
4th Edition 2012)
10
Because we now know that some enzymes contain polypeptide chains encoded Meaning, Scope and
Genetic Variation
by two (or occasionally more) different genes, a more accurate statement of the
principle is “one gene, one polypeptide”.
Only a few IEM are inherited in an autosomal dominant manner. This is because
the defective protein in the most inborn errors is an enzyme which is diffusible,
and there is usually sufficient residual activity in the heterozygous state for the
enzyme to function normally in most situations. If, however, the reaction catalyzed
by an enzyme, is rate limiting or the gene product is part of a multimeric complex,
the disorder can manifest in the heterozygous state, i.e., be dominantly inherited.
11
Human Biochemical
Genetics
13
Human Biochemical
Genetics
Children born with lysosomal disease are apparently normal at birth but tend to
accumulate a variety of macro molecules due to a deficiency of lysosomal
enzymes. Examples are Hurler Syndrome, Hunter Syndrome, Sanfilippo
Syndrome, Morquio syndrome, all put together known as Mucopolysaccharidoses
(MPS).
14
Meaning, Scope and
Genetic Variation
15
Human Biochemical
Genetics
Karl Landsteiner was born June 14, 1868 in Vienna, Austria. In 1897 he pursued
his interest in the emerging field of immunology and in 1901 published his
discovery of the human ABO blood group system. He won the 1930 Nobel Prize
for Physiology or Medicine for his discovery of the major blood groups and the
development of the ABO system of blood typing that has enabled blood
transfusions.
Due to less developed communication system in those days, it was subsequently
found that Czech serologist Jan Jansky had also independently pioneered the
classification of human blood into four groups, although his name is not so much
talked about, except in Russia and former states of USSR around that time in
America, Moss published a similar work on blood group in 1910, from USA.
17
Human Biochemical Ludwik Hirszfeld and von Dungern discovered the heritability of ABO blood
Genetics
groups in 1910–11. Felix Bernstein earns the credit for studying the blood group
inheritance pattern to be due to, multiple alleles at one locus in 1924.
Published literature states that the ABH substances are all attached to
glycosphingolipids – a long polylactosamine chain that contains the major portion
of the ABH substances attached to it.
Later, Yamamoto’s group showed the precise glycosyl transferase designates the
A, B and O epitopes. Epitope is the antigenic determinant on an antigen to which
the paratope (the specific site in the immunoglobulin) on an antibody binds.
Fig. 1.17: Diagram showing the carbohydrate chains that determine the ABO blood group
(Source: http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/ABO_blood_group_system)
The genetic basis of the ABO blood group system is an example of multiple
alleles. There are three alleles, A, B, and O, at the ABO locus on chromosome 9.
The expression of the O allele is recessive to that of A and B, which are said to
be co-dominant. Thus, the genotypes AO and AA express blood type A, BO and
BB express blood type B, AB expresses blood type AB, and OO expresses blood
type O. In the past, ABO blood group typing was used extensively both in forensic
cases as well as for paternity testing.
18
Meaning, Scope and
Genetic Variation
Fig. 1.18: ABO blood group antigens present on red bllod cells and IgM antibodies present
in the serum (Source: http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/ABO_blood_group_system)
The ABO blood group system is an important blood group system to be considered
during human blood transfusion. The associated anti-A antibodies and anti-B
antibodies are usually IgM antibodies, which are usually produced in the first
years of life by sensitization to environmental substances such as food, bacteria,
and viruses. ABO blood types are also present in apes such as chimpanzees,
bonobos, and gorillas.
Thus ABO group substances are distinct, genetically determined group of human
erythrocyte antigens represented by two blood factors (A and B) and four blood
types (A, B, AB, and O).
1.4 SUMMARY
The scope for Genetics is amazing and most of the sub disciplines emerged as
the understanding of Genetics nurtured the development of the science. Human
biochemical genetics was the first ideal model to pave way for this development.
Improvements in genetic technologies have helped us now stand on a platform
where we have a detailed knowledge of the human genome and its variations.
Suggested Reading
Benjamin, A. Pierce. 2008. Genetics: A Conceptual Approach. 3rd Edition W.H.
Freeman & Company.
Elaine Johansen Mange and Arthur P.Mange. 1999. Basic Human Genetics. 2nd
Edition. Sunderland Publishers.
Mandal, S. 2002. Fundamentals of Human Genetics. 2nd Edition. New Central
Book Agency.
Peter, D Turnpenny and SianEllard. 2007. Emery’s Elements of Medical Genetics.
13th Edition. Elsevier Publications.
Robert, C. King and William D. StansField. 2002. A Dictionary of Genetics. 6th
Edition. Oxford University Press.
Scriver, CR. 2001. Work, the clinician-scientist and human biochemical genetics.
Clin Invest Med, Vol. 24, No. 4.
Thomas, D.Gelehrter and Francis S.Collins. 1999. Principles of Medical Genetics.
3rd Edition. Williams and Wilkins.
Sample Questions
1) Describe with example some classic examples of inborn errors of metabolism.
2) Discuss the concept of gene in the light of Beadle and Tautum’s work.
3) Define the basis of human ABO blood group systems.
20
Meaning, Scope and
UNIT 2 ENZYME AND PROTEIN DIVERSITY Genetic Variation
IN HUMAN POPULATIONS
Contents
2.1 Introduction
2.2 Genes and Isozymes
2.3 Genetic Variation of Red Cell (Erythrocyte) Enzymes and Serum Proteins
2.4 Haemoglobins: Normal and Abnormal Haemoglobins
2.5 Structural Variation in Haemoglobin (Haemoglobin Variants)
2.6 Quantitative Variation in Haemoglobin (Thalassaemias)
2.7 Geographic Distribution of HB*S, HB*D and HB*E in Indian Populations
2.8 Summary
References
Suggested Reading
Sample Questions
Learning Objectives
&
After reading this unit, you will be able to:
Ø define genes and isozymes and explain the concept of genetic polymorphism
of red cell enzymes and proteins in man;
Ø discuss with reference to normal and abnormal haemoglobins and their
structural variation; and
Ø explain the geographical distribution of some abnormal haemoglobins in
Indian populations.
2.1 INTRODUCTION
Human beings are exceedingly diverse. They differ from one another in their
normal physical, physiological and behavioural attributes. These variations are
caused partially by differences in the environmental conditions in which they
live but more importantly they also depend on inborn (genetic) differences. Human
variation can be visible (e.g., differences in skin colour, hair colour and form
and or head shape) or invisible (biochemical differences, e.g., blood groups,
blood protein/red cell enzyme polymorphisms or DNA markers). At the beginning
of the 20th century, Landsteiner discovered ABO blood groups and Hirschfeld
and Hirschfeld (1919) suggested that these could be used to delineate biochemical
races. Blood protein haemoglobin polymorphism, including the gene for sickle
cell anaemia, was reported by the middle of the century, followed by serum
protein haptoglobin (HP) polymorphism in mid-1950’s and by mid-1970’s most
red cell enzyme and blood protein polymorphisms were discovered.
Anthropologists had studied these genetic markers with the primary aim of
documenting genetic differences among various populations inhabiting different
parts of the world and also for human racial classifications. Thus the existence
of Mendelian genetic traits, demonstrated from human blood in the 20th century,
21
Human Biochemical provided important powerful tools for investigation of biological variation in
Genetics
humans along with traditional anthropometric/morphological and dermatoglyphic
traits, among others.
The term isozyme was coined by Hunter and Markert (1957) who defined
isozymes as different variants of the same enzyme having identical functions or
present in the different individuals. In fact, isozymes refer to the existence of
different molecular forms of an enzyme that catalyze the same biochemical
reaction but which differ in their electrophoretic properties. The existence of
isozymes permits the fine-tuning of metabolism to meet the particular needs of a
given tissue or developmental stage.
The charged side chains are responsible for the movement of the proteins or
enzymes through a gel matrix during electrophoresis. In an electric field, the
anions (i.e. negatively charged molecules) migrate towards the anode (i.e. positive
electrode), and the cations (i.e. positively charged molecules) migrate towards
the cathode (i.e. negative electrode). The speed of migration is primarily related
to net charge on the protein or enzyme molecule and the electrical field strength
applied through the electrodes. Thus proteins/enzymes, the main products of
genes, move in an electric field with mobility that depends on their chemical
structure. The amino acid sequences of proteins are changed by mutations in the
encoding DNA locus. Such mutations may alter shape and net charge and
electrophoresis aims to reveal as many of these changes as possible.
In red cell enzyme adenosine deaminase system, the average frequency of ADA*2
is 0.118 in various populations of India, varying from 0.015 in Jalari of Andhra
Pradesh to 0.5 in Muslims and Kacharis of Assam. However, most of the Indian
populations fall in a range of 0.015 – 0.214 for this allele. The frequency of the
allele is quite low in the populations with Mongoloid ethnicity inhabiting
Himalayas (0.087), followed by the peninsular populations of South India with
Australoid (Pre-Dravidian) and Caucasoid (Dravidian) racial affinities compared
to people of Indus-Ganga-Brahmaputra plains of North India with Caucasoid
(Aryan) affinities (0.151).
Haemoglobin S (HBS)
One of the most interesting and widespread abnormal human haemoglobin, first
described by Pauling et al. (1949), is designated haemoglobin S (HBS)(αA2βS2),
more specifically, αA2β26Glu?Val. The notation signifies that HBS differs from its
normal counterpart HBA by a single amino acid substitution i.e. valine replaces
glutamic acid at position six in the β polypeptide chain (Ingram, 1957). It may
be noted that the mutation has only affected the β chain while the α chain is
normal. Haemoglobin S may be separated from haemoglobin A by electrophoresis
or by performing sickling test on fresh blood. Individuals who have one sickle
mutant gene and one normal beta gene i.e. heterozygote (HBAS) are referred as
sickle cell trait, which is benign. The sickling of red cells of homozygote (HBSS)
is more severe than that of heterozygote (HBAS). Haemoglobin S is also known
to occur in combination with other abnormal haemoglobins, for example, sickle
cell HBC (HBS/HBC), sickle cell HBD (HBS/HBD), sickle cell HBE (HBS/
HBE) and sickle cell thalassaemia (HBS/HBTh), among others.
Sickle cell trait occurs with highest frequency in tropical Africa (0.1-0.4), with
high frequency in India, Greece and Southern Turkey (0.05-0.1) and less than
0.1 frequency in populations inhabiting Palestine, Tunisia, Algeria and Sicily,
situated around the Mediterranean Sea.
Haemoglobin D (HBD)
Like HBS, HBD (also known as HBD-Punjab) is a β chain variant of haemoglobin
in which glutamine replaces glutamic acid at position 121 in the β polypeptide
chain (αA2β2121Glu?Gln). Both homozygote (HBDD) and heterozygote (HBAD)
phenotypes have been reported among individuals with reasonable health.
Haemoglobin D occurs mainly in North-West India, Pakistan and Iran. The
electrophoretic mobility of HBAD is identical to that of HBAS at alkaline pH in
cellulose acetate, but to distinguish these variants separation may be carried out
in agarose gel using a different buffer system.
Haemoglobin E (HBE)
Like HBS and HBD, HBE is also an abnormal haemoglobin with a single
point mutation in the β polypeptide chain i.e. at position 26 in the chain there is
a change of one amino acid from glutamic acid to lysine (αA2β226Glu?Lys). The
mutation is estimated to have arisen within the last 5,000 years resulting in the
second most common variant of normal haemoglobin in the world. Persons with
homozygote haemoglobin E (HBEE) have a mild haemolytic anaemia and mild
splenomegaly; heterozygote haemoglobin E (HBAE) is benign. Haemoglobin E
27
Human Biochemical is extremely common in Southeast Asia (Thailand, Myanmar, Cambodia and
Genetics
Laos, among others) where its prevalence can reach 30-40% and in some areas
equals haemoglobin A frequency. In Thailand the mutation can reach a frequency
as high as 50-70%. In India, this abnormal haemoglobin is most prevalent
in North-East region, where in certain areas carrier (HBAE) incidence reaches
as high as 60% of the population.
Thalassaemia (thalassa - the Greek word for the sea), appears in two clinical
states – thalassaemia major and thalassaemia minor. The former, also known as
Cooley’s anaemia or Mediterranean anaemia, is a severe haemolytic anaemia
and afflicted individuals cannot survive unless they receive blood transfusions
regularly or undergo bone marrow transplantation. Thalassaemia major is a clinical
entity found in individuals homozygous for α or β chain defect i.e. HBαTh/HBαTh
or HBβTh/HB βTh, where Th denotes thalassaemia. Thalassaemia minor occurs in
individuals heterozygous for either α or β chain defect i.e. HBαN/HBαTh or HBβN/
HB βTh, where N denotes normal production of α or β chain.
28
Enzyme and Protein
2.7 GEOGRAPHIC DISTRIBUTION OF HB*S, Diversity in Human
Populations
HB*D AND HB*E IN INDIAN POPULATIONS
HB*S
It is the most common variant haemoglobin allele in India and is present mostly
in South, West and Central India which inhabit sizeable autochthonous tribal
population of the country. The allele has not been reported from North India,
except in Chandigarh with a frequency of 0.011. HB*S shows polymorphic
proportions in the states of Karnataka (0.082), Andhra Pradesh (0.038), Tamil
Nadu (0.047), Kerala (0.045), Gujarat (0.065), Maharashtra (0.023), Dadra and
Nagar Haveli (0.08) and Madhya Pradesh (0.061). The incidence of the allele for
entire India has been estimated to be 0.031 (Bhasin et al., 1994).
HB*D
Though a distinct characteristic of populations originating from North-West
border Indian state of Punjab, this variant allele of haemoglobin occurs
sporadically almost all over North India. Bird et al. (1956) found 5 out of 279
Sikh subjects and one out of 13 Punjabi Hindu subjects to carry haemoglobin D.
Five of these had haemoglobins A and D in heterozygous form (HBAD) and one
had homozygous haemoglobin D (HBDD), giving a value 2.05% for haemoglobin
D variants and a frequency of 0.012 for HB*D in Punjab. The authors concluded
“It is clear, however, that haemoglobin D, though not common, is something
more than a sporadic mutant as had been suspected when it had been found only
in one Sikh” (Bird et al., 1955). In addition, this variant haemoglobin has also
been reported in Audich Brahmin of Gujarat in 2 out of 200 subjects, giving a
value of 1% for HBD variant and a frequency of 0.05 for HB*D (Parikh et al.,
1969).
HB*E
It is the second most common variant haemoglobin allele present in people of
India. But the distribution of the allele in the country is essentially limited to
East India, where it has been reported with a frequency of 0.303 in Assam, 0.066
in Manipur, 0.363 in Meghalaya, 0.006 in Sikkim and 0.007 in West Bengal; the
allele being polymorphic in the former three states. Thus, in general, HB*E is
confined to people of East India, particularly the Eastern Himalayan populations
with Mongoloid affinities. The allele is totally absent from West, Central and
South India and from North India there is a solitary report from Uttar Pradesh.
Like any other tropical country of the world, India is a “great reservoir for
abnormal haemoglobins” (Saha and Banerjee, 1971) and therefore further studies
are desirable to find out the true incidence of haemoglobin variants in this mega
diversity country. Needless to mention electrophoresis is essentially the technique
of choice for such investigations.
2.8 SUMMARY
Isozymes refer to the existence of different molecular forms of an enzyme that
catalyze the same biochemical reaction but which differ in their electrophoretic
properties. Electrophoretic investigations have led to the discovery of a large
number of structurally variant forms of enzymes/proteins attributable to specific
29
Human Biochemical gene mutations. The first example of electrophoretically detectable biochemical
Genetics
variation in humans was that of the well-known blood protein haemoglobin (HB),
followed by polymorphisms of serum proteins HP, TF, GC, C3 and BF, and red
cell enzymes ACP1, PGM1, AK1, ADA, GPI, ESD and GLO1, among others.
The term haemoglobinopathies comprises a group of hereditary abnormalities in
which either (a) the haemoglobin structure is altered (e.g. HBS, HBD, HBE) or
(b) there is a defect in globin chain synthesis of one of the normal haemoglobin
chains (α, or β) resulting, respectively, in α or β thalassaemia. Most variant
haemoglobins are products of point mutations and their detection is dependent
on a difference in their altered electrophoretic mobility. HB*S is the most common
variant haemoglobin allele in India, followed by HB*E and HB*D.
References
Bhasin, M. K., Walter, H. and Danker-Hopfe, H. 1992. The Distribution of
Genetical, Morphological and Behavioral Traits among the Peoples of Indian
Region. Delhi: Kamla-Raj Enterprises.
Chahal, S. M. S., Singh, P., Singh, H., Bansal, R. and Bansal, I. J. S. 2008.
Genetic variation and structure of the people of Uttarakhand, Central Himalayas,
India. Hum. Biol., 80: 409-434.
Pauling, L., Itano, H. A., Singer, S. J. and Wells, I. C. 1949. Sickle cell anaemia,
a molecular disease. Science, 110: 543-548.
Shaw, C. R. 1969. Isozymes: classification, frequency, and significance. Int. Rev.
Cytol., 25:297-332.
Suggested Readings
Bhasin, M. K., Walter, H. and Danker-Hopfe, H. 1994. People of India: An
Investigation of Biological Variability in Ecological, Ethno-economic and
Linguistic Groups. Delhi: Kamla-Raj Enterprises.
Cavalli-Sforza, L. L. and Bodmer, W. F. 1971. The Genetics of Human
Populations. San Francisco: Freeman.
Giblett, E. R. 1969. Genetic Markers in Human Blood. Oxford: Blackwell
Scientific Publications.
Harris, H. 1977. The Principles of Human Biochemical Genetics. Amsterdam:
Elsevier / North-Holland.
Mourant, A. E., Kopec, A. C. and Domaniewska-Sobczak, K. 1976. The
Distribution of the Human Blood Groups and Other Polymorphisms. London:
Oxford University Press.
Sample Questions
1) List different serum protein and red cell enzyme polymorphisms discovered
in man. What are the uses of these genetic markers in anthropology?
2) What are normal and abnormal haemoglobins and what techniques are used
to study them?
3) Discuss the two major components of haemoglobinopathies in man.
4) Give an account of the distribution of variant haemoglobin alleles in Indian
30
populations.
Enzyme and Protein
UNIT 3 INBORN ERRORS OF METABOLISM Diversity in Human
Populations
Contents
3.1 Introduction
3.2 Inborn Errors of Metabolism: Genesis
3.3 Inborn Errors of Metabolism in Man
3.3.1 Phenylketonuria
3.3.2 Alkaptonuria
3.3.3 Galactosemia and Galactosuria
3.3.4 Disorders of Lipid Metabolism: Familial Hypercholesterolemia
3.4 Summary
Suggested Reading
Sample Questions
Learning Objectives
&
After reading this unit, you will be able to:
Ø define and explain with regard to metabolism;
Ø discuss inborn errors of metabolism; and
Ø discuss the examples for inborn errors of metabolism such as Phenylketonuria,
Alkaptonuria, Galactosemia & Galactosuria; and Hypercholesterolemia.
3.1 INTRODUCTION
Metabolism broadly refers to the sum total of all the chemical changes occurring
in a cell, a tissue or the body, and these chemical changes are performed through
organized multistep pathways involving a number of enzymes, proteins and bio-
chemical ingredients. There are several pathways or cycles that intersect with
each other forming a cohesive co-ordinated network of chemical reactions. The
sum total of chemical reactions performed through different pathways can be
classified as either Catabolic (degradative) or Anabolic (Synthetic). The breaking
down of complex molecules such as proteins, polysaccharides and lipids etc. to
simple molecules such as Co2, NH3 (ammonia) and water is the example of
catabolic reaction. The synthetic or anabolic path way refers to the chain of events
that lead to the formation of complex products from simple precursors; for
example the synthesis of polysaccharide, glycogen from glucose. Investigation
of metabolism involves elucidation of complex path ways. Each path way is
characterized by action of multienzyme sequences, and each enzyme, in turn,
may display important catalytic or regulatory features. As far as Catabolism is
concerned, the degradation of complex molecules occurs in three stages and
Adenosine Triphosphate (ATP) is released as chemical energy as a degradation
of energy-rich molecules. Three stages of Catabolism are: a) Hydrolysis of
Complex molecules; b) Conversion of building blocks to simple intermediates
c) Oxidation of acetyl CoA. Anabolism refers to the process of formation of
complex molecules such as protein, polysaccharides, lipids, nucleic acids from
small molecules such as amino acids, sugars, fatty acids, nitrogenous bases etc.
31
Human Biochemical Anabolic reactions require energy, which is generally provided by the breaking
Genetics
down of ATP to ADP and Pi. The figure 3.1 given below demonstrates a
comparison of catabolic and anabolic pathways.
Fig. 3.1: Enzymatic pathways of metabolism of amino acids in Humans (Courtesy : Champe,
P.C, Harvey, R.A and Ferrier, D.R (Ed). 2005. Biochemistry).
Garrod’s work gave a strong ground in favour of the concept of one gene-one
enzyme hypothesis, which was established in the 1940s and 1950s by the
pioneering work of Beadle and Tatum, who were awarded Nobel Prize.
Fig. 3.2: Enzymatic steps in the catabolism of phenylalanine and tyrosine to aceto-acetic
acid (Courtesy: Gelehrter, T.D and Collins, F.S. 1998. Principles of Medical
Genetics).
The enzyme Homogentisate Oxidase is primarily active in the liver and kidney.
It is chiefly responsible for breaking down the amino acid phenylalanine and
tyrosine, into a molecule called homogentisic acid. Homogentisic acid oxidase
adds two oxygen atoms to homogentisic acid converting homogentisic acid into
another molecule called Maleylacetic acetate.
More than 40 mutations in HGD gene have been detected in people with
Alkaptonuria. The substitution of the amino acid valine for methionine at position
368 is the most common form of HDG mutation in European population. The
mutation in this gene inactivates the enzyme. Without HGD normal gene
functioning, the enzyme homogentisic oxidase become ineffective accounting
for building up homogentisic acid in the body. The gene for Alkaptonuria is
inherited as autosomal recessive trait. The person with Alkaptonuria inherits
both copies of the recessive genes from parents who are heterozygotes for
Alkaptonuria.
The major source of Galactose is obtained from lactose – the principal source of
milk and milk products. However, some amount of galactose can be obtained by
lysosomal degradation of complex carbohydrates such as glycoproteins, and
glycolipids – the membrane components of tissues.
a) Phosphorylation of Galactose
b) Formation of UDP-galactose
38
The figure 3.6 showing metabolism of galactose is given below: Inborn Errors of
Metabolism
Fig 3.6: Metabolism of Galactose (Courtecy: Champe, P.C, Harvey, R.A and Ferrier, D.R
(Ed). 2005. Biochemistry)
Fig. 3.7: The process of receptor mediated endocytosis (Courtesy: Jorde, L.B, Carrey,
J.C, Bamshad, J.C and White, R.L. 2000. Medical Genetics, 2nd edition).
In case of homozygotes (cholesterol levels raising from 600 to 1200 mg/dl) the
distinctive cholesterol deposits in the skin and tendons called xanthomas occur.
3.4 SUMMARY
The present unit describes few examples of inborn errors of metabolism in man
such as phenylketonuria, alkaptonuria, galactosuria, and hypercholesterolemia
with reference to biochemical and genetic aspects. These topics constitute the
central theme of one important area of human biochemical genetics, covering
the abnormal aspect of human genetic variation. The study of these metabolic
diseases focuses on early diagnosis as well as treatment, aspects which are also
important from clinical point of view.
40
Suggested Reading Inborn Errors of
Metabolism
Champe, P.C, Harvey, R.A and Ferrier, D.R (Ed). 2005. Biochemistry, 3rd edition.
MD: Lippincott Williams & Wilkins.
Gelehrter, T.D and Collins, F.S. 1998. Principles of Medical Genetics, Second
edition, USA:Williams and Wilkins Co.
Jorde, L.B, Carrey, J.C, Bamshad, J.C and White, R.L. 2000. Medical Genetics,
2nd edition, St Louis: Mosby.
Vogel, F. and Motulsky, A.G. 1996. Human Genetics: Problems and Approaches,
Berlin: Springer.
Sample Questions
1) Discuss on example of error of amino acid metabolism. Can you treat it by
any means?
2) Give a brief note on an example of error of lipid metabolism leading to heart
disease.
3) What is the difference between galactosaemia and galactosuria? Comment
4) Write a note on the first metabolic disorders described by Garrod?
41
MANE-001
Human Genetics
Indira Gandhi
National Open University
School of Social Sciences
Block
6
APPLIED AND EMERGING TRENDS IN HUMAN
GENETICS
UNIT 1
Introduction to New and Emerging Areas in Human
Genetics 5
UNIT 2
Genetic Epidemiology and Epigenetics 26
UNIT 3
Prevention of Genetic Diseases 39
UNIT 4
Genetics and Human Issues 48
Expert Committee
Prof. P. Dash Sharma (Retd.) Faculty of Anthropology
Dept. of Anthropology SOSS, IGNOU
Ranchi University, Ranchi
Dr. Rashmi Sinha, Reader
Prof. P. Veerraju (Retd.) Discipline of Anthropology
Dept. of Human Genetics IGNOU, New Delhi
Andhra University Dr. P. Venkatramana
Visakhapatnam Assistant Professor
Prof. S.M.S. Chahal Discipline of Anthropology
Dept. of Human Biology IGNOU, New Delhi
Punjabi University, Patiala Dr. Rukshana Zaman
Assistant Professor
Prof. A. Papa Rao Discipline of Anthropology
Dept. of Anthropology IGNOU, New Delhi
Sri Venkateswara University
Tirupati Dr. Mitoo Das
Assistant Professor
Dr. Roli Mathur Discipline of Anthropology
Scientist ‘C’ IGNOU, New Delhi
Division of Basic Medical Sciences Dr. K. Anil Kumar
Indian Council of Medical Research Assistant Professor
New Delhi Discipline of Anthropology
Dr. Seema Kalra IGNOU, New Delhi
Assistant Professor Academic Assistance provided by
Dept. of Biochemistry Dr. N.K. Mungreiphy, Research Associate
IGNOU, New Delhi (DBT) for the Expert Committee meeting
Programme Coordinator: Dr. Rashmi Sinha, SOSS, IGNOU, New Delhi
Course Coordinator: Dr. P. Venkatramana, SOSS, IGNOU, New Delhi
Content Editor
Prof. P. Veerraju (Retd.)
Department of Human Genetics
Andhra University, Visakhapatnam
Print Production
Mr. Manjit Singh
Section Officer (Pub.), SOSS, IGNOU, New Delhi
November, 2012
Indira Gandhi National Open University, 2012
ISBN-978-81-266-
All rights reserved. No part of this work may be reproduced in any form, by mimeograph or any other
means, without permission in writing from the Indira Gandhi National Open University.
Further information on Indira Gandhi National Open University courses may be obtained from the
University's office at Maidan Garhi. New Delhi-110 068.
Printed and published on behalf of the Indira Gandhi National Open University, New Delhi by the
Director, School of Social Sciences.
Laser Typeset by : Tessa Media & Computers, C-206, A.F.E.-II, Okhla, New Delhi
Printed at :
BLOCK 6 APPLIED AND EMERGING
TRENDS IN HUMAN GENETICS
Further stem cell research has made a great impact on the applied value of genetics.
Various types of stem cells have been characterised and the applications of these
cells vary from an in vitro model to therapeutic tool.
4
Introduction to New and
UNIT 1 INTRODUCTION TO NEW AND Emerging Areas in Human
Genetics
EMERGING AREAS IN HUMAN
GENETICS
Contents
1.1 Introduction
1.2 Proteomics
1.3 Bioinformatics
1.4 Pharmacogenomics
1.5 Stem Cell Research
1.6 Summary
Suggested Reading
Sample Questions
Learning Objectives
&
After reading this unit, you will be able to:
Ø appreciate the definition, importance, summary of proteins and their
functions, subfields, tools, applications and challenges of proteomics;
Ø describe scope, historical development, tools, biological databases, applications
and challenges of bioinformatics;
Ø gain insight on scope, classic examples, evolutionary aspects, approaches,
in vitro and in vivo models, applications and challenges of pharmacogenomics;
and
Ø discuss scope and evolution of stem cell research, types of stem cells, applications
and challenges of stem cell research.
1.1 INTRODUCTION
Like any discipline human genetics is growing by leaps and bounds with the
advancement of science and technologies for the noble mission of human welfare
and enhancement of quality of life of the people.
There is a difference of about 0.1% in the DNA sequences of any two individuals.
This variation often resulted in variation in drug response. Studying at genome
level for characteristic genetic variants responsible for variation in response to
drugs has resulted in the birth of pharmacogenomics. Lack of adequate knowledge
of genotype characteristics that contribute to adverse reactions to various drugs
is also increasing patient-care costs. Genotype guided management of diseases
holds great promise.
1.2 PROTEOMICS
The term ‘Proteome’ was coined by Marc Wilkins in 1994. This term is a linguistic
equivalent to genome and deals with large scale analysis of the complete, or at
least the major, set of proteins. The Proteome can be defined in terms of the
sequence, structure, abundance, localisation, modification, interaction and
biochemical function of its components.
Importance of proteomics
1) Genes are instruction carriers, while the proteins are the functional molecules
of the cells and a true understanding of them can come from the direct study
of proteins.
2) Unlike the genome whose content with few exceptions remain the same
irrespective of cell type or environmental conditions, the proteome is dynamic
whose content varies under different conditions due to the regulation of
transcription, RNA processing, protein synthesis and protein modification.
Study of the proteome can provide the glimpse of the cell in action.
6
3) A good understanding on the structure and function of a protein may provide Introduction to New and
Emerging Areas in Human
clues to introduce mutations in order to better understand their function. Genetics
4) Transcriptome may not represent the true insight on proteome, because not
all mRNA in the cell are translated and rates of protein synthesis and protein
turnover may vary among transcripts.
5) Difference in the stability of mRNA and efficiencies in translation can affect
the generation of new proteins. Some transcripts may give rise to multiple
proteins. For instance, 22 different forms of alpha-1-antitrypsin were
observed in plasma. The individual functions of these proteins can be studied
at the protein level only.
6) In certain body fluids like serum, cerebrospinal fluid and urine where nucleic
acids are not represented, proteins only provide information about
determinants of disease progression. In case of degradation and cross linking
of nucleic acids in fixed biological specimens, protein may only act as a
source material for further study. In many diseases proteins are the drug
targets.
7) Proteomics attempts to bridge the gap between our understanding of genome
sequence and cellular behaviour.
c) Tertiary: This structure provides the stability of the protein. It is the three
dimensional structure. In this, hydrophobic side chains are held interior and
hydrophilic groups are seen on the surface of the protein.
Subfields of Proteomics
1) Sequence and Structural proteomics: Protein sequences allow the designing
of probes or primers which can be used to isolate the cDNA or genomic
sequence. It is the protein sequence which acts as a bridge between the activity
of a protein and the genetic basis of a particular phenotype. Increasing
deposition of protein sequences and consequent development of statistical
techniques are facilitating the comparison of proteins. Three primary sequence
databases are Genbank, EMBL (European Molecular Biology Laboratory),
DDBJ (DNA Data Bank of Japan) that provide translated protein sequences
from DNA sequences, whereas, SWISSPROT is a dedicated protein sequence
data bank.
Similar sequences may gives rise to similar structures and this idea has given
birth to new branch of proteomics known as structural proteomics which
paved the way for storage, presentation, comparison, inferring evolutionary
relationships and prediction of theoretical protein models, a boon in the
absence of crystallographic protein structures, for drug discovery research.
8
2) Expression proteomics: It is concerned with the analysis of protein Introduction to New and
Emerging Areas in Human
abundance, separation of protein mixtures, the identification of individual Genetics
components and their systematic quantitative analysis. This sub branch lays
emphasis on differences representing alternative states like health and disease
and characterisation of post-translational modifications. The key tools used
in investigations involve 2D gel electrophoresis, mass spectrometry, multi-
dimensional chromatography and protein chips.
3) Interaction proteomics: It deals with the genetic and physical interactions
among proteins as well as interactions between proteins and nucleic acids or
small molecules. Study of protein interactions not only provides insight on
the function of individual proteins but also how proteins function in pathways,
networks, and complexes. It seeks to achieve creation of proteome linkage
map based on binary interactions between individual proteins and higher
order interactions determined by the systematic analysis of protein complexes.
Interactions between proteins and nucleic acids emphasize on processes such
as gene regulation, while interaction of proteins with small molecules may
enlighten on the interaction of enzymes with substrates and receptors with
their ligands and also may play an important role in drug development process.
The key approaches used in studies of this kind of interaction are yeast, two
hybrid system, mass spectrometry, biochemical assays and X-ray
crystallography.
4) Functional Proteomics: This lays emphasis on testing protein functions on
a large scale such as testing expressed proteins for different enzymatic
activities.
Tools used in Proteomics
1) Databases: Protein Expressed sequence tag and complete genome sequence
provide information on all the expressed proteins in organisms.
3) Soft ware tools: These tools determine the sequence of a protein with the
aid of specialised algorithms and provide automated survey of large amounts
of mass spectrometry data for protein sequence matches.
Applications
1) Identification and cataloguing of proteins.
2) Identification of proteins in a sample of differentiation, developmental state,
disease state and exposed to a drug, chemical or physical stimulus.
3) Determinate how proteins interact with each other in living systems and
characterisation of proteins in more complex networks.
4) Mapping of proteins in post-translational modifications. 9
Applied and Emerging Challenges: No single technological approach is suitable for every application.
Trends in Human Genetics
Integration and automation of these approaches, using of better materials,
advancement in instrument design and methodology for improving sensitivity,
resolution and repeatability are the challenges before the proteomics community
in order to provide a comprehensive analysis of complex biological system.
1.3 BIOINFORMATICS
Bioinformatics is defined as the computational handling and processing of genetic
information. Its goal is to enable the discovery of new biological insight as well
as to create a global perspective from which unifying principles can be perceived.
It lays emphasis on organizing the data for accessing and generating information,
developing tools to analyse the data and interpret the data in a biologically
meaningful manner. In analysing the data, two approaches like data mining and
knowledge discovery are taken into consideration. These approaches involve
generating testing hypothesis regarding the function or structure of a gene or
protein of interest by homology searching. Besides deriving meaningful biological
information from the data; bioinformatics also serves the scientific community
with resources such as databases.
BLAST: It stands for basic local alignment search tool. This algorithm is used to
perform sequence similarity search. A server at NCBI was established to support
BLAST. This server is used widely for sequence database searches. An
independent set of BLAST program was developed at Washington University
known as WU-BLAST. This BLAST also performs the similarity search like
NCBI and produces gapped local alignments. The BLAST requires different
statistical methods to evaluate sequence similarity score. BLAST algorithm
increases the speed of sequence alignment by searching first for common words
or k-tuples in query sequence and each database sequence. It searches the words
that are significant. In case of proteins, the significance of word matching is
evaluated by BLOSUM 62 amino acid substitution matrix. The word length is 3
for proteins and 11 for nucleic acids in BLAST algorithm. The latest version of
BLAST is BLAST 2. It reports the gapped alignment of query and database
sequences. BLAST has filtering feature for searching low complexity regions in
query sequence (repeats of sequence character) which produces artificial high
score alignments.
There are number of variations of BLAST programs like Blastp for comparing
an amino acid query sequence against a protein sequence of a database; Blastn
for comparing a nucleotide query sequence against nucleotide sequence of a
database; Blast x for searching six frame translation product of nucleotide
sequence against a protein database; Tblastn for searching a protein sequence
against a translated nucleotide sequence of a database; and Tblastx for comparing
six frame translations of nucleotide sequence query sequence against a six frame
translations of a nucleotide sequence data base. MegaBLAST searches similar
sequences that are 300 to 100,000 bp long. A long word is used for searching and
the gap penalty is calculated from the match and mismatch scores. RPS BLAST
scans conserved domains in a protein sequence. BLASTcl3 is a network client
BLAST which is used to access the BLAST server. Standalone BLASTs are
executable versions of all the BLAST program for the operating systems
Windows, Unix and Macintosh. PSI-BLAST (Position specific iterated BLAST),
PHI BLAST (pattern hit initiated BLAST) are used to search for domains in
query protein sequence and in database sequences. BEAUTY (BLAST enhanced
alignment utility) adds additional features to the BLAST like summarizing the
locations of HSPs, PFAM domains and Prosite pattern. BLAST searching with
cobbler sequence (consensus) is used to find majority residues in multiple
sequence alignment. BLAST2 program is used to align very long sequences.
FASTA: This program is used for aligning pairs of protein and DNA sequences.
It searches for matching sequence patterns or words called k-tuples. Patterns
contain k consecutive matches of letters. It attempts to build a local alignment
on word matches. This program is used for database searches. FASTA compares
the query protein or DNA sequences to the target sequences in the database and
give the best matched sequence and local alignment of matched sequences. To
search for similarity FASTA uses hashing method in which a table of the positions
of each word of length k, or k tuple is constructed for each sequence. The position
11
Applied and Emerging of each word is calculated by subtracting the position in the first sequence from
Trends in Human Genetics
the position in the second and words having the same offset position show a
region of alignment between the two sequences. The number of comparisons
increases as the average sequence length. The k tuple length is 1or 2 for protein
and 4-6 for nucleic acid sequences in FASTA program. There are other versions
of the FASTA also reported. Among them TFASTA compares the query protein
sequence to a six frame translation of DNA sequence of the database; FASTF/
TFASTS compares a set of short peptide fragments against a protein sequence
database or a DNA sequence database translated in all six reading frames; FASTX
and FASTY translate a query DNA sequence in all three reading forwad frames
and compare all three frames to a protein sequence database; and TFASTX and
TFASTY compare a query protein sequence to a DNA sequence database,
translating each DNA sequence in all six possible reading frames.
Local MSA methods align the most similar regions in sequences. The approaches
include profile analysis which identifies highly conserved portion of the alignment
and produces a scoring matrix called a profile. A profile includes scores for
amino acid substitutions and gaps in each column of the conserved region. In
block analysis, blocks (substituted regions without gaps) are searched and used
in sequence alignments. Pattern searching or statistical methods scan a localised
region of sequence similarity in a set of sequences.
Cn3D: It allows viewing protein structure files NCBI ASN.1 format. It opens
two windows: a colour structure viewer in which a molecule can be rotated,
coloured according to different properties and rendered in different display
formats; a sequence viewer, which allows you to view sequences and alignments
corresponding to the displayed protein and to add graphics to the sequence display
to highlight the location of secondary structure features.
14
Micro array databases: Microarray is a hybridization of a nucleic acid sample Introduction to New and
Emerging Areas in Human
(target) to a very large set of oligonucleotide probes, which are attached to a Genetics
solid support, to determine sequence or to detect variations in a gene sequence
or expression or for gene mapping. Various organisations have created microarray
databases like National Center for Biotechnology Information,US-Gene
expression Omnibus, European Bioinformatics Institute -Array express and
National Institute of Genetics, Japan- Center for information biology gene
expression.The purpose of creation of these databases is to store the minimum
information about microarray experiments and to allow the researchers to repeat
the experiments.
Various factors influence the drug response like age, genetics, sex, race/ethnicity,
disease state, absorption, distribution, metabolism, excretion, body weight, height,
receptor sensitivity, organ dysfunction, accompanying medications, smoking,
diet, alcohol, stress, pollution, socio-economic status, drug adherence,
physiological changes including pregnancy, lactation, unmeasured nucleotide or
structural variation, complex methylation/epigenetic mechanisms and gene-
environment interactions. Around 30 to 60% of medication response rate for
treating many diseases like depression, schizophrenia, rheumatoid arthritis has
been observed. It has been reported that genetic factors can account 20 to 95%
variation in drug response. Patients are classified into poor, normal and rapid
metabolizers depending on the response to the drug intake. When a standard
dose is given to the poor metabolizer, the drug is metabolized slowly resulting in
an increased risk of toxicity and for the ultra metabolizer, the standard dose may
be ineffective.
Inter individual variations in drug response have been reported based on genetic
variations in drug metabolizing enzymes, receptors, transporters and pathways.
The drug metabolizing enzymes are heterogeneous group of proteins involved
in metabolism of drugs. They are two groups namely oxidative drug metabolizing
enzymes and conjugative drug metabolizing enzymes. The oxidative drug
metabolizing enzymes include cytochrome P450 and Flavin mono oxygenase;
these catalyze the introduction of an oxygen atom into substrate molecules leading
to hydroxylation or demethylation. The conjugative enzymes catalyze the coupling
of endogenous small molecules to xenobiotics that results in the formation of
soluble compounds that are more readily excreted. This enzyme family has UDP
glycosyltransferases (UGTs), glutathione transferases, sulfotransferases and N
acetyltransferases as members.
Genome wide approach: This approach does not require a prior knowledge of
the target gene. It attempts to identify the association between genetic variants
and a given disorder by directing marker SNPs and analysing differences between
case and control groups. This approach has been successful in mapping rare
highly penetrant diseases in family pedigrees and identifying genes for monogenic
traits. The strategies in this approach are based on the Linkage Disequilibrium
relationships and structuring of haplotype blocks in the genome. It requires
thousands of single nucleotide polymorphism (SNP) as genetic markers and it
has been estimated that a minimum of 300,000 to 500,000 evenly spaced SNPs
needed to find a marker within the range of disequilibrium. One of the successful
examples of genome wide approach is identification of genetic variant in the
drug transporter gene SLCO1b1 responsible for statin induced myopathy. The
success of genome wide approach depends on study design, sample size, quality
control of genotype, collection bias, individual sample data, and ability of high
throughput technologies to produce volume of data and ethnicity details.
Validating data in an independent cohort in unbiased approach is requisite. The
reported odds ratios are relatively small. The practical utility of information
generated by using this approach remains controversial. Whole genome studies
involve usage of microarrays which is out of reach of routine clinical practice.
Complexity in analysis and requirement of additional guarantees in diagnosis
make this approach far from applicable. Matching control groups to factors such
as underlying disease and ancestry, contributions of genetic variants not detected
by current platforms, analysis of gene-gene and gene-environment interactions
in determining phenotype, affordable sequencing, storing of sequence data,
information management and methods of genome analysis are the challenging
issues in this approach.
Applications of Pharmacogenomics
1) Pharmacogenomic studies are helpful in developing therapeutic agents
suitable for genetically identifiable human sub group populations.
2) Pharmacogenomics research can decrease the time and number of subjects
needed for clinical trials.
3) Pharmacogenomics may facilitate the identification of biomarkers to optimize
drug selection, dose and treatment duration and avert adverse drug reactions.
18
4) Pharmacogenomics may be helpful in reducing national health care bills in Introduction to New and
Emerging Areas in Human
developing countries by taking into consideration of genomic variations Genetics
between populations.
5) Study of the genotypes of populations with little admixture may be helpful
in predicting drug responses without testing each individual.
6) Pharmacogenomics may help to improve our understanding of the
mechanisms underlying variability in human physiology and its response to
drug therapy with a final goal of improving therapy.
7) Information generated from pharmacogenomics studies may help health
professionals and patients to make informed decisions about treatment
options.
8) Generation of data on new and existing drugs will help in effective utilisation
of scarce resources.
9) Pharmacogenomics may be helpful in reducing the costs associated with
inappropriate drug treatments or hospitalisations due to serious adverse
reactions.
10) Pharmacogenomics testing may produce collateral information which may
be medically beneficial for ex. polymorphism in dopime receptor though
pharmacogenomics information may help in smoking cessation.
11) Long term applications of pharmacogenomics include reducing the burden
of disease, improving the economic efficiency of the health care system and
reducing some disparities in health care acess and health outcomes.
12) Pharmacogenomics may be helpful in offering alternatives to the traditional
drug development.
Stem cell populations are heterogeneous. Though stem cells express specific
protein markers but accumulating evidence suggests that these markers are
transient and dynamic. Stem cells express a vast range of genes at the mRNA
levels. Stem cells undergo asymmetric mitotic division and produce two identical
daughter cells. Of the two cells, at least one cell retains the stem cell properties,
while other differentiates. This process is governed by stem cell niche (environment)
and the detachment from this niche would result in differentiation. Stem cells
may also follow stochastic differentiation, wherein stem cells make a combination
of asymmetric divisions and symmetric ones leading to the formation of either
two stem cells (symmetric renewal) or two differentiated cells (symmetric
differentiation). Stem cells in olfactory epithelium and muscle follow this kind
of cell division.
8) They can form embryoid bodies, the cell aggregations containing all three
embryonic germ layers.
9) These cells have the potential of forming teratomas in vivo.
10) These cells are considered as the optimal stem cell source for regenerative
medicine applications in view of their potential to form any tissue in the
body.
11) Application of these cells are limited by ethical, political, biologic and
regulatory hurdles.
Epiblast-stem cells (EpiSC)
1) Cells are derived from pre- gastrula embryo.
2) Express surface markers like mouse embryonic stem cells, Oct4, Nanog and
Ssea-1, and form teratoma.
3) These cells do not require feeders or leukemia inhibitory factor (Lif) for
culture but can be expanded in the presence of Activin/nodal signaling.
4) These cells are unable to contribute to somatic cells and the germ line
following injection into blastocyst or following morula aggregation.
XEN Stem cells
1) These cells are isolated from extra embryonic endoderm.
2) Express markers like Sox7, Hnf4, Gata4 and Foxa2 but lack expression of
Oct4 and Nanog.
3) In a chimera assay, these cells contributed to the parietal endoderm and to
the parietal yolk sac at later stages during embryo development.
2) They have the potential for lineage-restricted differentiation and are capable
of developing into a pancreatic phenotype.
3) The adult pancreatic stem or progenitor cells are found in duct cells, exocrine
tissue, nestin positive islet-derived progenitor cells, neurogenin-3-positive
cells, pancreas-derived multipotent precursors and mature â cells.
5) Pdx-1, nestin and Ngn-3 markers have been shown to be expressed by these
cells.
22
Cancer stem cells (CSCs) Introduction to New and
Emerging Areas in Human
1) These are small population of cancer cells that have the ability of unlimited Genetics
Applications
1) Stem cells provide an opportunity to study the growth and differentiation of
cells into tissues.
2) Stem cells can be used to produce large amounts of one cell type.
3) These cells can be to test new drugs for effectiveness and chemicals for
toxicity.
4) The damaging side effects of medical treatments might be repaired with
stem cell treatment.
5) Somatic cell nucleus transfer technique stem cells created by using patient
cell would avoid any tissue rejection problems that could be encountered in
other stem cell therapeutic approaches.
6) In view of their migratory properties these cells can be used to target organs
ex.tumours.
7) These cells can be used as vehicles to carry therapeutic molecule which they
excrete spontaneously.
8) Stem cell therapies, in future, may circumvent the traditional use of chemicals
as therapeutic drugs.
9) Stem cell transplantations are used to treat or greatly ameliorate a variety of
genetic diseases ranging from inherent defects of hematopoietic cell
production (thalassaemia) or function to metabolic diseases (lysosomal
storage diseases) mostly affecting solid organs.
10) In acute myeloid leukemia and high grade lymphoma, hematopoietic cell
therapy is used as adjuvant therapy.
11) Stem cells therapies are promising in the management of variety of disease
conditions like cardiovascular diseases, neurological diseases (parkinson’s
disease, Amyotrophic lateral sclerosis, Huntington’s diseases or Alzheimer’s
disease, Duchenne muscular dystrophy), diabetes, eye diseases and bone
diseases. 23
Applied and Emerging 12) Mesenchymal stem cells have been shown to be helpful in rapid engraftment
Trends in Human Genetics
of allogenic bone marrow transplantations. These cells were found inhibiting
T cell growth, reducing graft versus host disease and effective in a large
number of steroid resistant patients.
13) Early wound healing, delayed progression in human multiple system atrophy
and beneficial effects in patients with hemorrhagic cystitis, penmomediastium
and perforated colon due to the transplantion of mesenchymal stem cells.
14) In experimental studies entire organs were generated from stem cells and
this raises the hope of using stemcells/progenitors for tissue engineering
applications to generate organs for therapeutic purposes.
1.6 SUMMARY
The Proteome can be defined in terms of the sequence, structure, abundance,
localisation, modification, interaction and biochemical function of its components.
Proteomics has subfields like sequence and structural proteomics, expression
proteomics, interactional and functional proteomics. Various tools are used in
proteomics like databases, mass spectrometry, software tools and protein
separation technologies.
Stem cells are precursor undifferentiated cells that are characterised by self
renewal and differentiation. Stem cell populations are heterogeneous in nature.
Stem cells were classified as embryonic or adult/non-embryonic/somatic
(postnatal to adult)/extra- embryonic stem cells (adult,cancer and induced
pluripotent) or hematopoetic and non-hematopoietic (mesenchymal stem cells),
based on their origin. In terms of developmental potential, stem cells were
categorized as totipotent, multipotent and unipotent. Applicatiions of stem cells
vary from a invitro model to therapeutic tool.
Suggested Reading
Dov Zipori (ed). 2009. Biology of Stem cells and the Molecular basis of the
stem state. New York: Humana Press.
Kalow W. 2005. Pharmacogenomics: Historical perspective and status. In:
Pharmacogenomics, Methods in Molecular Biology Innocenti, F (Ed). Totowa
NJ: Humana Press Inc. Vol 311.
Krishna Rao, A and Raghu KA. 2011. Stem cells and regenerative medicine.
From molecular embryology to tissue engineering. New York: Humana Press.
Liebler, D.C. 2002. U.K.Introduction to Proteomics: Tools for the New Biology.
NewJersy: Humana Press, Totowa.
Mount, DW. 2004. Bioinformatics. Sequence and Genome Analysis. 2nd edition,
New Delhi: CBS publishers and distributors.
Ouzounis, CA, Valencia, A. 2003. Early bioinformatics: the birth of a discipline-
a personal view. Bioinformatics, 17: 2176-2190.
Richard JS, 2003. Proteins and proteomics: A Laboratory manual. New York:
cold spring harbor laboratory press.
Searls, DB. 2010. The roots of bioinformatics. PLOS Computational Biology.
6(6):e1000809.
Trifonov, EN. 2000. Earliest pages of bioinformatics. Bioinformatics, 16:5-9.
Twyman, R.M. 2004. Principles of Proteomics. Oxon: Garland Science/Bios
Scientific Publishers.
Sample Questions
1) What is bioinformatics? Mention in brief the important sequence analysis tools.
2) What are the different subfields of proteomics?
3) Give a brief note on genome wide approach.
4) What are the different types of stem cells?
5) What are the tools employed in proteomic studies?
6) What is Pharmacogenomics? Discus with examples.
25
Applied and Emerging
Trends in Human Genetics UNIT 2 GENETIC EPIDEMIOLOLGY AND
EPIGENETICS
Contents
2.1 Introduction
2.2 Scope of Genetic Epidemiology
2.3 Methods of Genetic Epidemiology
2.4 Epigenetics
2.4.1 Epigenetic Mechanisms
2.4.2 Epigenetics and Inheritance
2.5 DNA Methylation
2.6 The role of DNA Methylation in Mammalian Epigenetics
2.7 The Hap Map Project
2.7.1 Method of Study
2.7.2 International Hap Map Project
2.7.3 Genetic Variation and Use of Hap Map
2.8 Summary
Suggested Reading
Sample Questions
Learning Objectives
&
After studying this unit, you would be able to:
Ø explain the concept of Genetic Epidemiology and its scope in areas of
medicine, genetics etc;
Ø discuss the meaning of Epigenetics and the factors responsible for the
occurrence of epigenetics;
Ø elucidate the importance of epigenetics in the understanding of DNA
Methylation or noncoding RNA;
Ø explain the methods employed for the study of Genetic Epidemiology; and
Ø to understand Hap Map project, the new advancement in Human Genetics.
2.1 INTRODUCTION
The Mendel’s Laws of Heredity discovery led to emergence of new biological
field of Genetics which is the study of heredity and variation i.e. how certain
characteristics or traits are passed from parents to offspring. His discoveries
paved the way for today’s understanding of the role of genetics in human
development and in the treatment of genetic disorders. Presently, genetic research
has moved from Mendelian genetics to sequence maps for the study of natural
human genetic variation at the level of the genome. The inheritance in
contemporary populations, uniting genetics with epidemiology, medicine,
psychology, and (in other species) with agriculture and with this concept the
26 field of genetic epidemiology emanated.
Genetic epidemiology is the study of the role of genetic factors in determining Genetic Epidemiology and
Epigenetics
health and disease in families and in populations, and the interplay of such genetic
factors with environmental factors. Genetic epidemiology was defined by Morton
as “a science which deals with the etiology, distribution, and control of disease
in groups of relatives and with inherited causes of disease in populations. It is of
two types. Classical epidemiology and Molecular Epidemiology. The former
deals with disease patterns and factors associated with causation of diseases
with the ultimate aim of preventing the disease and the latter measures exposure
to specific substances (DNA adducts) and early biological response (somatic
mutations), evaluates host characteristics (genotype and phenotype) mediating
response to external agents, and use of markers of a specific effect (like gene
expression) to refine disease categories (such as heterogeneity, etiology and
prognosis). The study methods of Genetic Epidemiology are mentioned below:
• Familial aggregation studies: Is there a genetic component to the disease,
and what are the relative contributions of genes and environment?
• Segregation studies: What is the pattern of inheritance of the disease (e.g.
dominant or recessive)?
• Linkage studies: On which part of which chromosome is the disease gene
located?
• Association studies: Which allele of which gene is associated with the
disease?
27
Applied and Emerging Family Recurrence Studies
Trends in Human Genetics
A fundamental aspect of genetic epidemiology is the study of aggregation (or
recurrence) of certain diseases in given families. Is this familial aggregation
associated with common environmental exposure, hereditary susceptibility, or
cultural inheritance of risk factors? If there is genetic susceptibility, how is it
inherited? The existence of familial aggregation can be determined by observing
the prevalence of a given disease in family members of the index case (the index
case is the affected individual who introduces the family into the study) and of
controls (individuals who are not affected). This method is efficient and
inexpensive, but one of its limitations is that information about characteristics
of family members and controls may give rise to biased.
Twin studies
Twin studies have typically been used to determine whether genetic factors play
a role in the etiology of certain diseases. Such studies consist of comparing the
difference in concordance between identical or monozygotic twins (MZ) and
fraternal or dizygotic twins (DZ). MZ twins share 100% of their genetic material,
whereas DZ twins share, on average, 50% of their genes. If sets of twins are
being studied, and the MZ twins are found to be concordant (both have the same
disease, for example) with greater frequency than the DZ twins, it is possible to
conclude that genetic factors are at least partially involved in the etiology of that
disease. It is important to note, however, that genetic differences may exist
between MZ twins. They may differ, for example, in the series of T-cell antibodies
and receptors, in the number of mitochondrial deoxyribonucleic acid (DNA)
molecules, in somatic mutations in general, and in the inactivation pattern of the
X chromosome in female twins. It is also well known that MZ twins may differ
from DZ twins as a result of environmental factors. One of two calculations is
normally made in twin studies, based on the method used to select the twins: (1)
pair concordance rate, which describes the proportion of twin pairs where both
siblings are affected; and (2) index case concordance rate, which is the proportion
of affected individuals among the co-twins of those selected as index cases.
Although the pair concordance rate is the simplest method of determining whether
genes affect a specific phenotype, it does not measure the magnitude of such an
effect. For that purpose, use of the index case concordance rate is preferable.
Twin studies are limited by several factors; in particular those associated with
the way participants are selected for the studies. For example, it has been observed
that studies that depend exclusively on volunteers have a greater proportion of
MZ twins, female pairs, and participants who are concordant for the phenotype
under study. Such differences may influence the concordance rate that is
calculated, which is why several countries— Sweden is a prime example—have
launched population-based twin registries. Another limitation, especially in
behavior studies, is that MZ twins tend to share environmental factors more
frequently than DZ twins.
Linkage studies: What is the location of the disease gene(s)? Linkage studies
screen the whole genome and use parametric or nonparametric methods such as
allele sharing methods (affected sibling-pairs method) with no assumptions on
the mode of inheritance, penetrance or disease allele frequency (the parameters).
The underlying principle of linkage studies is the co segregation of two genes
(one of which is the disease locus).
Association studies: What is the allele associated with the disease susceptibility?
The principle is the coexistence of the same marker on the same chromosome in
affected individuals (due to linkage disequilibrium). Association studies focus
on population frequencies, whereas linkage studies focus on concordant
inheritance. Association studies have several practical advantages over linkage
studies.
2.4 EPIGENETICS
The cells in a multicellular organism have normally identical DNA sequences
(and therefore the same genetic instruction sets), yet maintain different terminal
phenotypes. This nongenetic cellular memory, which records developmental and
environmental cues (and alternative cell states in unicellular organisms), is the
basis of epi-(above)–genetics. The lack of identified genetic determinants that
fully explain the heritability of complex traits, and the inability to pinpoint
causative genetic effects in some complex diseases, suggest possible epigenetic
explanations for this missing information. The desire to understand the
“deprogramming” of differentiated cells into pluripotent/totipotent states, has
led to “epigenetic” becoming shorthand for many regulatory systems involving
DNA methylation, histone modification, nucleosome location, or non-coding
RNA. Epigenetics was coined by Waddington (1942) to refer to the study of the
“causal mechanisms” by which “the genes of the genotype bring about phenotypic
effects.”
29
Applied and Emerging An epigenetic system is heritable, self-perpetuating, and reversible. Whether
Trends in Human Genetics
histone modifications (and many non-coding RNAs) are epigenetic is debated;
it is likely that relatively few of these modifications or RNAs will be self-
perpetuating and inherited.
DNA methylation stably alters the gene expression pattern in cells such that
cells can “remember where they have been” or decrease gene expression; for
example, cells programmed to be pancreatic islets during embryonic development
remain pancreatic islets throughout the life of the organism without continuing
signals telling them that they need to remain islets. DNA methylation is typically
removed during zygote formation and re-established through successive cell
divisions during development. However, the latest research shows that
hydroxylation of methyl group occurs rather than complete removal of methyl
groups in zygote. Some methylation modifications that regulate gene expression
are inheritable and are referred to as epigenetic regulation. DNA methylation is
essential for normal development and is associated with a number of key processes
including genomic imprinting, X-chromosome inactivation, suppression of
31
Applied and Emerging repetitive elements, and carcinogenesis. Alterations of DNA methylation have
Trends in Human Genetics
been recognised as an important component of cancer development.
Hypomethylation, in general, arises earlier and is linked to chromosomal
instability, loss of imprinting, whereas hypermethylation is associated with
promoters that can arise secondary to gene (oncogene suppressor) silencing, but
might be a target for epigenetic therapy.
Locus-specific
Enrichment Purified Genomic DNA Methylation
Quantitation
Bisulfite Treatment
Purified Bisulfite
Converted DNA
PCR Amplification of
Converted DNA
Analysis Analysis
32
Epigenetics Genetic Epidemiology and
Epigenetics
Methylation contributing to epigenetic inheritance can occur through either DNA
methylation or protein methylation.
Protein Methylation typically takes place on arginine or lysine amino acid residues
in the protein sequence. Arginine can be methylated once (monomethylated
arginine) or twice, with either both methyl groups on one terminal nitrogen
(asymmetric dimethylated arginine) or one on both nitrogens (symmetric
dimethylated arginine) by peptidyl arginine methyltransferases (PRMTs). Lysine
can be methylated once, twice or three times by lysine methyltransferases. Protein
methylation has been most-studied in the histones. The transfer of methyl groups
from S-adenosyl methionine to histones is catalyzed by enzymes known as histone
methyltransferases. Histones that are methylated on certain residues can act
epigenetically to repress or activate gene expression. Protein methylation is one
type of post-translational modification.
The variations have an effect on individual’s disease risk and the sites in the
DNA sequence where individuals differ at a single DNA base are called single
nucleotide polymorphisms (SNPs). Sets of nearby SNPs on the same chromosome
are inherited in blocks. This pattern of SNPs on a block is a haplotype. The Hap
Map is a map of these haplotype blocks and the specific SNPs that identify the
haplotype are called tag SNPs. The “Hap Map,” is a tool to find genes and genetic
variations that affect health and disease. The Hap Map is valuable by reducing
34
the number of SNPs required to examine the entire genome for association with Genetic Epidemiology and
Epigenetics
a phenotype from the 10 million SNPs that exist to roughly 500,000 tag SNPs.
The HAPMAP would help in genome scan approaches to finding regions with
genes that affect diseases much more efficient and comprehensive, since effort
is not wasted in typing more SNPs than necessary and all regions of the genome
are included.
In addition to its use in studying genetic associations with disease, the Hap Map
is a powerful resource for studying the genetic factors contributing to variation
in response to environmental factors, susceptibility to infection, and to study the
adverse responses to drugs and vaccines.
The Hap Map project proposes a shortcut. Although any two unrelated people
share about 99.5% of their DNA sequence, some people may have an A at a
particular site on a chromosome while others have a G instead. Such a site is
known as a single nucleotide polymorphism (SNP), and each of the two
possibilities is called an allele. The Hap Map project focuses only on common
SNPs, those where each allele occurs in at least 1% of the population. Each
person has two copies of all chromosomes, except the sex chromosomes in males.
For each SNP, the combination of alleles a person has is called a genotype.
Genotyping refers to uncovering what genotype a person has at a particular site.
To find the genetic factors involved in a particular disease, one can proceed as
follows. First a certain region of interest in the genome is identified, possibly
from earlier inheritance studies. In this region one then locates a set of tag SNPs
35
Applied and Emerging from the Hap Map data; these are SNPs that are very well correlated with all the
Trends in Human Genetics
other SNPs in the region, so that knowledge of the alleles of the tag SNPs in an
individual will determine the individual’s haplotype with high probability. Next,
one determines the genotype for these tag SNPs in several individuals, some
with the disease and some without. By comparing the two groups, one can then
determine the likely locations and haplotype that are involved in the disease.
Hap Map resource is to guide the design and analysis of genetic association
studies, shed light on structural variation and recombination identifies loci that
may have been subject to natural selection during human evolution. Despite the
ever-accelerating pace of biomedical research, the root causes of common human
diseases remain largely unknown, preventative measures are generally inadequate
and available treatments are seldom curative. Family history is one of the strongest
risk factors for nearly all diseases—including cardiovascular disease, cancer,
diabetes, autoimmunity, psychiatric illnesses and many others—providing the
tantalizing but elusive clue that inherited genetic variation has an important role
in the pathogenesis of disease. Identifying the causal genes and variants would
represent an important step in the path towards improved prevention, diagnosis
and treatment of disease. More than a thousand genes for rare, highly heritable
diseases have been identified so far.
A part of two chromosomes showing a SNP. Both the A and G alleles are
shown.
Each person has two copies of all chromosomes except the sex chromosomes.
The set of alleles that a person has is called a genotype. For this SNP a person
could have the genotype AA, AG, or GG. for basic genetics information). The
term genotype can refer to the SNP alleles that a person has at a particular SNP
or for many SNPs across the genome. A method that discovers what genotype a
person has is called genotyping. About 10 million SNPs exist in human
populations, where the rarer SNP allele has a frequency of at least 1%. Alleles of
SNPs that are close together tend to be inherited together. A set of associated
SNP alleles in a region of a chromosome is called a “haplotype”. Most
chromosome regions have only a few common haplotype (each with a frequency
of at least 5%), which account for most of the variation from person to person in
a population. A chromosome region may contain many SNPs, but only a few
“tag” SNPs can provide most of the information on the pattern of genetic variation
in the region.
36
Genetic Epidemiology and
Epigenetics
A chromosome region with only the SNPs shown. Three haplotype are
shown. The two SNPs in color are sufficient to identify (tag) each of the
three haplotype. For example, if a chromosome has alleles A and T at
these two tag SNPs, and then it has the first haplotype.
The Hap Map describes the common patterns of genetic variation in humans.
Population and Sample
Most of the common haplotype occur in all human populations; however, their
frequencies differ among populations. Therefore, data from several populations
are needed to choose tag SNPs.
2.8 SUMMARY
Genetic epidemiology aims at diseases that are caused by genetic alterations
among closely related individuals or in a Mendelian population. It measures the
frequency and prevalence of a genetic disease, gene - gene interaction, gene -
environment interaction, genotype and phenotype correlation, the extent of
expression of default gene in families or in a population. When there is no fault
in the structure of a gene, a disease may occur in the faulty expression of a gene.
Such changes are due to DNA methylation and histone modification. It is called
as epigenetics. Segregation, association and linkage analysis are important
methods used in Genetic epidemiological studies. Using these methods
internationally, a Haplotype map of humans (HapMap) was constructed to
understand common genetic variation and its association with diseases.
37
Applied and Emerging Suggested Reading
Trends in Human Genetics
Andreas Ziegler , Inke R. König. 2010. A Statistical Approach to Genetic
Epidemiology. Concepts and Applications.2nd Edition.,Weinheim: Wiley-VCH
Verlag GmbH and Co.KGaA.
Dawn Teare (ed). 2011. Genetic epidemiology. Methods in molecular
biology.Vol.713, Newyork: Springer.
Francis CR. 2011. Epigenetics: The Ultimate mystery of Inheritance. Newyork:
W.W.Norton & Company.
Francis CR. Epigentics: How environment shapes our genes.W.W.Norton and
Company, 2012.
Lyle J. Palmer, Paul Burton and George Davey Smith (Editors). 2011. An
Introduction to Genetic Epidemiology (Health & Society Series). First edition.
Bristol, U.K: The Policy Press.
Morton, N and Chin Sik Chung. Genetic Epidemiology. London: Academic press.
Trygve Tollefsbol. (eds). 2010. Handbook of epigenetics: The new molecular
and medical genetics. London:Academic Press.
Sample Questions
1) Define Genetic Epidemiology?
2) Give a brief account on the scope of genetic epidemiology.
3) Explain the term epigenetics. Epigenetics concept has given new ideas to
Human Genetics. Justify the statement.
4) DNA Methylation is an important process to understand gene-expression.
Explain DNA Methylation process.
5) HAP MAP Project is an essential innovation for biomedical research. State
the aims of the project.
38
Genetic Epidemiology and
UNIT 3 PREVENTION OF GENETIC Epigenetics
DISEASES
Contents
3.1 Introduction
3.2 Genetic Screening
3.3 Genetic Counselling
3.4 Prenatal Diagnosis
3.5 Gene Therapy
3.6 Summary
Further Reading
Sample Questions
Learning Objectives
&
It is expected that after reading this unit, you would be able to:
Ø explain what is genetic disease and types of genetic diseases;
Ø discuss the processes of genetic screening and genetic counselling;
Ø describe on prenatal diagnosis; and
Ø explain gene therapy and its importance.
3.1 INTRODUCTION
Genetic diseases are those pathological conditions that are caused or influenced
by abnormalities in the genetic material (genome) of a person and these are caused
by genemutations and chromosomal abnormalities. Genetic diseases place a
substantial health, emotional, and economic load on affected people, their families
and on the society. There are a number of diverse types of genetic disorders.
Geneticists group genetic disorders into four categories: single gene/monogenic
genetic diseases, multifactorial/polygenic genetic diseases, chromosomal diseases
and mitochondrial DNA disorders.
Single Gene Genetic diseases: These are also called as monogenic genetic
diseases or Mendelian genetic disorders. These type of disorders are caused by
changes or mutations that occur in the DNA sequence of a single gene. Single
gene disorders are passed on between generations from parents to offspring.
Four patterns of inheritance occur: autosomal dominant, autosomal recessive,
X-linked dominant and X-linked recessive. Some of the diseases of single gene
disorders are sickle cell anaemia, cystic fibrosis, Aicardi Syndrome, Huntington’s
disease etc.
Polygenic genetic diseases: These diseases are also called multifactorial genetic
disorders. These diseases are influenced by the interaction of multiple genes and
interaction between genes and environmental factors. Heart disease, diabetes,
hypertension, Alzheimer’s disease are some of the examples of polygenic diseases.
39
Applied and Emerging Chromosomal diseases: These diseases are caused by the loss or gain of one or
Trends in Human Genetics
more chromosomes or by alterations in chromosome structure. Down syndrome,
Turner syndrome and Klinefelter syndrome are some of the examples for
chromosomal diseases.
So far we have studied what are genetic disease and their types. Now let us
discuss how to prevent them. The desire of all parents is to have normal and
healthy children. Hence many parents think ways to prevent or lower the risk of
passing the genetic diseases to their offspring by preventing the genetic diseases.
To prevent genetic diseases, parents have to undergo certain preventive measures
such as Genetic screening, Genetic counselling, Prenatal diagnosis and Gene
therapy. A brief description of the above mentioned preventive measures is
described below.
After genetic screening if both the parents are heterozygous for a genetic disease
and the genotypes of both the prospective parents become known and they can
decide to produce a child or not. It is simple matter to work out the probability of
their child inheriting the disease. This can be done through appropriate tests
around 2-3 months after conception. This is achieved through amniocentesis or
through chorionic villus biopsy; the cultured fetal cells may be used for
determining their karyotype, levels of the critical enzymes and restriction patterns
of DNA. Such an antenatal diagnosis is now available for several genetic diseases
and for a variety of chromosomal defects. The purpose of such a diagnosis is
premature termination of abnormal fetuses.
It has been advocated that defective genes may be corrected through sophisticated
genetic techniques either during the early stages of embryo development (embryo
40
therapy) or in specific tissues of the adult patient (patient therapy); such an Prevention of Genetic
Diseases
approach is referred to as genetic surgery. Embryo therapy would involve:
1) In vitro fertilization of egg.
2) Production of several copies of the normal allele of the defective gene.
3) Introduction of this DNA into the zygote or in the cells of the developing
embryo.
4) Integration of DNA, preferably in place of the defective allele, so that it may
function normally.
The aim of patient therapy is to introduce the normal gene into the critical tissue
of the patient that is affected by a genetic disease, i.e., the tissue where the
concerned gene is required to express itself the most e.g., pancreas in the case of
diabetes. The steps involved in patient therapy would be similar to those of embryo
therapy. But in this case, cells from the concerned tissues may have to be exercised
and treated in vitro to correct their genetic defects and then reintroduced into the
tissue where they may function normally. Techniques for isolation, identification
and multiplication of many human genes are now available, and for many others
they are likely to be developed soon. The techniques for gene transfer in eukaryotes
are being refined and it may not remain a great problem in the near future.
A suggestion has also been made to use highly specific chemical mutagens that
will correct the defect in the concerned gene. Such a directed mutagenesis however
is a dream that may be more difficult to fulfil the patient and embryo therapies
through DNA mediated genetic modifications. Genetic screening and counselling
may also lead to certain problems. The cases of mistaken paternity, the problem
of confidentiality, delayed counselling are important among them.
Prenatal diagnosis for genetic diseases is now commonly available for pregnancies
at risk. Prior to prenatal diagnosis genetic counselling could only give likelihood
of recurrence, based on Mendelian laws or empirical data. If an abnormality is
detected in the pregnancy the medical people have to convey the information to
parents and allow the parents to take a decision as to whether to continue with
the abnormal foetus or to go for abortion. The couples at high risk of having a
child with a genetic disorder has to choose between taking the risk or considering
other reproductive options such as long term conception, sterilization and
termination of pregnancies. Most parents would terminate an affected pregnancy
but some choose to use the information to prepare for the birth of an affected
child. When the foetus is found to be normal it allows the parents to continue the
pregnancy with mental relief.
Advanced maternal age: Women who are pregnant at 35 or more have higher
risk of giving birth to a baby with the defect in chromosomes. Down syndrome
(trisomy 21) is the common chromosomal defect. A child with Down syndrome
can be born to parents of any age; however, the risk rises steeply once the mother’s
age is over 35 years.
43
Applied and Emerging Previous child with a chromosome abnormality: Parents who have had a child
Trends in Human Genetics
with trisomy 21 (Down syndrome) or any other trisomy are at increased risk of
having a trisomy in subsequent pregnancies.
The gene therapy can be categorised into two types: in vivo therapy and ex vivo
therapy. In the case of in vivo therapy the therapeutic genes are directly introduced
in to the patient’s body (fig. 3.2) and in ex vivo category the cells are removed
from the patient and after manipulation they are returned to the patient (fig. 3.3).
45
Applied and Emerging
Trends in Human Genetics
3.6 SUMMARY
Genetic disease is caused by variation or alteration called mutation in gene, or
alteration in chromosome. Genetic diseases can be classified into simple and
complex diseases. Simple genetic diseases are also called as monogenetic or
Mendelian diseases caused by a mutation. Complex diseases have multi-factorial
causation. They are caused by the interaction of many genes and gene -
46
environmental interaction. Screening the genetic diseases in the population and Prevention of Genetic
Diseases
genetic counselling to the couples is a prerequisite in avoiding the defective
progeny. To prevent the genetic diseases, prenatal diagnosis and termination of
defective zygote is one of the best ways. Gene therapy is the treating method for
genetic diseases, it involves in correcting the default genetic sequence. Currently
available method for preventing genetic diseases is to identify the faulty genetic
code at an early stage and change the life style. By changing the life style we can
prevent some late onset genetic diseases. In curing the genetic diseases future
research may bring success in gene therapy.
Further Reading
Gardner, A, Howell, R.T and Davies, T. 2008. Human Genetics. New Delhi:
Viva Books private Ltd.
Hartl, D.L. 1991. Basic Genetics. Boston: Jones and Bartlett Publishers.
Mueller, RF and Young, ID. 1995. Emery’s Elements of medical genetics. New
York and London: Churchill Livingstone.
Thompson, JS and Thompson, MW. 2005. Genetics in Medicine. Philadelphia
and London: WB Saunders Company.
Uhlmann, WR, Schuette, JL and Yashar, BM. 2009. A guide to Genetic counseling.
New Jersey: Wiley-Blackwell.
Verma, PS and Agarwal, VK. 1999. Cell Biology, Genetics, Molecular Biology,
Evolution and Ecology. New Delhi: S. Chand & company Ltd.
Sample Questions
1) What is a genetic disease? Briefly explain on various genetic diseases.
2) Discuss briefly about Prenatal diagnosis.
3) What is genetic screening? Explain its processes.
4) Write short notes on the following:
a) Gene therapy
b) Genetic counselling
47
Applied and Emerging
Trends in Human Genetics UNIT 4 GENETICS AND HUMAN ISSUES
Contents
4.1 Introduction
4.1.1 Human Genome Project
4.1.2 What is Ethics?
4.1.3 Ethical, Legal, Social Issues in Genetics
4.2 Genetic Testing and Research
4.2.1 General Concerns
4.2.2 Ethical Principles in Genetics Research
4.2.2.1 Autonomy or Respect for Persons
4.2.2.2 Beneficence and Non Maleficence
4.2.2.3 Justice
4.2.3 Special Ethical Issues in Genetics Studies
4.2.3.1 Informed Consent
4.2.3.2 Vulnerable Participants
4.2.3.3 Genetic Counselling
4.2.3.4 Risks and Benefits
4.2.3.5 Pedigree Studies
4.2.3.6 Privacy and Confidentiality
4.2.3.7 Inducement vs Compensation
4.2.3.8 Genetic Screening
4.2.3.9 DNA Testing
4.2.3.10 Prenatal Testing
4.2.3.11 Presymptomatic and Susceptibility Testing
4.2.3.12 Gene Therapy
4.2.3.13 DNA and Cell-line Banking/Repository
4.2.3.14 Cloning
4.2.3.15 Stem Cell Research and Therapy
4.2.4 Other Concerns in Genetics Research
4.2.4.1 Commercial Issues
4.2.4.2 Patenting
4.2.4.3 Research in International Collaboration
4.3 Summary
Further Reading and References
Sample Questions
Learning Objectives
&
Once you have studied this unit, you should be able to:
Ø describe how ethical issues in human genetics have emerged and why it is
important to take care of them;
Ø understand about the various ethical principles and their importance; and
Ø discuss the emerging ethical, legal, social concerns in genetic testing and research.
48
Genetics and Human Issues
4.1 INTRODUCTION
Hereditary conditions affect millions of families throughout the world. About
5% of all pregnancies result in the birth of a child with a significant genetic
disorder, congenital malformation or disability. The burden of genetic disorders
and birth defects is yet to be recognised. It has been estimated that there is a high
prevalence of genetic disorders in India with about 495,000 infants with congenital
malformations, 390,000 with G6PD deficiency, 21,400 with Down syndrome,
9000 with Beta thalassaemia, 5,200 with sickle cell disease and 9760 with amino
acid disorders born each year (Verma and Bijarnia, 2002). A high prevalence of
inborn errors of metabolism of 1 in 1000 live births has been reported from India
(Rama Devi and Naushad, 2004). It is estimated that 8000-10000 children are
born with thalassaemia every year and there are about 20 million carriers of b-
thalassaemia in the country (Mohanty et al, 2002). Most non-infectious diseases,
may have a genetic component. Therefore, continued efforts are required to
develop effective treatments and make them available in India for diseases that
are important to the health of communities as well as individuals and families.
You may be surprised to know that in no other area of biomedical research there
has been a greater concern for ethical issues than in the field of human genetics.
With the successful completion of Human Genome sequencing in April, 2003,
number of guidelines were laid identifying the ethical, legal and social issues
and measures that may be taken for improving awareness and understanding of
human genetic disorders.
50
The integration of genetic technologies into the public health raises significant Genetics and Human Issues
challenges. How can we assure the quality and accuracy? What impact will these
new technologies have on existing programs? Issues of autonomy, privacy,
confidentiality will require special consideration. Will it be possible to obtain
fully informed consent from large populations? How to protect privacy in genetic
registries and databases? How can group stigmatization and discrimination be
prevented? None of these questions have easy answers, but they raise important
challenges for the community. These are the various ethical, legal and social
issues that address the societal concerns emerging from the new genomic
information and technologies.
Any research procedure that exposes a person to any risk should be done only if
there is proper justification for doing so and there should be expected benefits of
the research. All expected or potential risks as well as benefits should be discussed
in detail before participation of the person. Also it is important for you to note
that in genetic research, the primary risk may not be physical but rather may be
psychosocial and can have effects or implications on other members of the family
as well. Genetic testing therefore should be offered when the probability of harm
is less and the expected benefits are more. Adequate counseling should be given
to participants on the meaning of genetic information they receive.
4.2.3.14 Cloning
Research using human stem cells to grow new tissues (in order to repair or replace
those damaged by disease) holds potential promise. Some of this research may
involve nuclear fusion of an adult individual’s cell with an enucleated egg, a
first step toward potential human cloning. The possible benefits of research using
nuclear fusion to produce tissues for the treatment of disease are recognized,
provided that there would be no attempt to reproduce an entire human being. At
the present time, “reproductive human cloning” is unsafe and should not be
58 attempted.
4.2.3.15 Stem Cell Research and Therapy Genetics and Human Issues
The stem cell research holds a great promise for improving human health by
control of degenerative diseases and restoration of damage to organs by various
injuries. At the same time it also raises several ethical and social issues such as
destruction of human embryos to create human embryonic stem (HES) cell lines,
potential for commodification in human tissues and organs, possible use of
technology for germ-line engineering and reproductive cloning etc. The research
in this field, therefore, needs careful consideration. It is important to protect
safety and rights of those donating gametes/ blastocysts/ somatic cells for
derivation of stem cells; or fetal tissues/umbilical cord cells/ adult tissue (or
cells) for use as stem cells. Safeguards are also needed to protect research
participants receiving stem cell transplants, and patients at large from unproven
therapies/remedies. Most of the stem cell procedures are still in the research or
experimental phase and long term effects are unknown therefore stem cell studies
should be done as a clinical trial and not offered as proven therapy to patients.
4.2.4.2 Patenting
Biomedical research in human genetics can lead to the development of diagnostic
and pharmaceutical products. Patents may be necessary to raise funding to develop
such products commercially, but gene sequences without proven utility should
not be granted patents. Patenting has the potential to impede international
collaboration, especially between developing and developed countries, to the
ultimate detriment of service delivery to those with genetic disorders. Genetics
differs from many areas of research in that important new knowledge can come
from a family, or an ethnic group, with a particular genetic variant. If this leads
59
Applied and Emerging to the development of a diagnostic test or new therapies, equity requires that the
Trends in Human Genetics
donors, or the community generally, should receive some benefit.
60
Genetics and Human Issues
4.3 SUMMARY
The last decade has witnessed tremendous advances in science and technology
and the prospects of genetic testing, genetic engineering, cloning, stem cell
research, prenatal testing, DNA diagnostic etc. all have raised many ethical
dilemmas in the minds of scientists and society. There are advantages of such
new technologies but there is also the fear of the unknown distant possibilities
which needs careful examination. Weighing of risk benefit ratio, protection of
privacy and confidentiality and sharing of burdens and benefits are some of the
main issues. Close monitoring of research in these areas is important. Education
has the potential power to prevent stigmatization and discrimination by
emphasizing that genetic disorders are not caused by the behaviour of affected
persons or families but the fact that most people may carry some recessive lethal
mutations and that our offspring or we are all at genetic risk. For all kinds of
genetic testing and research, respect for persons is important and should include
informed consent, right to referral, full disclosure, protection of confidentiality,
and respect for minority groups, women and children. The following statements
summarize the issues:
• Genetic services should be voluntary but should be made available to those
interested in them.
• Genetic counselling should be non-directive to let the decision making be
done by individuals without any force or coercion.
• All clinically relevant information that may affect the health of an individual
or fetus should be disclosed and various options explained.
• Confidentiality of genetic information should be maintained. When there is
a high risk of serious harm to family members at genetic risk, the information
should be used to avert this harm.
• Individual privacy should be protected from third parties, such as employers,
insurers, schools, commercial entities etc.
• Prenatal diagnosis should be performed only for reasons relevant to the health
and only to detect genetic conditions or malformations.
• Choices about counselling, screening, testing and abortion following prenatal
diagnosis should be available on a voluntary basis.
• Optimum support and education should be provided for children and families
with genetic conditions.
• Research protocols should follow established procedures for ethical review
and informed consent.
61
Applied and Emerging Hardy BJ, Séguin B, Goodsaid F, Jimenez-Sanchez G, Singer PA, Daar AS. 2008.
Trends in Human Genetics
The next steps for genomic medicine: challenges and opportunities for the
developing world. Nat Rev Genet. Oct;9 Suppl 1:S23-7.
Kabra, M. 2003. Prenatal diagnosis. Indian J Pediatr. 70:81-5.
Mohanty D, Colah RB, Gorakshakar AH, Nadkarni AH, Phanasgaonkar SP, Shetty
S, Ghosh K, Mukherjee MB. 2002. Genetic Disorders in Haematological Practice
in India. Community Genetics, 5:197-200.
National Guidelines for Stem Cell Research and Therapy, 2007.
Nuffield Council on Bioethics. 1993. Genetic screening and public policy. In
Genetic Screening, Ethical Issues. London: Nuffield Council on Bioethics, 75–
81.
Parker, M Ashcroft R, AOM Wilkie, A Kent, 2004. Ethical review of research
into rare genetic disorders. British Medical Journal, 329:288–9.
Rama Devi AR, Naushad SM. 2004. Newborn screening in India. Indian J Pediatr;
71: 157-60.
Séguin B, Hardy BJ, Singer PA, Daar AS. 2008. Genomic medicine and
developing countries: creating a room of their own. Nat Rev Genet. 9 (6):487-
93.
The Universal Declaration on the Human Genome and Human Rights, 29th session
General Conference UNESCO, 11 November 1997.
The ethics of patenting DNA: a discussion paper. Nuffield Council on Bioethics
July 2002.
Tom L. Beauchamp, James F. Childress. 1994. Principles of Biomedical Ethics,
Oxford University Press.
Verma IC, Bijarnia S. 2002. The burden of genetic disorders in India and a
framework for community control. Community Genetics, 5:192-196.
Sample Questions
1) Write a short note on Human Genome Project and its implications.
2) What do you understand by Genetic Counselling and why is it important?
3) What are the ethical, legal and social issues? Discuss.
4) Write a note on the Ethical Principles in Genetic research.
5) What is informed consent in research? Give a few main elements of informed
consent.
6) What do you understand by vulnerable persons/ populations?
7) Why should there be adequate provisions to protect the privacy and
confidentiality of persons in genetic research?
8) Describe any three specific concerns in genetics research.
9) Write a short note on biobanks.
10. What safeguards should be in place for genetic research in International
Collaboration?
62